2015-12-10 05:06:13 +02:00
|
|
|
/****************************************************************************
|
|
|
|
**
|
|
|
|
** Copyright (C) 2015 The Qt Company Ltd.
|
|
|
|
** Contact: http://www.qt.io/licensing/
|
|
|
|
**
|
|
|
|
** This file is part of the QtGui module of the Qt Toolkit.
|
|
|
|
**
|
|
|
|
** $QT_BEGIN_LICENSE:LGPL$
|
|
|
|
** Commercial License Usage
|
|
|
|
** Licensees holding valid commercial Qt licenses may use this file in
|
|
|
|
** accordance with the commercial license agreement provided with the
|
|
|
|
** Software or, alternatively, in accordance with the terms contained in
|
|
|
|
** a written agreement between you and The Qt Company. For licensing terms
|
|
|
|
** and conditions see http://www.qt.io/terms-conditions. For further
|
|
|
|
** information use the contact form at http://www.qt.io/contact-us.
|
|
|
|
**
|
|
|
|
** GNU Lesser General Public License Usage
|
|
|
|
** Alternatively, this file may be used under the terms of the GNU Lesser
|
|
|
|
** General Public License version 2.1 or version 3 as published by the Free
|
|
|
|
** Software Foundation and appearing in the file LICENSE.LGPLv21 and
|
|
|
|
** LICENSE.LGPLv3 included in the packaging of this file. Please review the
|
|
|
|
** following information to ensure the GNU Lesser General Public License
|
|
|
|
** requirements will be met: https://www.gnu.org/licenses/lgpl.html and
|
|
|
|
** http://www.gnu.org/licenses/old-licenses/lgpl-2.1.html.
|
|
|
|
**
|
|
|
|
** As a special exception, The Qt Company gives you certain additional
|
|
|
|
** rights. These rights are described in The Qt Company LGPL Exception
|
|
|
|
** version 1.1, included in the file LGPL_EXCEPTION.txt in this package.
|
|
|
|
**
|
|
|
|
** GNU General Public License Usage
|
|
|
|
** Alternatively, this file may be used under the terms of the GNU
|
|
|
|
** General Public License version 3.0 as published by the Free Software
|
|
|
|
** Foundation and appearing in the file LICENSE.GPL included in the
|
|
|
|
** packaging of this file. Please review the following information to
|
|
|
|
** ensure the GNU General Public License version 3.0 requirements will be
|
|
|
|
** met: http://www.gnu.org/copyleft/gpl.html.
|
|
|
|
**
|
|
|
|
** $QT_END_LICENSE$
|
|
|
|
**
|
|
|
|
****************************************************************************/
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
#include "qapplication.h"
|
|
|
|
#include "qapplication_p.h"
|
|
|
|
#include "qbrush.h"
|
|
|
|
#include "qcursor.h"
|
|
|
|
#include "qdesktopwidget.h"
|
|
|
|
#include "qevent.h"
|
|
|
|
#include "qhash.h"
|
|
|
|
#include "qlayout.h"
|
|
|
|
#include "qmenu.h"
|
|
|
|
#include "qmetaobject.h"
|
|
|
|
#include "qpixmap.h"
|
|
|
|
#include "qpointer.h"
|
|
|
|
#include "qstack.h"
|
|
|
|
#include "qstyle.h"
|
|
|
|
#include "qstylefactory.h"
|
|
|
|
#include "qvariant.h"
|
|
|
|
#include "qwidget.h"
|
|
|
|
#include "qstyleoption.h"
|
|
|
|
#ifndef QT_NO_ACCESSIBILITY
|
|
|
|
# include "qaccessible.h"
|
|
|
|
#endif
|
|
|
|
#if defined(Q_WS_WIN)
|
|
|
|
# include "qt_windows.h"
|
|
|
|
#endif
|
|
|
|
#ifdef Q_WS_MAC
|
|
|
|
# include "qt_mac_p.h"
|
|
|
|
# include "qt_cocoa_helpers_mac_p.h"
|
|
|
|
# include "qmainwindow.h"
|
|
|
|
# include "qtoolbar.h"
|
|
|
|
# include <qmainwindowlayout_p.h>
|
|
|
|
#endif
|
|
|
|
#include "qpainter.h"
|
|
|
|
#include "qtooltip.h"
|
|
|
|
#include "qwhatsthis.h"
|
|
|
|
#include "qdebug.h"
|
|
|
|
#include "qstylesheetstyle_p.h"
|
|
|
|
#include "qstyle_p.h"
|
|
|
|
#include "qinputcontext_p.h"
|
|
|
|
#include "qfileinfo.h"
|
|
|
|
#include "qsoftkeymanager_p.h"
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
#if defined (Q_WS_WIN)
|
|
|
|
# include <qwininputcontext_p.h>
|
|
|
|
#endif
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
#if defined(Q_WS_X11)
|
|
|
|
# include <qpaintengine_x11_p.h>
|
|
|
|
# include "qx11info_x11.h"
|
|
|
|
#endif
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
#include <qgraphicseffect_p.h>
|
|
|
|
#include <qwindowsurface_p.h>
|
|
|
|
#include <qbackingstore_p.h>
|
|
|
|
#ifdef Q_WS_MAC
|
|
|
|
# include <qpaintengine_mac_p.h>
|
|
|
|
#endif
|
|
|
|
#include <qpaintengine_raster_p.h>
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
#include "qwidget_p.h"
|
|
|
|
#include "qaction_p.h"
|
|
|
|
#include "qlayout_p.h"
|
|
|
|
#include "QtGui/qgraphicsproxywidget.h"
|
|
|
|
#include "QtGui/qgraphicsscene.h"
|
|
|
|
#include "qgraphicsproxywidget_p.h"
|
|
|
|
#include "QtGui/qabstractscrollarea.h"
|
|
|
|
#include "qabstractscrollarea_p.h"
|
|
|
|
#include "qevent_p.h"
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
#include "qgraphicssystem_p.h"
|
|
|
|
#include "qgesturemanager_p.h"
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
#ifdef QT_KEYPAD_NAVIGATION
|
|
|
|
#include "qtabwidget.h" // Needed in inTabWidget()
|
|
|
|
#endif // QT_KEYPAD_NAVIGATION
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
#ifdef Q_OS_BLACKBERRY
|
|
|
|
#include <bps/navigator.h>
|
|
|
|
#endif
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
#ifdef Q_OS_BLACKBERRY_TABLET
|
|
|
|
#include <bps/orientation.h>
|
|
|
|
#endif
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
// widget/widget data creation count
|
|
|
|
//#define QWIDGET_EXTRA_DEBUG
|
|
|
|
//#define ALIEN_DEBUG
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
QT_BEGIN_NAMESPACE
|
|
|
|
|
2016-01-30 16:02:10 +02:00
|
|
|
#ifdef QT_MAC_USE_COCOA
|
2015-12-10 05:06:13 +02:00
|
|
|
bool qt_mac_clearDirtyOnWidgetInsideDrawWidget = false;
|
|
|
|
#endif
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
static inline bool qRectIntersects(const QRect &r1, const QRect &r2)
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
return (qMax(r1.left(), r2.left()) <= qMin(r1.right(), r2.right()) &&
|
|
|
|
qMax(r1.top(), r2.top()) <= qMin(r1.bottom(), r2.bottom()));
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
static inline bool hasBackingStoreSupport()
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
#ifdef Q_WS_MAC
|
2016-06-21 16:52:02 +00:00
|
|
|
return QApplicationPrivate::graphics_system != 0;
|
2015-12-10 05:06:13 +02:00
|
|
|
#else
|
|
|
|
return true;
|
|
|
|
#endif
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
#ifdef Q_WS_MAC
|
|
|
|
# define QT_NO_PAINT_DEBUG
|
|
|
|
#endif
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
extern QDesktopWidget *qt_desktopWidget; // qapplication.cpp
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/*!
|
|
|
|
\internal
|
|
|
|
\class QWidgetBackingStoreTracker
|
|
|
|
\brief Class which allows tracking of which widgets are using a given backing store
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
QWidgetBackingStoreTracker is a thin wrapper around a QWidgetBackingStore pointer,
|
|
|
|
which maintains a list of the QWidgets which are currently using the backing
|
|
|
|
store. This list is modified via the registerWidget and unregisterWidget functions.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
QWidgetBackingStoreTracker::QWidgetBackingStoreTracker()
|
|
|
|
: m_ptr(0)
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
QWidgetBackingStoreTracker::~QWidgetBackingStoreTracker()
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
delete m_ptr;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/*!
|
|
|
|
\internal
|
|
|
|
Destroy the contained QWidgetBackingStore, if not null, and clear the list of
|
|
|
|
widgets using the backing store, then create a new QWidgetBackingStore, providing
|
|
|
|
the QWidget.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
void QWidgetBackingStoreTracker::create(QWidget *widget)
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
destroy();
|
|
|
|
m_ptr = new QWidgetBackingStore(widget);
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/*!
|
|
|
|
\internal
|
|
|
|
Destroy the contained QWidgetBackingStore, if not null, and clear the list of
|
|
|
|
widgets using the backing store.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
void QWidgetBackingStoreTracker::destroy()
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
delete m_ptr;
|
|
|
|
m_ptr = 0;
|
|
|
|
m_widgets.clear();
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/*!
|
|
|
|
\internal
|
|
|
|
Add the widget to the list of widgets currently using the backing store.
|
|
|
|
If the widget was already in the list, this function is a no-op.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
void QWidgetBackingStoreTracker::registerWidget(QWidget *w)
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
Q_ASSERT(m_ptr);
|
|
|
|
Q_ASSERT(w->internalWinId());
|
|
|
|
Q_ASSERT(qt_widget_private(w)->maybeBackingStore() == m_ptr);
|
|
|
|
m_widgets.insert(w);
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/*!
|
|
|
|
\internal
|
|
|
|
Remove the widget from the list of widgets currently using the backing store.
|
|
|
|
If the widget was in the list, and removing it causes the list to be empty,
|
|
|
|
the backing store is deleted.
|
|
|
|
If the widget was not in the list, this function is a no-op.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
void QWidgetBackingStoreTracker::unregisterWidget(QWidget *w)
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
if (m_widgets.remove(w) && m_widgets.isEmpty()) {
|
|
|
|
delete m_ptr;
|
|
|
|
m_ptr = 0;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/*!
|
|
|
|
\internal
|
|
|
|
Recursively remove widget and all of its descendents.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
void QWidgetBackingStoreTracker::unregisterWidgetSubtree(QWidget *widget)
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
unregisterWidget(widget);
|
|
|
|
foreach (QObject *child, widget->children())
|
|
|
|
if (QWidget *childWidget = qobject_cast<QWidget *>(child))
|
|
|
|
unregisterWidgetSubtree(childWidget);
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
QWidgetPrivate::QWidgetPrivate(int version)
|
|
|
|
: QObjectPrivate(version)
|
|
|
|
, extra(0)
|
|
|
|
, focus_next(0)
|
|
|
|
, focus_prev(0)
|
|
|
|
, focus_child(0)
|
|
|
|
, layout(0)
|
|
|
|
, needsFlush(0)
|
|
|
|
, redirectDev(0)
|
|
|
|
, widgetItem(0)
|
|
|
|
, extraPaintEngine(0)
|
|
|
|
, polished(0)
|
|
|
|
, graphicsEffect(0)
|
|
|
|
#if !defined(QT_NO_IM)
|
|
|
|
, imHints(Qt::ImhNone)
|
|
|
|
#endif
|
|
|
|
, inheritedFontResolveMask(0)
|
|
|
|
, inheritedPaletteResolveMask(0)
|
|
|
|
, leftmargin(0)
|
|
|
|
, topmargin(0)
|
|
|
|
, rightmargin(0)
|
|
|
|
, bottommargin(0)
|
|
|
|
, leftLayoutItemMargin(0)
|
|
|
|
, topLayoutItemMargin(0)
|
|
|
|
, rightLayoutItemMargin(0)
|
|
|
|
, bottomLayoutItemMargin(0)
|
|
|
|
, hd(0)
|
|
|
|
, size_policy(QSizePolicy::Preferred, QSizePolicy::Preferred)
|
|
|
|
, fg_role(QPalette::NoRole)
|
|
|
|
, bg_role(QPalette::NoRole)
|
|
|
|
, dirtyOpaqueChildren(1)
|
|
|
|
, isOpaque(0)
|
|
|
|
, inDirtyList(0)
|
|
|
|
, isScrolled(0)
|
|
|
|
, isMoved(0)
|
|
|
|
, isGLWidget(0)
|
|
|
|
, usesDoubleBufferedGLContext(0)
|
|
|
|
#ifndef QT_NO_IM
|
|
|
|
, inheritsInputMethodHints(0)
|
|
|
|
#endif
|
|
|
|
, inSetParent(0)
|
|
|
|
#if defined(Q_WS_X11)
|
|
|
|
, picture(0)
|
|
|
|
#elif defined(Q_WS_WIN)
|
|
|
|
, noPaintOnScreen(0)
|
|
|
|
#ifndef QT_NO_GESTURES
|
|
|
|
, nativeGesturePanEnabled(0)
|
|
|
|
#endif
|
|
|
|
#elif defined(Q_WS_MAC)
|
|
|
|
, needWindowChange(0)
|
|
|
|
, window_event(0)
|
|
|
|
, qd_hd(0)
|
|
|
|
#endif
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
if (!qApp) {
|
|
|
|
qFatal("QWidget: Must construct a QApplication before a QPaintDevice");
|
|
|
|
return;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
if (version != QObjectPrivateVersion)
|
|
|
|
qFatal("Cannot mix incompatible Qt libraries");
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
isWidget = true;
|
|
|
|
memset(high_attributes, 0, sizeof(high_attributes));
|
2016-01-30 16:02:10 +02:00
|
|
|
#ifdef QT_MAC_USE_COCOA
|
2015-12-10 05:06:13 +02:00
|
|
|
drawRectOriginalAdded = false;
|
|
|
|
originalDrawMethod = true;
|
|
|
|
changeMethods = false;
|
|
|
|
isInUnifiedToolbar = false;
|
|
|
|
unifiedSurface = 0;
|
|
|
|
toolbar_ancestor = 0;
|
|
|
|
flushRequested = false;
|
|
|
|
touchEventsEnabled = false;
|
|
|
|
#endif // QT_MAC_USE_COCOA
|
|
|
|
#ifdef QWIDGET_EXTRA_DEBUG
|
|
|
|
static int count = 0;
|
|
|
|
qDebug() << "widgets" << ++count;
|
|
|
|
#endif
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
QWidgetPrivate::~QWidgetPrivate()
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
if (widgetItem)
|
|
|
|
widgetItem->wid = 0;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
if (extra)
|
|
|
|
deleteExtra();
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
#ifndef QT_NO_GRAPHICSEFFECT
|
|
|
|
delete graphicsEffect;
|
|
|
|
#endif //QT_NO_GRAPHICSEFFECT
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
class QDummyWindowSurface : public QWindowSurface
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
public:
|
|
|
|
QDummyWindowSurface(QWidget *window) : QWindowSurface(window) {}
|
|
|
|
QPaintDevice *paintDevice() { return window(); }
|
|
|
|
void flush(QWidget *, const QRegion &, const QPoint &) {}
|
|
|
|
};
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
QWindowSurface *QWidgetPrivate::createDefaultWindowSurface()
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
Q_Q(QWidget);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
QWindowSurface *surface;
|
|
|
|
#ifndef QT_NO_PROPERTIES
|
|
|
|
if (q->property("_q_DummyWindowSurface").toBool()) {
|
|
|
|
surface = new QDummyWindowSurface(q);
|
|
|
|
} else
|
|
|
|
#endif
|
|
|
|
{
|
2016-06-21 16:52:02 +00:00
|
|
|
if (QApplicationPrivate::graphics_system)
|
|
|
|
surface = QApplicationPrivate::graphics_system->createWindowSurface(q);
|
2015-12-10 05:06:13 +02:00
|
|
|
else
|
|
|
|
surface = createDefaultWindowSurface_sys();
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
return surface;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/*!
|
|
|
|
\internal
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
void QWidgetPrivate::scrollChildren(int dx, int dy)
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
Q_Q(QWidget);
|
|
|
|
if (q->children().size() > 0) { // scroll children
|
|
|
|
QPoint pd(dx, dy);
|
|
|
|
QObjectList childObjects = q->children();
|
|
|
|
for (int i = 0; i < childObjects.size(); ++i) { // move all children
|
|
|
|
QWidget *w = qobject_cast<QWidget*>(childObjects.at(i));
|
|
|
|
if (w && !w->isWindow()) {
|
|
|
|
QPoint oldp = w->pos();
|
|
|
|
QRect r(w->pos() + pd, w->size());
|
|
|
|
w->data->crect = r;
|
|
|
|
if (w->testAttribute(Qt::WA_WState_Created))
|
|
|
|
w->d_func()->setWSGeometry();
|
|
|
|
w->d_func()->setDirtyOpaqueRegion();
|
|
|
|
QMoveEvent e(r.topLeft(), oldp);
|
|
|
|
QApplication::sendEvent(w, &e);
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
#ifndef QT_NO_IM
|
|
|
|
QInputContext *QWidgetPrivate::assignedInputContext() const
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
const QWidget *widget = q_func();
|
|
|
|
while (widget) {
|
|
|
|
if (QInputContext *qic = widget->d_func()->ic)
|
|
|
|
return qic;
|
|
|
|
widget = widget->parentWidget();
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
return 0;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
QInputContext *QWidgetPrivate::inputContext() const
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
if (QInputContext *qic = assignedInputContext())
|
|
|
|
return qic;
|
|
|
|
return qApp->inputContext();
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/*!
|
|
|
|
This function returns the QInputContext for this widget. By
|
|
|
|
default the input context is inherited from the widgets
|
|
|
|
parent. For toplevels it is inherited from QApplication.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
You can override this and set a special input context for this
|
|
|
|
widget by using the setInputContext() method.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
\sa setInputContext()
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
QInputContext *QWidget::inputContext()
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
Q_D(QWidget);
|
|
|
|
if (!testAttribute(Qt::WA_InputMethodEnabled))
|
|
|
|
return 0;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
return d->inputContext();
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/*!
|
|
|
|
This function sets the input context \a context
|
|
|
|
on this widget.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Qt takes ownership of the given input \a context.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
\sa inputContext()
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
void QWidget::setInputContext(QInputContext *context)
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
Q_D(QWidget);
|
|
|
|
if (!testAttribute(Qt::WA_InputMethodEnabled))
|
|
|
|
return;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
if (context == d->ic)
|
|
|
|
return;
|
|
|
|
if (d->ic)
|
|
|
|
delete d->ic;
|
|
|
|
d->ic = context;
|
|
|
|
if (d->ic)
|
|
|
|
d->ic->setParent(this);
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
#endif // QT_NO_IM
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/*!
|
|
|
|
\obsolete
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
This function can be called on the widget that currently has focus
|
|
|
|
to reset the input method operating on it.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
This function is providing for convenience, instead you should use
|
|
|
|
\l{QInputContext::}{reset()} on the input context that was
|
|
|
|
returned by inputContext().
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
\sa QInputContext, inputContext(), QInputContext::reset()
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
void QWidget::resetInputContext()
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
if (!hasFocus())
|
|
|
|
return;
|
|
|
|
#ifndef QT_NO_IM
|
|
|
|
QInputContext *qic = this->inputContext();
|
|
|
|
if(qic)
|
|
|
|
qic->reset();
|
|
|
|
#endif // QT_NO_IM
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
#ifdef QT_KEYPAD_NAVIGATION
|
|
|
|
QPointer<QWidget> QWidgetPrivate::editingWidget;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/*!
|
|
|
|
Returns true if this widget currently has edit focus; otherwise false.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
This feature is only available in Qt for Embedded Linux.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
\sa setEditFocus(), QApplication::keypadNavigationEnabled()
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
bool QWidget::hasEditFocus() const
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
const QWidget* w = this;
|
|
|
|
while (w->d_func()->extra && w->d_func()->extra->focus_proxy)
|
|
|
|
w = w->d_func()->extra->focus_proxy;
|
|
|
|
return QWidgetPrivate::editingWidget == w;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/*!
|
|
|
|
\fn void QWidget::setEditFocus(bool enable)
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
If \a enable is true, make this widget have edit focus, in which
|
|
|
|
case Qt::Key_Up and Qt::Key_Down will be delivered to the widget
|
|
|
|
normally; otherwise, Qt::Key_Up and Qt::Key_Down are used to
|
|
|
|
change focus.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
This feature is only available in Qt for Embedded Linux and Qt
|
|
|
|
for Symbian.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
\sa hasEditFocus(), QApplication::keypadNavigationEnabled()
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
void QWidget::setEditFocus(bool on)
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
QWidget *f = this;
|
|
|
|
while (f->d_func()->extra && f->d_func()->extra->focus_proxy)
|
|
|
|
f = f->d_func()->extra->focus_proxy;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
if (QWidgetPrivate::editingWidget && QWidgetPrivate::editingWidget != f)
|
|
|
|
QWidgetPrivate::editingWidget->setEditFocus(false);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
if (on && !f->hasFocus())
|
|
|
|
f->setFocus();
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
if ((!on && !QWidgetPrivate::editingWidget)
|
|
|
|
|| (on && QWidgetPrivate::editingWidget == f)) {
|
|
|
|
return;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
if (!on && QWidgetPrivate::editingWidget == f) {
|
|
|
|
QWidgetPrivate::editingWidget = 0;
|
|
|
|
QEvent event(QEvent::LeaveEditFocus);
|
|
|
|
QApplication::sendEvent(f, &event);
|
|
|
|
QApplication::sendEvent(f->style(), &event);
|
|
|
|
} else if (on) {
|
|
|
|
QWidgetPrivate::editingWidget = f;
|
|
|
|
QEvent event(QEvent::EnterEditFocus);
|
|
|
|
QApplication::sendEvent(f, &event);
|
|
|
|
QApplication::sendEvent(f->style(), &event);
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
#endif
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/*!
|
|
|
|
\property QWidget::autoFillBackground
|
|
|
|
\brief whether the widget background is filled automatically
|
|
|
|
\since 4.1
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
If enabled, this property will cause Qt to fill the background of the
|
|
|
|
widget before invoking the paint event. The color used is defined by the
|
|
|
|
QPalette::Window color role from the widget's \l{QPalette}{palette}.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
In addition, Windows are always filled with QPalette::Window, unless the
|
|
|
|
WA_OpaquePaintEvent or WA_NoSystemBackground attributes are set.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
This property cannot be turned off (i.e., set to false) if a widget's
|
|
|
|
parent has a static gradient for its background.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
\warning Use this property with caution in conjunction with
|
|
|
|
\l{Qt Style Sheets}. When a widget has a style sheet with a valid
|
|
|
|
background or a border-image, this property is automatically disabled.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
By default, this property is false.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
\sa Qt::WA_OpaquePaintEvent, Qt::WA_NoSystemBackground,
|
|
|
|
{QWidget#Transparency and Double Buffering}{Transparency and Double Buffering}
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
bool QWidget::autoFillBackground() const
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
Q_D(const QWidget);
|
|
|
|
return d->extra && d->extra->autoFillBackground;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
void QWidget::setAutoFillBackground(bool enabled)
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
Q_D(QWidget);
|
|
|
|
if (!d->extra)
|
|
|
|
d->createExtra();
|
|
|
|
if (d->extra->autoFillBackground == enabled)
|
|
|
|
return;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
d->extra->autoFillBackground = enabled;
|
|
|
|
d->updateIsOpaque();
|
|
|
|
update();
|
|
|
|
d->updateIsOpaque();
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/*!
|
|
|
|
\class QWidget
|
|
|
|
\brief The QWidget class is the base class of all user interface objects.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
\ingroup basicwidgets
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
The widget is the atom of the user interface: it receives mouse, keyboard
|
|
|
|
and other events from the window system, and paints a representation of
|
|
|
|
itself on the screen. Every widget is rectangular, and they are sorted in a
|
|
|
|
Z-order. A widget is clipped by its parent and by the widgets in front of
|
|
|
|
it.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
A widget that is not embedded in a parent widget is called a window.
|
|
|
|
Usually, windows have a frame and a title bar, although it is also possible
|
|
|
|
to create windows without such decoration using suitable
|
|
|
|
\l{Qt::WindowFlags}{window flags}). In Qt, QMainWindow and the various
|
|
|
|
subclasses of QDialog are the most common window types.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Every widget's constructor accepts one or two standard arguments:
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
\list 1
|
|
|
|
\i \c{QWidget *parent = 0} is the parent of the new widget. If it is 0
|
|
|
|
(the default), the new widget will be a window. If not, it will be
|
|
|
|
a child of \e parent, and be constrained by \e parent's geometry
|
|
|
|
(unless you specify Qt::Window as window flag).
|
|
|
|
\i \c{Qt::WindowFlags f = 0} (where available) sets the window flags;
|
|
|
|
the default is suitable for almost all widgets, but to get, for
|
|
|
|
example, a window without a window system frame, you must use
|
|
|
|
special flags.
|
|
|
|
\endlist
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
QWidget has many member functions, but some of them have little direct
|
|
|
|
functionality; for example, QWidget has a font property, but never uses
|
|
|
|
this itself. There are many subclasses which provide real functionality,
|
|
|
|
such as QLabel, QPushButton, QListWidget, and QTabWidget.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
\section1 Top-Level and Child Widgets
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
A widget without a parent widget is always an independent window (top-level
|
|
|
|
widget). For these widgets, setWindowTitle() and setWindowIcon() set the
|
|
|
|
title bar and icon respectively.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Non-window widgets are child widgets, displayed within their parent
|
|
|
|
widgets. Most widgets in Qt are mainly useful as child widgets. For
|
|
|
|
example, it is possible to display a button as a top-level window, but most
|
|
|
|
people prefer to put their buttons inside other widgets, such as QDialog.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
\image parent-child-widgets.png A parent widget containing various child widgets.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
The diagram above shows a QGroupBox widget being used to hold various child
|
|
|
|
widgets in a layout provided by QGridLayout. The QLabel child widgets have
|
|
|
|
been outlined to indicate their full sizes.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
If you want to use a QWidget to hold child widgets you will usually want to
|
|
|
|
add a layout to the parent QWidget. See \l{Layout Management} for more
|
|
|
|
information.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
\section1 Composite Widgets
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
When a widget is used as a container to group a number of child widgets, it
|
|
|
|
is known as a composite widget. These can be created by constructing a
|
|
|
|
widget with the required visual properties - a QFrame, for example - and
|
|
|
|
adding child widgets to it, usually managed by a layout. The above diagram
|
|
|
|
shows such a composite widget that was created using \l{Qt Designer}.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Composite widgets can also be created by subclassing a standard widget,
|
|
|
|
such as QWidget or QFrame, and adding the necessary layout and child
|
|
|
|
widgets in the constructor of the subclass. Many of the \l{Qt Examples}
|
|
|
|
{examples provided with Qt} use this approach, and it is also covered in
|
|
|
|
the Qt \l{Tutorials}.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
\section1 Custom Widgets and Painting
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Since QWidget is a subclass of QPaintDevice, subclasses can be used to
|
|
|
|
display custom content that is composed using a series of painting
|
|
|
|
operations with an instance of the QPainter class. This approach contrasts
|
|
|
|
with the canvas-style approach used by the \l{Graphics View}
|
|
|
|
{Graphics View Framework} where items are added to a scene by the
|
|
|
|
application and are rendered by the framework itself.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Each widget performs all painting operations from within its paintEvent()
|
|
|
|
function. This is called whenever the widget needs to be redrawn, either
|
|
|
|
as a result of some external change or when requested by the application.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
The \l{widgets/analogclock}{Analog Clock example} shows how a simple widget
|
|
|
|
can handle paint events.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
\section1 Size Hints and Size Policies
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
When implementing a new widget, it is almost always useful to reimplement
|
|
|
|
sizeHint() to provide a reasonable default size for the widget and to set
|
|
|
|
the correct size policy with setSizePolicy().
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
By default, composite widgets which do not provide a size hint will be
|
|
|
|
sized according to the space requirements of their child widgets.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
The size policy lets you supply good default behavior for the layout
|
|
|
|
management system, so that other widgets can contain and manage yours
|
|
|
|
easily. The default size policy indicates that the size hint represents
|
|
|
|
the preferred size of the widget, and this is often good enough for many
|
|
|
|
widgets.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
\note The size of top-level widgets are constrained to 2/3 of the desktop's
|
|
|
|
height and width. You can resize() the widget manually if these bounds are
|
|
|
|
inadequate.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
\section1 Events
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Widgets respond to events that are typically caused by user actions. Qt
|
|
|
|
delivers events to widgets by calling specific event handler functions with
|
|
|
|
instances of QEvent subclasses containing information about each event.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
If your widget only contains child widgets, you probably do not need to
|
|
|
|
implement any event handlers. If you want to detect a mouse click in a
|
|
|
|
child widget call the child's underMouse() function inside the widget's
|
|
|
|
mousePressEvent().
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
The \l{widgets/scribble}{Scribble example} implements a wider set of
|
|
|
|
events to handle mouse movement, button presses, and window resizing.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
You will need to supply the behavior and content for your own widgets, but
|
|
|
|
here is a brief overview of the events that are relevant to QWidget,
|
|
|
|
starting with the most common ones:
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
\list
|
|
|
|
\i paintEvent() is called whenever the widget needs to be repainted.
|
|
|
|
Every widget displaying custom content must implement it. Painting
|
|
|
|
using a QPainter can only take place in a paintEvent() or a
|
|
|
|
function called by a paintEvent().
|
|
|
|
\i resizeEvent() is called when the widget has been resized.
|
|
|
|
\i mousePressEvent() is called when a mouse button is pressed while
|
|
|
|
the mouse cursor is inside the widget, or when the widget has
|
|
|
|
grabbed the mouse using grabMouse(). Pressing the mouse without
|
|
|
|
releasing it is effectively the same as calling grabMouse().
|
|
|
|
\i mouseReleaseEvent() is called when a mouse button is released. A
|
|
|
|
widget receives mouse release events when it has received the
|
|
|
|
corresponding mouse press event. This means that if the user
|
|
|
|
presses the mouse inside \e your widget, then drags the mouse
|
|
|
|
somewhere else before releasing the mouse button, \e your widget
|
|
|
|
receives the release event. There is one exception: if a popup menu
|
|
|
|
appears while the mouse button is held down, this popup immediately
|
|
|
|
steals the mouse events.
|
|
|
|
\i mouseDoubleClickEvent() is called when the user double-clicks in
|
|
|
|
the widget. If the user double-clicks, the widget receives a mouse
|
|
|
|
press event, a mouse release event and finally this event instead
|
|
|
|
of a second mouse press event. (Some mouse move events may also be
|
|
|
|
received if the mouse is not held steady during this operation.) It
|
|
|
|
is \e{not possible} to distinguish a click from a double-click
|
|
|
|
until the second click arrives. (This is one reason why most GUI
|
|
|
|
books recommend that double-clicks be an extension of
|
|
|
|
single-clicks, rather than trigger a different action.)
|
|
|
|
\endlist
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Widgets that accept keyboard input need to reimplement a few more event
|
|
|
|
handlers:
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
\list
|
|
|
|
\i keyPressEvent() is called whenever a key is pressed, and again when
|
|
|
|
a key has been held down long enough for it to auto-repeat. The
|
|
|
|
\key Tab and \key Shift+Tab keys are only passed to the widget if
|
|
|
|
they are not used by the focus-change mechanisms. To force those
|
|
|
|
keys to be processed by your widget, you must reimplement
|
|
|
|
QWidget::event().
|
|
|
|
\i focusInEvent() is called when the widget gains keyboard focus
|
|
|
|
(assuming you have called setFocusPolicy()). Well-behaved widgets
|
|
|
|
indicate that they own the keyboard focus in a clear but discreet
|
|
|
|
way.
|
|
|
|
\i focusOutEvent() is called when the widget loses keyboard focus.
|
|
|
|
\endlist
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
You may be required to also reimplement some of the less common event
|
|
|
|
handlers:
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
\list
|
|
|
|
\i mouseMoveEvent() is called whenever the mouse moves while a mouse
|
|
|
|
button is held down. This can be useful during drag and drop
|
|
|
|
operations. If you call \l{setMouseTracking()}{setMouseTracking}(true),
|
|
|
|
you get mouse move events even when no buttons are held down.
|
|
|
|
(See also the \l{Drag and Drop} guide.)
|
|
|
|
\i keyReleaseEvent() is called whenever a key is released and while it
|
|
|
|
is held down (if the key is auto-repeating). In that case, the
|
|
|
|
widget will receive a pair of key release and key press event for
|
|
|
|
every repeat. The \key Tab and \key Shift+Tab keys are only passed
|
|
|
|
to the widget if they are not used by the focus-change mechanisms.
|
|
|
|
To force those keys to be processed by your widget, you must
|
|
|
|
reimplement QWidget::event().
|
|
|
|
\i wheelEvent() is called whenever the user turns the mouse wheel
|
|
|
|
while the widget has the focus.
|
|
|
|
\i enterEvent() is called when the mouse enters the widget's screen
|
|
|
|
space. (This excludes screen space owned by any of the widget's
|
|
|
|
children.)
|
|
|
|
\i leaveEvent() is called when the mouse leaves the widget's screen
|
|
|
|
space. If the mouse enters a child widget it will not cause a
|
|
|
|
leaveEvent().
|
|
|
|
\i moveEvent() is called when the widget has been moved relative to
|
|
|
|
its parent.
|
|
|
|
\i closeEvent() is called when the user closes the widget (or when
|
|
|
|
close() is called).
|
|
|
|
\endlist
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
There are also some rather obscure events described in the documentation
|
|
|
|
for QEvent::Type. To handle these events, you need to reimplement event()
|
|
|
|
directly.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
The default implementation of event() handles \key Tab and \key Shift+Tab
|
|
|
|
(to move the keyboard focus), and passes on most of the other events to
|
|
|
|
one of the more specialized handlers above.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Events and the mechanism used to deliver them are covered in
|
|
|
|
\l{The Event System}.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
\section1 Groups of Functions and Properties
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
\table
|
|
|
|
\header \i Context \i Functions and Properties
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
\row \i Window functions \i
|
|
|
|
show(),
|
|
|
|
hide(),
|
|
|
|
raise(),
|
|
|
|
lower(),
|
|
|
|
close().
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
\row \i Top-level windows \i
|
|
|
|
\l windowModified, \l windowTitle, \l windowIcon, \l windowIconText,
|
|
|
|
\l isActiveWindow, activateWindow(), \l minimized, showMinimized(),
|
|
|
|
\l maximized, showMaximized(), \l fullScreen, showFullScreen(),
|
|
|
|
showNormal().
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
\row \i Window contents \i
|
|
|
|
update(),
|
|
|
|
repaint(),
|
|
|
|
scroll().
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
\row \i Geometry \i
|
|
|
|
\l pos, x(), y(), \l rect, \l size, width(), height(), move(), resize(),
|
|
|
|
\l sizePolicy, sizeHint(), minimumSizeHint(),
|
|
|
|
updateGeometry(), layout(),
|
|
|
|
\l frameGeometry, \l geometry, \l childrenRect, \l childrenRegion,
|
|
|
|
adjustSize(),
|
|
|
|
mapFromGlobal(), mapToGlobal(),
|
|
|
|
mapFromParent(), mapToParent(),
|
|
|
|
\l maximumSize, \l minimumSize, \l sizeIncrement,
|
|
|
|
\l baseSize, setFixedSize()
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
\row \i Mode \i
|
|
|
|
\l visible, isVisibleTo(),
|
|
|
|
\l enabled, isEnabledTo(),
|
|
|
|
\l modal,
|
|
|
|
isWindow(),
|
|
|
|
\l mouseTracking,
|
|
|
|
\l updatesEnabled,
|
|
|
|
visibleRegion().
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
\row \i Look and feel \i
|
|
|
|
style(),
|
|
|
|
setStyle(),
|
|
|
|
\l styleSheet,
|
|
|
|
\l cursor,
|
|
|
|
\l font,
|
|
|
|
\l palette,
|
|
|
|
backgroundRole(), setBackgroundRole(),
|
|
|
|
fontInfo(), fontMetrics().
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
\row \i Keyboard focus functions \i
|
|
|
|
\l focus, \l focusPolicy,
|
|
|
|
setFocus(), clearFocus(), setTabOrder(), setFocusProxy(),
|
|
|
|
focusNextChild(), focusPreviousChild().
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
\row \i Mouse and keyboard grabbing \i
|
|
|
|
grabMouse(), releaseMouse(),
|
|
|
|
grabKeyboard(), releaseKeyboard(),
|
|
|
|
mouseGrabber(), keyboardGrabber().
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
\row \i Event handlers \i
|
|
|
|
event(),
|
|
|
|
mousePressEvent(),
|
|
|
|
mouseReleaseEvent(),
|
|
|
|
mouseDoubleClickEvent(),
|
|
|
|
mouseMoveEvent(),
|
|
|
|
keyPressEvent(),
|
|
|
|
keyReleaseEvent(),
|
|
|
|
focusInEvent(),
|
|
|
|
focusOutEvent(),
|
|
|
|
wheelEvent(),
|
|
|
|
enterEvent(),
|
|
|
|
leaveEvent(),
|
|
|
|
paintEvent(),
|
|
|
|
moveEvent(),
|
|
|
|
resizeEvent(),
|
|
|
|
closeEvent(),
|
|
|
|
dragEnterEvent(),
|
|
|
|
dragMoveEvent(),
|
|
|
|
dragLeaveEvent(),
|
|
|
|
dropEvent(),
|
|
|
|
childEvent(),
|
|
|
|
showEvent(),
|
|
|
|
hideEvent(),
|
|
|
|
customEvent().
|
|
|
|
changeEvent(),
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
\row \i System functions \i
|
|
|
|
parentWidget(), window(), setParent(), winId(),
|
|
|
|
find(), metric().
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
\row \i Interactive help \i
|
|
|
|
setToolTip(), setWhatsThis()
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
\endtable
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
\section1 Widget Style Sheets
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
In addition to the standard widget styles for each platform, widgets can
|
|
|
|
also be styled according to rules specified in a \l{styleSheet}
|
|
|
|
{style sheet}. This feature enables you to customize the appearance of
|
|
|
|
specific widgets to provide visual cues to users about their purpose. For
|
|
|
|
example, a button could be styled in a particular way to indicate that it
|
|
|
|
performs a destructive action.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
The use of widget style sheets is described in more detail in the
|
|
|
|
\l{Qt Style Sheets} document.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
\section1 Transparency and Double Buffering
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Since Qt 4.0, QWidget automatically double-buffers its painting, so there
|
|
|
|
is no need to write double-buffering code in paintEvent() to avoid
|
|
|
|
flicker.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Since Qt 4.1, the Qt::WA_ContentsPropagated widget attribute has been
|
|
|
|
deprecated. Instead, the contents of parent widgets are propagated by
|
|
|
|
default to each of their children as long as Qt::WA_PaintOnScreen is not
|
|
|
|
set. Custom widgets can be written to take advantage of this feature by
|
|
|
|
updating irregular regions (to create non-rectangular child widgets), or
|
|
|
|
painting with colors that have less than full alpha component. The
|
|
|
|
following diagram shows how attributes and properties of a custom widget
|
|
|
|
can be fine-tuned to achieve different effects.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
\image propagation-custom.png
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
In the above diagram, a semi-transparent rectangular child widget with an
|
|
|
|
area removed is constructed and added to a parent widget (a QLabel showing
|
|
|
|
a pixmap). Then, different properties and widget attributes are set to
|
|
|
|
achieve different effects:
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
\list
|
|
|
|
\i The left widget has no additional properties or widget attributes
|
|
|
|
set. This default state suits most custom widgets using
|
|
|
|
transparency, are irregularly-shaped, or do not paint over their
|
|
|
|
entire area with an opaque brush.
|
|
|
|
\i The center widget has the \l autoFillBackground property set. This
|
|
|
|
property is used with custom widgets that rely on the widget to
|
|
|
|
supply a default background, and do not paint over their entire
|
|
|
|
area with an opaque brush.
|
|
|
|
\i The right widget has the Qt::WA_OpaquePaintEvent widget attribute
|
|
|
|
set. This indicates that the widget will paint over its entire area
|
|
|
|
with opaque colors. The widget's area will initially be
|
|
|
|
\e{uninitialized}, represented in the diagram with a red diagonal
|
|
|
|
grid pattern that shines through the overpainted area. The
|
|
|
|
Qt::WA_OpaquePaintArea attribute is useful for widgets that need to
|
|
|
|
paint their own specialized contents quickly and do not need a
|
|
|
|
default filled background.
|
|
|
|
\endlist
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
To rapidly update custom widgets with simple background colors, such as
|
|
|
|
real-time plotting or graphing widgets, it is better to define a suitable
|
|
|
|
background color (using setBackgroundRole() with the
|
|
|
|
QPalette::Window role), set the \l autoFillBackground property, and only
|
|
|
|
implement the necessary drawing functionality in the widget's paintEvent().
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
To rapidly update custom widgets that constantly paint over their entire
|
|
|
|
areas with opaque content, e.g., video streaming widgets, it is better to
|
|
|
|
set the widget's Qt::WA_OpaquePaintEvent, avoiding any unnecessary overhead
|
|
|
|
associated with repainting the widget's background.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
If a widget has both the Qt::WA_OpaquePaintEvent widget attribute \e{and}
|
|
|
|
the \l autoFillBackground property set, the Qt::WA_OpaquePaintEvent
|
|
|
|
attribute takes precedence. Depending on your requirements, you should
|
|
|
|
choose either one of them.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Since Qt 4.1, the contents of parent widgets are also propagated to
|
|
|
|
standard Qt widgets. This can lead to some unexpected results if the
|
|
|
|
parent widget is decorated in a non-standard way, as shown in the diagram
|
|
|
|
below.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
\image propagation-standard.png
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
The scope for customizing the painting behavior of standard Qt widgets,
|
|
|
|
without resorting to subclassing, is slightly less than that possible for
|
|
|
|
custom widgets. Usually, the desired appearance of a standard widget can be
|
|
|
|
achieved by setting its \l autoFillBackground property.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
\section1 Creating Translucent Windows
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Since Qt 4.5, it has been possible to create windows with translucent regions
|
|
|
|
on window systems that support compositing.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
To enable this feature in a top-level widget, set its Qt::WA_TranslucentBackground
|
|
|
|
attribute with setAttribute() and ensure that its background is painted with
|
|
|
|
non-opaque colors in the regions you want to be partially transparent.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Platform notes:
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
\list
|
|
|
|
\o X11: This feature relies on the use of an X server that supports ARGB visuals
|
|
|
|
and a compositing window manager.
|
|
|
|
\o Windows: The widget needs to have the Qt::FramelessWindowHint window flag set
|
|
|
|
for the translucency to work.
|
|
|
|
\endlist
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
\section1 Native Widgets vs Alien Widgets
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Introduced in Qt 4.4, alien widgets are widgets unknown to the windowing
|
|
|
|
system. They do not have a native window handle associated with them. This
|
|
|
|
feature significantly speeds up widget painting, resizing, and removes flicker.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Should you require the old behavior with native windows, you can choose
|
|
|
|
one of the following options:
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
\list 1
|
|
|
|
\i Use the \c{QT_USE_NATIVE_WINDOWS=1} in your environment.
|
|
|
|
\i Set the Qt::AA_NativeWindows attribute on your application. All
|
|
|
|
widgets will be native widgets.
|
|
|
|
\i Set the Qt::WA_NativeWindow attribute on widgets: The widget itself
|
|
|
|
and all of its ancestors will become native (unless
|
|
|
|
Qt::WA_DontCreateNativeAncestors is set).
|
|
|
|
\i Call QWidget::winId to enforce a native window (this implies 3).
|
|
|
|
\i Set the Qt::WA_PaintOnScreen attribute to enforce a native window
|
|
|
|
(this implies 3).
|
|
|
|
\endlist
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
\sa QEvent, QPainter, QGridLayout, QBoxLayout
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
\section1 Softkeys
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Since Qt 4.6, Softkeys are usually physical keys on a device that have a corresponding label or
|
|
|
|
other visual representation on the screen that is generally located next to its
|
|
|
|
physical counterpart. They are most often found on mobile phone platforms. In
|
|
|
|
modern touch based user interfaces it is also possible to have softkeys that do
|
|
|
|
not correspond to any physical keys. Softkeys differ from other onscreen labels
|
|
|
|
in that they are contextual.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
In Qt, contextual softkeys are added to a widget by calling addAction() and
|
|
|
|
passing a \c QAction with a softkey role set on it. When the widget
|
|
|
|
containing the softkey actions has focus, its softkeys should appear in
|
|
|
|
the user interface. Softkeys are discovered by traversing the widget
|
|
|
|
hierarchy so it is possible to define a single set of softkeys that are
|
|
|
|
present at all times by calling addAction() for a given top level widget.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
On some platforms, this concept overlaps with \c QMenuBar such that if no
|
|
|
|
other softkeys are found and the top level widget is a QMainWindow containing
|
|
|
|
a QMenuBar, the menubar actions may appear on one of the softkeys.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Note: Currently softkeys are only supported on the Symbian Platform.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
\sa addAction(), QAction, QMenuBar
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
QWidgetMapper *QWidgetPrivate::mapper = 0; // widget with wid
|
|
|
|
QWidgetSet *QWidgetPrivate::allWidgets = 0; // widgets with no wid
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/*****************************************************************************
|
|
|
|
QWidget utility functions
|
|
|
|
*****************************************************************************/
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
QRegion qt_dirtyRegion(QWidget *widget)
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
if (!widget)
|
|
|
|
return QRegion();
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
QWidgetBackingStore *bs = qt_widget_private(widget)->maybeBackingStore();
|
|
|
|
if (!bs)
|
|
|
|
return QRegion();
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
return bs->dirtyRegion(widget);
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/*****************************************************************************
|
|
|
|
QWidget member functions
|
|
|
|
*****************************************************************************/
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
|
|
Widget state flags:
|
|
|
|
\list
|
|
|
|
\i Qt::WA_WState_Created The widget has a valid winId().
|
|
|
|
\i Qt::WA_WState_Visible The widget is currently visible.
|
|
|
|
\i Qt::WA_WState_Hidden The widget is hidden, i.e. it won't
|
|
|
|
become visible unless you call show() on it. Qt::WA_WState_Hidden
|
|
|
|
implies !Qt::WA_WState_Visible.
|
|
|
|
\i Qt::WA_WState_CompressKeys Compress keyboard events.
|
|
|
|
\i Qt::WA_WState_BlockUpdates Repaints and updates are disabled.
|
|
|
|
\i Qt::WA_WState_InPaintEvent Currently processing a paint event.
|
|
|
|
\i Qt::WA_WState_Reparented The widget has been reparented.
|
|
|
|
\i Qt::WA_WState_ConfigPending A configuration (resize/move) event is pending.
|
|
|
|
\i Qt::WA_WState_DND (Deprecated) The widget supports drag and drop, see setAcceptDrops().
|
|
|
|
\endlist
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
struct QWidgetExceptionCleaner
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
/* this cleans up when the constructor throws an exception */
|
|
|
|
static inline void cleanup(QWidget *that, QWidgetPrivate *d)
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
#ifdef QT_NO_EXCEPTIONS
|
|
|
|
Q_UNUSED(that);
|
|
|
|
Q_UNUSED(d);
|
|
|
|
#else
|
|
|
|
QWidgetPrivate::allWidgets->remove(that);
|
|
|
|
if (d->focus_next != that) {
|
|
|
|
if (d->focus_next)
|
|
|
|
d->focus_next->d_func()->focus_prev = d->focus_prev;
|
|
|
|
if (d->focus_prev)
|
|
|
|
d->focus_prev->d_func()->focus_next = d->focus_next;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
#endif
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
};
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/*!
|
|
|
|
Constructs a widget which is a child of \a parent, with widget
|
|
|
|
flags set to \a f.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
If \a parent is 0, the new widget becomes a window. If
|
|
|
|
\a parent is another widget, this widget becomes a child window
|
|
|
|
inside \a parent. The new widget is deleted when its \a parent is
|
|
|
|
deleted.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
The widget flags argument, \a f, is normally 0, but it can be set
|
|
|
|
to customize the frame of a window (i.e. \a
|
|
|
|
parent must be 0). To customize the frame, use a value composed
|
|
|
|
from the bitwise OR of any of the \l{Qt::WindowFlags}{window flags}.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
If you add a child widget to an already visible widget you must
|
|
|
|
explicitly show the child to make it visible.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Note that the X11 version of Qt may not be able to deliver all
|
|
|
|
combinations of style flags on all systems. This is because on
|
|
|
|
X11, Qt can only ask the window manager, and the window manager
|
|
|
|
can override the application's settings. On Windows, Qt can set
|
|
|
|
whatever flags you want.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
\sa windowFlags
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
QWidget::QWidget(QWidget *parent, Qt::WindowFlags f)
|
|
|
|
: QObject(*new QWidgetPrivate, 0), QPaintDevice()
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
QT_TRY {
|
|
|
|
d_func()->init(parent, f);
|
|
|
|
} QT_CATCH(...) {
|
|
|
|
QWidgetExceptionCleaner::cleanup(this, d_func());
|
|
|
|
QT_RETHROW;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/*! \internal
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
QWidget::QWidget(QWidgetPrivate &dd, QWidget* parent, Qt::WindowFlags f)
|
|
|
|
: QObject(dd, 0), QPaintDevice()
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
Q_D(QWidget);
|
|
|
|
QT_TRY {
|
|
|
|
d->init(parent, f);
|
|
|
|
} QT_CATCH(...) {
|
|
|
|
QWidgetExceptionCleaner::cleanup(this, d_func());
|
|
|
|
QT_RETHROW;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/*!
|
|
|
|
\internal
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
int QWidget::devType() const
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
return QInternal::Widget;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
//### w is a "this" ptr, passed as a param because QWorkspace needs special logic
|
|
|
|
void QWidgetPrivate::adjustFlags(Qt::WindowFlags &flags, QWidget *w)
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
bool customize = (flags & (Qt::CustomizeWindowHint
|
|
|
|
| Qt::FramelessWindowHint
|
|
|
|
| Qt::WindowTitleHint
|
|
|
|
| Qt::WindowSystemMenuHint
|
|
|
|
| Qt::WindowMinimizeButtonHint
|
|
|
|
| Qt::WindowMaximizeButtonHint
|
|
|
|
| Qt::WindowCloseButtonHint
|
|
|
|
| Qt::WindowContextHelpButtonHint));
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
uint type = (flags & Qt::WindowType_Mask);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
if ((type == Qt::Widget || type == Qt::SubWindow) && w && !w->parent()) {
|
|
|
|
type = Qt::Window;
|
|
|
|
flags |= Qt::Window;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
if (flags & Qt::CustomizeWindowHint) {
|
|
|
|
// modify window flags to make them consistent.
|
|
|
|
// Only enable this on non-Mac platforms. Since the old way of doing this would
|
|
|
|
// interpret WindowSystemMenuHint as a close button and we can't change that behavior
|
|
|
|
// we can't just add this in.
|
|
|
|
#ifndef Q_WS_MAC
|
|
|
|
if (flags & (Qt::WindowMinMaxButtonsHint | Qt::WindowCloseButtonHint | Qt::WindowContextHelpButtonHint)) {
|
|
|
|
flags |= Qt::WindowSystemMenuHint;
|
|
|
|
#else
|
|
|
|
if (flags & (Qt::WindowMinMaxButtonsHint | Qt::WindowCloseButtonHint
|
|
|
|
| Qt::WindowSystemMenuHint)) {
|
|
|
|
#endif
|
|
|
|
flags |= Qt::WindowTitleHint;
|
|
|
|
flags &= ~Qt::FramelessWindowHint;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
} else if (customize && !(flags & Qt::FramelessWindowHint)) {
|
|
|
|
// if any of the window hints that affect the titlebar are set
|
|
|
|
// and the window is supposed to have frame, we add a titlebar
|
|
|
|
// and system menu by default.
|
|
|
|
flags |= Qt::WindowSystemMenuHint;
|
|
|
|
flags |= Qt::WindowTitleHint;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if (customize)
|
|
|
|
; // don't modify window flags if the user explicitly set them.
|
|
|
|
else if (type == Qt::Dialog || type == Qt::Sheet)
|
|
|
|
#ifndef Q_WS_WINCE
|
|
|
|
flags |= Qt::WindowTitleHint | Qt::WindowSystemMenuHint | Qt::WindowContextHelpButtonHint | Qt::WindowCloseButtonHint;
|
|
|
|
#else
|
|
|
|
flags |= Qt::WindowTitleHint | Qt::WindowSystemMenuHint | Qt::WindowCloseButtonHint;
|
|
|
|
#endif
|
|
|
|
else if (type == Qt::Tool)
|
|
|
|
flags |= Qt::WindowTitleHint | Qt::WindowSystemMenuHint | Qt::WindowCloseButtonHint;
|
|
|
|
else
|
|
|
|
flags |= Qt::WindowTitleHint | Qt::WindowSystemMenuHint | Qt::WindowMinimizeButtonHint | Qt::WindowMaximizeButtonHint | Qt::WindowCloseButtonHint;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
void QWidgetPrivate::init(QWidget *parentWidget, Qt::WindowFlags f)
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
Q_Q(QWidget);
|
|
|
|
if (QApplication::type() == QApplication::Tty)
|
|
|
|
qFatal("QWidget: Cannot create a QWidget when no GUI is being used");
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Q_ASSERT(allWidgets);
|
|
|
|
if (allWidgets)
|
|
|
|
allWidgets->insert(q);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
QWidget *desktopWidget = 0;
|
|
|
|
if (parentWidget && parentWidget->windowType() == Qt::Desktop) {
|
|
|
|
desktopWidget = parentWidget;
|
|
|
|
parentWidget = 0;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
q->data = &data;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
#ifndef QT_NO_THREAD
|
|
|
|
if (!parent) {
|
|
|
|
Q_ASSERT_X(q->thread() == qApp->thread(), "QWidget",
|
|
|
|
"Widgets must be created in the GUI thread.");
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
#endif
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
#if defined(Q_WS_X11)
|
|
|
|
if (desktopWidget) {
|
|
|
|
// make sure the widget is created on the same screen as the
|
|
|
|
// programmer specified desktop widget
|
|
|
|
xinfo = desktopWidget->d_func()->xinfo;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
#else
|
|
|
|
Q_UNUSED(desktopWidget);
|
|
|
|
#endif
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
data.fstrut_dirty = true;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
data.winid = 0;
|
|
|
|
data.widget_attributes = 0;
|
|
|
|
data.window_flags = f;
|
|
|
|
data.window_state = 0;
|
2016-07-21 13:50:52 +00:00
|
|
|
data.focus_policy = Qt::NoFocus;
|
2015-12-10 05:06:13 +02:00
|
|
|
data.context_menu_policy = Qt::DefaultContextMenu;
|
|
|
|
data.window_modality = Qt::NonModal;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
data.is_closing = 0;
|
|
|
|
data.in_show = 0;
|
|
|
|
data.in_destructor = false;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
// Widgets with Qt::MSWindowsOwnDC (typically QGLWidget) must have a window handle.
|
|
|
|
if (f & Qt::MSWindowsOwnDC)
|
|
|
|
q->setAttribute(Qt::WA_NativeWindow);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
//#ifdef Q_WS_MAC
|
|
|
|
// q->setAttribute(Qt::WA_NativeWindow);
|
|
|
|
//#endif
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
q->setAttribute(Qt::WA_QuitOnClose); // might be cleared in adjustQuitOnCloseAttribute()
|
|
|
|
adjustQuitOnCloseAttribute();
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
q->setAttribute(Qt::WA_WState_Hidden);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
//give potential windows a bigger "pre-initial" size; create_sys() will give them a new size later
|
|
|
|
data.crect = parentWidget ? QRect(0,0,100,30) : QRect(0,0,640,480);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
focus_next = focus_prev = q;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
if ((f & Qt::WindowType_Mask) == Qt::Desktop)
|
|
|
|
q->create();
|
|
|
|
else if (parentWidget)
|
|
|
|
q->setParent(parentWidget, data.window_flags);
|
|
|
|
else {
|
|
|
|
adjustFlags(data.window_flags, q);
|
|
|
|
resolveLayoutDirection();
|
|
|
|
// opaque system background?
|
|
|
|
const QBrush &background = q->palette().brush(QPalette::Window);
|
|
|
|
setOpaque(q->isWindow() && background.style() != Qt::NoBrush && background.isOpaque());
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
data.fnt = QFont(data.fnt, q);
|
|
|
|
#if defined(Q_WS_X11)
|
|
|
|
data.fnt.x11SetScreen(xinfo.screen());
|
|
|
|
#endif // Q_WS_X11
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
q->setAttribute(Qt::WA_PendingMoveEvent);
|
|
|
|
q->setAttribute(Qt::WA_PendingResizeEvent);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
if (++QWidgetPrivate::instanceCounter > QWidgetPrivate::maxInstances)
|
|
|
|
QWidgetPrivate::maxInstances = QWidgetPrivate::instanceCounter;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
if (QApplicationPrivate::app_compile_version < 0x040200
|
|
|
|
|| QApplicationPrivate::testAttribute(Qt::AA_ImmediateWidgetCreation))
|
|
|
|
q->create();
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
QEvent e(QEvent::Create);
|
|
|
|
QApplication::sendEvent(q, &e);
|
|
|
|
QApplication::postEvent(q, new QEvent(QEvent::PolishRequest));
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
extraPaintEngine = 0;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
void QWidgetPrivate::createRecursively()
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
Q_Q(QWidget);
|
|
|
|
q->create(0, true, true);
|
|
|
|
for (int i = 0; i < children.size(); ++i) {
|
|
|
|
QWidget *child = qobject_cast<QWidget *>(children.at(i));
|
|
|
|
if (child && !child->isHidden() && !child->isWindow() && !child->testAttribute(Qt::WA_WState_Created))
|
|
|
|
child->d_func()->createRecursively();
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/*!
|
|
|
|
Creates a new widget window if \a window is 0, otherwise sets the
|
|
|
|
widget's window to \a window.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Initializes the window (sets the geometry etc.) if \a
|
|
|
|
initializeWindow is true. If \a initializeWindow is false, no
|
|
|
|
initialization is performed. This parameter only makes sense if \a
|
|
|
|
window is a valid window.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Destroys the old window if \a destroyOldWindow is true. If \a
|
|
|
|
destroyOldWindow is false, you are responsible for destroying the
|
|
|
|
window yourself (using platform native code).
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
The QWidget constructor calls create(0,true,true) to create a
|
|
|
|
window for this widget.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
void QWidget::create(WId window, bool initializeWindow, bool destroyOldWindow)
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
Q_D(QWidget);
|
|
|
|
if (testAttribute(Qt::WA_WState_Created) && window == 0 && internalWinId())
|
|
|
|
return;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
if (d->data.in_destructor)
|
|
|
|
return;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Qt::WindowType type = windowType();
|
|
|
|
Qt::WindowFlags &flags = data->window_flags;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
if ((type == Qt::Widget || type == Qt::SubWindow) && !parentWidget()) {
|
|
|
|
type = Qt::Window;
|
|
|
|
flags |= Qt::Window;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
if (QWidget *parent = parentWidget()) {
|
|
|
|
if (type & Qt::Window) {
|
|
|
|
if (!parent->testAttribute(Qt::WA_WState_Created))
|
|
|
|
parent->createWinId();
|
|
|
|
} else if (testAttribute(Qt::WA_NativeWindow) && !parent->internalWinId()
|
|
|
|
&& !testAttribute(Qt::WA_DontCreateNativeAncestors)) {
|
|
|
|
// We're about to create a native child widget that doesn't have a native parent;
|
|
|
|
// enforce a native handle for the parent unless the Qt::WA_DontCreateNativeAncestors
|
|
|
|
// attribute is set.
|
|
|
|
d->createWinId(window);
|
|
|
|
// Nothing more to do.
|
|
|
|
Q_ASSERT(testAttribute(Qt::WA_WState_Created));
|
|
|
|
Q_ASSERT(internalWinId());
|
|
|
|
return;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
static int paintOnScreenEnv = -1;
|
|
|
|
if (paintOnScreenEnv == -1)
|
|
|
|
paintOnScreenEnv = qgetenv("QT_ONSCREEN_PAINT").toInt() > 0 ? 1 : 0;
|
|
|
|
if (paintOnScreenEnv == 1)
|
|
|
|
setAttribute(Qt::WA_PaintOnScreen);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
if (QApplicationPrivate::testAttribute(Qt::AA_NativeWindows))
|
|
|
|
setAttribute(Qt::WA_NativeWindow);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
#ifdef ALIEN_DEBUG
|
|
|
|
qDebug() << "QWidget::create:" << this << "parent:" << parentWidget()
|
|
|
|
<< "Alien?" << !testAttribute(Qt::WA_NativeWindow);
|
|
|
|
#endif
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
#if defined (Q_WS_WIN) && !defined(QT_NO_DRAGANDDROP)
|
|
|
|
// Unregister the dropsite (if already registered) before we
|
|
|
|
// re-create the widget with a native window.
|
|
|
|
if (testAttribute(Qt::WA_WState_Created) && !internalWinId() && testAttribute(Qt::WA_NativeWindow)
|
|
|
|
&& d->extra && d->extra->dropTarget) {
|
|
|
|
d->registerDropSite(false);
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
#endif // defined (Q_WS_WIN) && !defined(QT_NO_DRAGANDDROP)
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
d->updateIsOpaque();
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
setAttribute(Qt::WA_WState_Created); // set created flag
|
|
|
|
d->create_sys(window, initializeWindow, destroyOldWindow);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
// a real toplevel window needs a backing store
|
|
|
|
if (isWindow() && windowType() != Qt::Desktop) {
|
|
|
|
d->topData()->backingStore.destroy();
|
|
|
|
if (hasBackingStoreSupport())
|
|
|
|
d->topData()->backingStore.create(this);
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
d->setModal_sys();
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
if (!isWindow() && parentWidget() && parentWidget()->testAttribute(Qt::WA_DropSiteRegistered))
|
|
|
|
setAttribute(Qt::WA_DropSiteRegistered, true);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
// need to force the resting of the icon after changing parents
|
|
|
|
if (testAttribute(Qt::WA_SetWindowIcon))
|
|
|
|
d->setWindowIcon_sys(true);
|
|
|
|
if (isWindow() && !d->topData()->iconText.isEmpty())
|
|
|
|
d->setWindowIconText_helper(d->topData()->iconText);
|
|
|
|
if (isWindow() && !d->topData()->caption.isEmpty())
|
|
|
|
d->setWindowTitle_helper(d->topData()->caption);
|
|
|
|
if (windowType() != Qt::Desktop) {
|
|
|
|
d->updateSystemBackground();
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
if (isWindow() && !testAttribute(Qt::WA_SetWindowIcon))
|
|
|
|
d->setWindowIcon_sys();
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/*!
|
|
|
|
Destroys the widget.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
All this widget's children are deleted first. The application
|
|
|
|
exits if this widget is the main widget.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
QWidget::~QWidget()
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
Q_D(QWidget);
|
|
|
|
d->data.in_destructor = true;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
#if defined (QT_CHECK_STATE)
|
|
|
|
if (paintingActive())
|
|
|
|
qWarning("QWidget: %s (%s) deleted while being painted", className(), name());
|
|
|
|
#endif
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
#ifndef QT_NO_GESTURES
|
|
|
|
foreach (Qt::GestureType type, d->gestureContext.keys())
|
|
|
|
ungrabGesture(type);
|
|
|
|
#endif
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
// force acceptDrops false before winId is destroyed.
|
|
|
|
d->registerDropSite(false);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
#ifndef QT_NO_ACTION
|
|
|
|
// remove all actions from this widget
|
|
|
|
for (int i = 0; i < d->actions.size(); ++i) {
|
|
|
|
QActionPrivate *apriv = d->actions.at(i)->d_func();
|
|
|
|
apriv->widgets.removeAll(this);
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
d->actions.clear();
|
|
|
|
#endif
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
#ifndef QT_NO_SHORTCUT
|
|
|
|
// Remove all shortcuts grabbed by this
|
|
|
|
// widget, unless application is closing
|
|
|
|
if (!QApplicationPrivate::is_app_closing && testAttribute(Qt::WA_GrabbedShortcut))
|
|
|
|
qApp->d_func()->shortcutMap.removeShortcut(0, this, QKeySequence());
|
|
|
|
#endif
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
// delete layout while we still are a valid widget
|
|
|
|
delete d->layout;
|
|
|
|
d->layout = 0;
|
|
|
|
// Remove myself from focus list
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Q_ASSERT(d->focus_next->d_func()->focus_prev == this);
|
|
|
|
Q_ASSERT(d->focus_prev->d_func()->focus_next == this);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
if (d->focus_next != this) {
|
|
|
|
d->focus_next->d_func()->focus_prev = d->focus_prev;
|
|
|
|
d->focus_prev->d_func()->focus_next = d->focus_next;
|
|
|
|
d->focus_next = d->focus_prev = 0;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
QT_TRY {
|
|
|
|
clearFocus();
|
|
|
|
} QT_CATCH(...) {
|
|
|
|
// swallow this problem because we are in a destructor
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
d->setDirtyOpaqueRegion();
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
if (isWindow() && isVisible() && internalWinId()) {
|
|
|
|
QT_TRY {
|
|
|
|
d->close_helper(QWidgetPrivate::CloseNoEvent);
|
|
|
|
} QT_CATCH(...) {
|
|
|
|
// if we're out of memory, at least hide the window.
|
|
|
|
QT_TRY {
|
|
|
|
hide();
|
|
|
|
} QT_CATCH(...) {
|
|
|
|
// and if that also doesn't work, then give up
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
#if defined(Q_WS_WIN) || defined(Q_WS_X11)|| defined(Q_WS_MAC)
|
|
|
|
else if (!internalWinId() && isVisible()) {
|
|
|
|
qApp->d_func()->sendSyntheticEnterLeave(this);
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
#endif
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
if (QWidgetBackingStore *bs = d->maybeBackingStore()) {
|
|
|
|
bs->removeDirtyWidget(this);
|
|
|
|
if (testAttribute(Qt::WA_StaticContents))
|
|
|
|
bs->removeStaticWidget(this);
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
delete d->needsFlush;
|
|
|
|
d->needsFlush = 0;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
// set all QPointers for this object to zero
|
|
|
|
if (d->hasGuards)
|
|
|
|
QObjectPrivate::clearGuards(this);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
if (d->declarativeData) {
|
|
|
|
QAbstractDeclarativeData::destroyed(d->declarativeData, this);
|
|
|
|
d->declarativeData = 0; // don't activate again in ~QObject
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
#ifdef QT_MAC_USE_COCOA
|
|
|
|
// QCocoaView holds a pointer back to this widget. Clear it now
|
|
|
|
// to make sure it's not followed later on. The lifetime of the
|
|
|
|
// QCocoaView might exceed the lifetime of this widget in cases
|
|
|
|
// where Cocoa itself holds references to it.
|
|
|
|
extern void qt_mac_clearCocoaViewQWidgetPointers(QWidget *);
|
|
|
|
qt_mac_clearCocoaViewQWidgetPointers(this);
|
|
|
|
#endif
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
if (!d->children.isEmpty())
|
|
|
|
d->deleteChildren();
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
#ifndef QT_NO_ACCESSIBILITY
|
|
|
|
QAccessible::updateAccessibility(this, 0, QAccessible::ObjectDestroyed);
|
|
|
|
#endif
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
QApplication::removePostedEvents(this);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
QT_TRY {
|
|
|
|
destroy(); // platform-dependent cleanup
|
|
|
|
} QT_CATCH(...) {
|
|
|
|
// if this fails we can't do anything about it but at least we are not allowed to throw.
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
--QWidgetPrivate::instanceCounter;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
if (QWidgetPrivate::allWidgets) // might have been deleted by ~QApplication
|
|
|
|
QWidgetPrivate::allWidgets->remove(this);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
QT_TRY {
|
|
|
|
QEvent e(QEvent::Destroy);
|
|
|
|
QCoreApplication::sendEvent(this, &e);
|
|
|
|
} QT_CATCH(const std::exception&) {
|
|
|
|
// if this fails we can't do anything about it but at least we are not allowed to throw.
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
int QWidgetPrivate::instanceCounter = 0; // Current number of widget instances
|
|
|
|
int QWidgetPrivate::maxInstances = 0; // Maximum number of widget instances
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
void QWidgetPrivate::setWinId(WId id) // set widget identifier
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
Q_Q(QWidget);
|
|
|
|
// the user might create a widget with Qt::Desktop window
|
|
|
|
// attribute (or create another QDesktopWidget instance), which
|
|
|
|
// will have the same windowid (the root window id) as the
|
|
|
|
// qt_desktopWidget. We should not add the second desktop widget
|
|
|
|
// to the mapper.
|
|
|
|
bool userDesktopWidget = qt_desktopWidget != 0 && qt_desktopWidget != q && q->windowType() == Qt::Desktop;
|
|
|
|
if (mapper && data.winid && !userDesktopWidget) {
|
|
|
|
mapper->remove(data.winid);
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
const WId oldWinId = data.winid;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
data.winid = id;
|
|
|
|
#if defined(Q_WS_X11)
|
|
|
|
hd = id; // X11: hd == ident
|
|
|
|
#endif
|
|
|
|
if (mapper && id && !userDesktopWidget) {
|
|
|
|
mapper->insert(data.winid, q);
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
if(oldWinId != id) {
|
|
|
|
QEvent e(QEvent::WinIdChange);
|
|
|
|
QCoreApplication::sendEvent(q, &e);
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
void QWidgetPrivate::createTLExtra()
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
if (!extra)
|
|
|
|
createExtra();
|
|
|
|
if (!extra->topextra) {
|
|
|
|
QTLWExtra* x = extra->topextra = new QTLWExtra;
|
|
|
|
x->icon = 0;
|
|
|
|
x->iconPixmap = 0;
|
|
|
|
x->windowSurface = 0;
|
|
|
|
x->sharedPainter = 0;
|
|
|
|
x->incw = x->inch = 0;
|
|
|
|
x->basew = x->baseh = 0;
|
|
|
|
x->frameStrut.setCoords(0, 0, 0, 0);
|
|
|
|
x->normalGeometry = QRect(0,0,-1,-1);
|
|
|
|
x->savedFlags = 0;
|
|
|
|
x->opacity = 255;
|
|
|
|
x->posFromMove = false;
|
|
|
|
x->sizeAdjusted = false;
|
|
|
|
x->inTopLevelResize = false;
|
|
|
|
x->inRepaint = false;
|
|
|
|
x->embedded = 0;
|
2016-01-30 16:02:10 +02:00
|
|
|
#if defined(Q_WS_MAC) && defined(QT_MAC_USE_COCOA)
|
2015-12-10 05:06:13 +02:00
|
|
|
x->wasMaximized = false;
|
2016-01-30 16:02:10 +02:00
|
|
|
#endif // Q_WS_MAC && QT_MAC_USE_COCOA
|
2015-12-10 05:06:13 +02:00
|
|
|
createTLSysExtra();
|
|
|
|
#ifdef QWIDGET_EXTRA_DEBUG
|
|
|
|
static int count = 0;
|
|
|
|
qDebug() << "tlextra" << ++count;
|
|
|
|
#endif
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/*!
|
|
|
|
\internal
|
|
|
|
Creates the widget extra data.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
void QWidgetPrivate::createExtra()
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
if (!extra) { // if not exists
|
|
|
|
extra = new QWExtra;
|
|
|
|
extra->glContext = 0;
|
|
|
|
extra->topextra = 0;
|
|
|
|
#ifndef QT_NO_GRAPHICSVIEW
|
|
|
|
extra->proxyWidget = 0;
|
|
|
|
#endif
|
|
|
|
#ifndef QT_NO_CURSOR
|
|
|
|
extra->curs = 0;
|
|
|
|
#endif
|
|
|
|
extra->minw = 0;
|
|
|
|
extra->minh = 0;
|
|
|
|
extra->maxw = QWIDGETSIZE_MAX;
|
|
|
|
extra->maxh = QWIDGETSIZE_MAX;
|
|
|
|
extra->customDpiX = 0;
|
|
|
|
extra->customDpiY = 0;
|
|
|
|
extra->explicitMinSize = 0;
|
|
|
|
extra->explicitMaxSize = 0;
|
|
|
|
extra->autoFillBackground = 0;
|
|
|
|
extra->nativeChildrenForced = 0;
|
|
|
|
extra->inRenderWithPainter = 0;
|
|
|
|
extra->hasMask = 0;
|
|
|
|
createSysExtra();
|
|
|
|
#ifdef QWIDGET_EXTRA_DEBUG
|
|
|
|
static int count = 0;
|
|
|
|
qDebug() << "extra" << ++count;
|
|
|
|
#endif
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/*!
|
|
|
|
\internal
|
|
|
|
Deletes the widget extra data.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
void QWidgetPrivate::deleteExtra()
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
if (extra) { // if exists
|
|
|
|
#ifndef QT_NO_CURSOR
|
|
|
|
delete extra->curs;
|
|
|
|
#endif
|
|
|
|
deleteSysExtra();
|
|
|
|
#ifndef QT_NO_STYLE_STYLESHEET
|
|
|
|
// dereference the stylesheet style
|
|
|
|
if (QStyleSheetStyle *proxy = qobject_cast<QStyleSheetStyle *>(extra->style))
|
|
|
|
proxy->deref();
|
|
|
|
#endif
|
|
|
|
if (extra->topextra) {
|
|
|
|
deleteTLSysExtra();
|
|
|
|
extra->topextra->backingStore.destroy();
|
|
|
|
delete extra->topextra->icon;
|
|
|
|
delete extra->topextra->iconPixmap;
|
|
|
|
delete extra->topextra->windowSurface;
|
|
|
|
delete extra->topextra;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
delete extra;
|
|
|
|
// extra->xic destroyed in QWidget::destroy()
|
|
|
|
extra = 0;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
|
|
Returns true if there are widgets above this which overlap with
|
|
|
|
\a rect, which is in parent's coordinate system (same as crect).
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
bool QWidgetPrivate::isOverlapped(const QRect &rect) const
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
Q_Q(const QWidget);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
const QWidget *w = q;
|
|
|
|
QRect r = rect;
|
|
|
|
while (w) {
|
|
|
|
if (w->isWindow())
|
|
|
|
return false;
|
|
|
|
QWidgetPrivate *pd = w->parentWidget()->d_func();
|
|
|
|
bool above = false;
|
|
|
|
for (int i = 0; i < pd->children.size(); ++i) {
|
|
|
|
QWidget *sibling = qobject_cast<QWidget *>(pd->children.at(i));
|
|
|
|
if (!sibling || !sibling->isVisible() || sibling->isWindow())
|
|
|
|
continue;
|
|
|
|
if (!above) {
|
|
|
|
above = (sibling == w);
|
|
|
|
continue;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
if (qRectIntersects(sibling->d_func()->effectiveRectFor(sibling->data->crect), r)) {
|
|
|
|
const QWExtra *siblingExtra = sibling->d_func()->extra;
|
|
|
|
if (siblingExtra && siblingExtra->hasMask && !sibling->d_func()->graphicsEffect
|
|
|
|
&& !siblingExtra->mask.translated(sibling->data->crect.topLeft()).intersects(r)) {
|
|
|
|
continue;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
return true;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
w = w->parentWidget();
|
|
|
|
r.translate(pd->data.crect.topLeft());
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
return false;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
void QWidgetPrivate::syncBackingStore()
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
if (paintOnScreen()) {
|
|
|
|
repaint_sys(dirty);
|
|
|
|
dirty = QRegion();
|
|
|
|
} else if (QWidgetBackingStore *bs = maybeBackingStore()) {
|
|
|
|
bs->sync();
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
void QWidgetPrivate::syncBackingStore(const QRegion ®ion)
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
if (paintOnScreen())
|
|
|
|
repaint_sys(region);
|
|
|
|
else if (QWidgetBackingStore *bs = maybeBackingStore()) {
|
|
|
|
bs->sync(q_func(), region);
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
void QWidgetPrivate::setUpdatesEnabled_helper(bool enable)
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
Q_Q(QWidget);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
if (enable && !q->isWindow() && q->parentWidget() && !q->parentWidget()->updatesEnabled())
|
|
|
|
return; // nothing we can do
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
if (enable != q->testAttribute(Qt::WA_UpdatesDisabled))
|
|
|
|
return; // nothing to do
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
q->setAttribute(Qt::WA_UpdatesDisabled, !enable);
|
|
|
|
if (enable)
|
|
|
|
q->update();
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Qt::WidgetAttribute attribute = enable ? Qt::WA_ForceUpdatesDisabled : Qt::WA_UpdatesDisabled;
|
|
|
|
for (int i = 0; i < children.size(); ++i) {
|
|
|
|
QWidget *w = qobject_cast<QWidget *>(children.at(i));
|
|
|
|
if (w && !w->isWindow() && !w->testAttribute(attribute))
|
|
|
|
w->d_func()->setUpdatesEnabled_helper(enable);
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/*!
|
|
|
|
\internal
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Propagate this widget's palette to all children, except style sheet
|
|
|
|
widgets, and windows that don't enable window propagation (palettes don't
|
|
|
|
normally propagate to windows).
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
void QWidgetPrivate::propagatePaletteChange()
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
Q_Q(QWidget);
|
|
|
|
// Propagate a new inherited mask to all children.
|
|
|
|
#ifndef QT_NO_GRAPHICSVIEW
|
|
|
|
if (!q->parentWidget() && extra && extra->proxyWidget) {
|
|
|
|
QGraphicsProxyWidget *p = extra->proxyWidget;
|
|
|
|
inheritedPaletteResolveMask = p->d_func()->inheritedPaletteResolveMask | p->palette().resolve();
|
|
|
|
} else
|
|
|
|
#endif //QT_NO_GRAPHICSVIEW
|
|
|
|
if (q->isWindow() && !q->testAttribute(Qt::WA_WindowPropagation)) {
|
|
|
|
inheritedPaletteResolveMask = 0;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
int mask = data.pal.resolve() | inheritedPaletteResolveMask;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
QEvent pc(QEvent::PaletteChange);
|
|
|
|
QApplication::sendEvent(q, &pc);
|
|
|
|
for (int i = 0; i < children.size(); ++i) {
|
|
|
|
QWidget *w = qobject_cast<QWidget*>(children.at(i));
|
|
|
|
if (w && !w->testAttribute(Qt::WA_StyleSheet)
|
|
|
|
&& (!w->isWindow() || w->testAttribute(Qt::WA_WindowPropagation))) {
|
|
|
|
QWidgetPrivate *wd = w->d_func();
|
|
|
|
wd->inheritedPaletteResolveMask = mask;
|
|
|
|
wd->resolvePalette();
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
|
|
Returns the widget's clipping rectangle.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
QRect QWidgetPrivate::clipRect() const
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
Q_Q(const QWidget);
|
|
|
|
const QWidget * w = q;
|
|
|
|
if (!w->isVisible())
|
|
|
|
return QRect();
|
|
|
|
QRect r = effectiveRectFor(q->rect());
|
|
|
|
int ox = 0;
|
|
|
|
int oy = 0;
|
|
|
|
while (w
|
|
|
|
&& w->isVisible()
|
|
|
|
&& !w->isWindow()
|
|
|
|
&& w->parentWidget()) {
|
|
|
|
ox -= w->x();
|
|
|
|
oy -= w->y();
|
|
|
|
w = w->parentWidget();
|
|
|
|
r &= QRect(ox, oy, w->width(), w->height());
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
return r;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
|
|
Returns the widget's clipping region (without siblings).
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
QRegion QWidgetPrivate::clipRegion() const
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
Q_Q(const QWidget);
|
|
|
|
if (!q->isVisible())
|
|
|
|
return QRegion();
|
|
|
|
QRegion r(q->rect());
|
|
|
|
const QWidget * w = q;
|
|
|
|
const QWidget *ignoreUpTo;
|
|
|
|
int ox = 0;
|
|
|
|
int oy = 0;
|
|
|
|
while (w
|
|
|
|
&& w->isVisible()
|
|
|
|
&& !w->isWindow()
|
|
|
|
&& w->parentWidget()) {
|
|
|
|
ox -= w->x();
|
|
|
|
oy -= w->y();
|
|
|
|
ignoreUpTo = w;
|
|
|
|
w = w->parentWidget();
|
|
|
|
r &= QRegion(ox, oy, w->width(), w->height());
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
int i = 0;
|
|
|
|
while(w->d_func()->children.at(i++) != static_cast<const QObject *>(ignoreUpTo))
|
|
|
|
;
|
|
|
|
for ( ; i < w->d_func()->children.size(); ++i) {
|
|
|
|
if(QWidget *sibling = qobject_cast<QWidget *>(w->d_func()->children.at(i))) {
|
|
|
|
if(sibling->isVisible() && !sibling->isWindow()) {
|
|
|
|
QRect siblingRect(ox+sibling->x(), oy+sibling->y(),
|
|
|
|
sibling->width(), sibling->height());
|
|
|
|
if (qRectIntersects(siblingRect, q->rect()))
|
|
|
|
r -= QRegion(siblingRect);
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
return r;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
#ifndef QT_NO_GRAPHICSEFFECT
|
|
|
|
void QWidgetPrivate::invalidateGraphicsEffectsRecursively()
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
Q_Q(QWidget);
|
|
|
|
QWidget *w = q;
|
|
|
|
do {
|
|
|
|
if (w->graphicsEffect()) {
|
|
|
|
QWidgetEffectSourcePrivate *sourced =
|
|
|
|
static_cast<QWidgetEffectSourcePrivate *>(w->graphicsEffect()->source()->d_func());
|
|
|
|
if (!sourced->updateDueToGraphicsEffect)
|
|
|
|
w->graphicsEffect()->source()->d_func()->invalidateCache();
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
w = w->parentWidget();
|
|
|
|
} while (w);
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
#endif //QT_NO_GRAPHICSEFFECT
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
void QWidgetPrivate::setDirtyOpaqueRegion()
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
Q_Q(QWidget);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
dirtyOpaqueChildren = true;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
#ifndef QT_NO_GRAPHICSEFFECT
|
|
|
|
invalidateGraphicsEffectsRecursively();
|
|
|
|
#endif //QT_NO_GRAPHICSEFFECT
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
if (q->isWindow())
|
|
|
|
return;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
QWidget *parent = q->parentWidget();
|
|
|
|
if (!parent)
|
|
|
|
return;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
// TODO: instead of setting dirtyflag, manipulate the dirtyregion directly?
|
|
|
|
QWidgetPrivate *pd = parent->d_func();
|
|
|
|
if (!pd->dirtyOpaqueChildren)
|
|
|
|
pd->setDirtyOpaqueRegion();
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
const QRegion &QWidgetPrivate::getOpaqueChildren() const
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
if (!dirtyOpaqueChildren)
|
|
|
|
return opaqueChildren;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
QWidgetPrivate *that = const_cast<QWidgetPrivate*>(this);
|
|
|
|
that->opaqueChildren = QRegion();
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
for (int i = 0; i < children.size(); ++i) {
|
|
|
|
QWidget *child = qobject_cast<QWidget *>(children.at(i));
|
|
|
|
if (!child || !child->isVisible() || child->isWindow())
|
|
|
|
continue;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
const QPoint offset = child->geometry().topLeft();
|
|
|
|
QWidgetPrivate *childd = child->d_func();
|
|
|
|
QRegion r = childd->isOpaque ? child->rect() : childd->getOpaqueChildren();
|
|
|
|
if (childd->extra && childd->extra->hasMask)
|
|
|
|
r &= childd->extra->mask;
|
|
|
|
if (r.isEmpty())
|
|
|
|
continue;
|
|
|
|
r.translate(offset);
|
|
|
|
that->opaqueChildren += r;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
that->opaqueChildren &= q_func()->rect();
|
|
|
|
that->dirtyOpaqueChildren = false;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
return that->opaqueChildren;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
void QWidgetPrivate::subtractOpaqueChildren(QRegion &source, const QRect &clipRect) const
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
if (children.isEmpty() || clipRect.isEmpty())
|
|
|
|
return;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
const QRegion &r = getOpaqueChildren();
|
|
|
|
if (!r.isEmpty())
|
|
|
|
source -= (r & clipRect);
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
//subtract any relatives that are higher up than me --- this is too expensive !!!
|
|
|
|
void QWidgetPrivate::subtractOpaqueSiblings(QRegion &sourceRegion, bool *hasDirtySiblingsAbove,
|
|
|
|
bool alsoNonOpaque) const
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
Q_Q(const QWidget);
|
|
|
|
static int disableSubtractOpaqueSiblings = qgetenv("QT_NO_SUBTRACTOPAQUESIBLINGS").toInt();
|
|
|
|
if (disableSubtractOpaqueSiblings || q->isWindow())
|
|
|
|
return;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
#ifdef QT_MAC_USE_COCOA
|
|
|
|
if (q->d_func()->isInUnifiedToolbar)
|
|
|
|
return;
|
|
|
|
#endif // QT_MAC_USE_COCOA
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
QRect clipBoundingRect;
|
|
|
|
bool dirtyClipBoundingRect = true;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
QRegion parentClip;
|
|
|
|
bool dirtyParentClip = true;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
QPoint parentOffset = data.crect.topLeft();
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
const QWidget *w = q;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
while (w) {
|
|
|
|
if (w->isWindow())
|
|
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
QWidgetPrivate *pd = w->parentWidget()->d_func();
|
|
|
|
const int myIndex = pd->children.indexOf(const_cast<QWidget *>(w));
|
|
|
|
const QRect widgetGeometry = w->d_func()->effectiveRectFor(w->data->crect);
|
|
|
|
for (int i = myIndex + 1; i < pd->children.size(); ++i) {
|
|
|
|
QWidget *sibling = qobject_cast<QWidget *>(pd->children.at(i));
|
|
|
|
if (!sibling || !sibling->isVisible() || sibling->isWindow())
|
|
|
|
continue;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
const QRect siblingGeometry = sibling->d_func()->effectiveRectFor(sibling->data->crect);
|
|
|
|
if (!qRectIntersects(siblingGeometry, widgetGeometry))
|
|
|
|
continue;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
if (dirtyClipBoundingRect) {
|
|
|
|
clipBoundingRect = sourceRegion.boundingRect();
|
|
|
|
dirtyClipBoundingRect = false;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
if (!qRectIntersects(siblingGeometry, clipBoundingRect.translated(parentOffset)))
|
|
|
|
continue;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
if (dirtyParentClip) {
|
|
|
|
parentClip = sourceRegion.translated(parentOffset);
|
|
|
|
dirtyParentClip = false;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
const QPoint siblingPos(sibling->data->crect.topLeft());
|
|
|
|
const QRect siblingClipRect(sibling->d_func()->clipRect());
|
|
|
|
QRegion siblingDirty(parentClip);
|
|
|
|
siblingDirty &= (siblingClipRect.translated(siblingPos));
|
|
|
|
const bool hasMask = sibling->d_func()->extra && sibling->d_func()->extra->hasMask
|
|
|
|
&& !sibling->d_func()->graphicsEffect;
|
|
|
|
if (hasMask)
|
|
|
|
siblingDirty &= sibling->d_func()->extra->mask.translated(siblingPos);
|
|
|
|
if (siblingDirty.isEmpty())
|
|
|
|
continue;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
if (sibling->d_func()->isOpaque || alsoNonOpaque) {
|
|
|
|
if (hasMask) {
|
|
|
|
siblingDirty.translate(-parentOffset);
|
|
|
|
sourceRegion -= siblingDirty;
|
|
|
|
} else {
|
|
|
|
sourceRegion -= siblingGeometry.translated(-parentOffset);
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
} else {
|
|
|
|
if (hasDirtySiblingsAbove)
|
|
|
|
*hasDirtySiblingsAbove = true;
|
|
|
|
if (sibling->d_func()->children.isEmpty())
|
|
|
|
continue;
|
|
|
|
QRegion opaqueSiblingChildren(sibling->d_func()->getOpaqueChildren());
|
|
|
|
opaqueSiblingChildren.translate(-parentOffset + siblingPos);
|
|
|
|
sourceRegion -= opaqueSiblingChildren;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if (sourceRegion.isEmpty())
|
|
|
|
return;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
dirtyClipBoundingRect = true;
|
|
|
|
dirtyParentClip = true;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
w = w->parentWidget();
|
|
|
|
parentOffset += pd->data.crect.topLeft();
|
|
|
|
dirtyParentClip = true;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
void QWidgetPrivate::clipToEffectiveMask(QRegion ®ion) const
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
Q_Q(const QWidget);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
const QWidget *w = q;
|
|
|
|
QPoint offset;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
#ifndef QT_NO_GRAPHICSEFFECT
|
|
|
|
if (graphicsEffect) {
|
|
|
|
w = q->parentWidget();
|
|
|
|
offset -= data.crect.topLeft();
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
#endif //QT_NO_GRAPHICSEFFECT
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
while (w) {
|
|
|
|
const QWidgetPrivate *wd = w->d_func();
|
|
|
|
if (wd->extra && wd->extra->hasMask)
|
|
|
|
region &= (w != q) ? wd->extra->mask.translated(offset) : wd->extra->mask;
|
|
|
|
if (w->isWindow())
|
|
|
|
return;
|
|
|
|
offset -= wd->data.crect.topLeft();
|
|
|
|
w = w->parentWidget();
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
bool QWidgetPrivate::paintOnScreen() const
|
|
|
|
{
|
2016-06-21 16:52:02 +00:00
|
|
|
#if defined(QT_NO_BACKINGSTORE)
|
2015-12-10 05:06:13 +02:00
|
|
|
return true;
|
|
|
|
#else
|
|
|
|
Q_Q(const QWidget);
|
|
|
|
if (q->testAttribute(Qt::WA_PaintOnScreen)
|
|
|
|
|| (!q->isWindow() && q->window()->testAttribute(Qt::WA_PaintOnScreen))) {
|
|
|
|
return true;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
2016-06-21 16:52:02 +00:00
|
|
|
return false;
|
2015-12-10 05:06:13 +02:00
|
|
|
#endif
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
void QWidgetPrivate::updateIsOpaque()
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
// hw: todo: only needed if opacity actually changed
|
|
|
|
setDirtyOpaqueRegion();
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
#ifndef QT_NO_GRAPHICSEFFECT
|
|
|
|
if (graphicsEffect) {
|
|
|
|
// ### We should probably add QGraphicsEffect::isOpaque at some point.
|
|
|
|
setOpaque(false);
|
|
|
|
return;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
#endif //QT_NO_GRAPHICSEFFECT
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Q_Q(QWidget);
|
|
|
|
#ifdef Q_WS_X11
|
|
|
|
if (q->testAttribute(Qt::WA_X11OpenGLOverlay)) {
|
|
|
|
setOpaque(false);
|
|
|
|
return;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
#endif
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
if (q->testAttribute(Qt::WA_OpaquePaintEvent) || q->testAttribute(Qt::WA_PaintOnScreen)) {
|
|
|
|
setOpaque(true);
|
|
|
|
return;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
const QPalette &pal = q->palette();
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
if (q->autoFillBackground()) {
|
|
|
|
const QBrush &autoFillBrush = pal.brush(q->backgroundRole());
|
|
|
|
if (autoFillBrush.style() != Qt::NoBrush && autoFillBrush.isOpaque()) {
|
|
|
|
setOpaque(true);
|
|
|
|
return;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
if (q->isWindow() && !q->testAttribute(Qt::WA_NoSystemBackground)) {
|
|
|
|
const QBrush &windowBrush = q->palette().brush(QPalette::Window);
|
|
|
|
if (windowBrush.style() != Qt::NoBrush && windowBrush.isOpaque()) {
|
|
|
|
setOpaque(true);
|
|
|
|
return;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
setOpaque(false);
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
void QWidgetPrivate::setOpaque(bool opaque)
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
if (isOpaque == opaque)
|
|
|
|
return;
|
|
|
|
isOpaque = opaque;
|
|
|
|
#ifdef Q_WS_MAC
|
|
|
|
macUpdateIsOpaque();
|
|
|
|
#endif
|
|
|
|
#ifdef Q_WS_X11
|
|
|
|
x11UpdateIsOpaque();
|
|
|
|
#endif
|
|
|
|
#ifdef Q_WS_WIN
|
|
|
|
winUpdateIsOpaque();
|
|
|
|
#endif
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
void QWidgetPrivate::updateIsTranslucent()
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
#ifdef Q_WS_MAC
|
|
|
|
macUpdateIsOpaque();
|
|
|
|
#endif
|
|
|
|
#ifdef Q_WS_X11
|
|
|
|
x11UpdateIsOpaque();
|
|
|
|
#endif
|
|
|
|
#ifdef Q_WS_WIN
|
|
|
|
winUpdateIsOpaque();
|
|
|
|
#endif
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/*!
|
|
|
|
\fn void QPixmap::fill(const QWidget *widget, const QPoint &offset)
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Fills the pixmap with the \a widget's background color or pixmap
|
|
|
|
according to the given offset.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
The QPoint \a offset defines a point in widget coordinates to
|
|
|
|
which the pixmap's top-left pixel will be mapped to. This is only
|
|
|
|
significant if the widget has a background pixmap; otherwise the
|
|
|
|
pixmap will simply be filled with the background color of the
|
|
|
|
widget.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
void QPixmap::fill( const QWidget *widget, const QPoint &off )
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
QPainter p(this);
|
|
|
|
p.translate(-off);
|
|
|
|
widget->d_func()->paintBackground(&p, QRect(off, size()));
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
static inline void fillRegion(QPainter *painter, const QRegion &rgn, const QBrush &brush)
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
Q_ASSERT(painter);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
if (brush.style() == Qt::TexturePattern) {
|
|
|
|
#ifdef Q_WS_MAC
|
|
|
|
// Optimize pattern filling on mac by using HITheme directly
|
|
|
|
// when filling with the standard widget background.
|
|
|
|
// Defined in qmacstyle_mac.cpp
|
|
|
|
extern void qt_mac_fill_background(QPainter *painter, const QRegion &rgn, const QBrush &brush);
|
|
|
|
qt_mac_fill_background(painter, rgn, brush);
|
|
|
|
#else
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
const QRect rect(rgn.boundingRect());
|
|
|
|
painter->setClipRegion(rgn);
|
|
|
|
painter->drawTiledPixmap(rect, brush.texture(), rect.topLeft());
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
#endif // Q_WS_MAC
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
} else if (brush.gradient()
|
|
|
|
&& brush.gradient()->coordinateMode() == QGradient::ObjectBoundingMode) {
|
|
|
|
painter->save();
|
|
|
|
painter->setClipRegion(rgn);
|
|
|
|
painter->fillRect(0, 0, painter->device()->width(), painter->device()->height(), brush);
|
|
|
|
painter->restore();
|
|
|
|
} else {
|
|
|
|
const QVector<QRect> &rects = rgn.rects();
|
|
|
|
for (int i = 0; i < rects.size(); ++i)
|
|
|
|
painter->fillRect(rects.at(i), brush);
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
void QWidgetPrivate::paintBackground(QPainter *painter, const QRegion &rgn, int flags) const
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
Q_Q(const QWidget);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
#ifndef QT_NO_SCROLLAREA
|
|
|
|
bool resetBrushOrigin = false;
|
|
|
|
QPointF oldBrushOrigin;
|
|
|
|
//If we are painting the viewport of a scrollarea, we must apply an offset to the brush in case we are drawing a texture
|
|
|
|
QAbstractScrollArea *scrollArea = qobject_cast<QAbstractScrollArea *>(parent);
|
|
|
|
if (scrollArea && scrollArea->viewport() == q) {
|
|
|
|
QObjectData *scrollPrivate = static_cast<QWidget *>(scrollArea)->d_ptr.data();
|
|
|
|
QAbstractScrollAreaPrivate *priv = static_cast<QAbstractScrollAreaPrivate *>(scrollPrivate);
|
|
|
|
oldBrushOrigin = painter->brushOrigin();
|
|
|
|
resetBrushOrigin = true;
|
|
|
|
painter->setBrushOrigin(-priv->contentsOffset());
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
#endif // QT_NO_SCROLLAREA
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
const QBrush autoFillBrush = q->palette().brush(q->backgroundRole());
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
if ((flags & DrawAsRoot) && !(q->autoFillBackground() && autoFillBrush.isOpaque())) {
|
|
|
|
const QBrush bg = q->palette().brush(QPalette::Window);
|
|
|
|
fillRegion(painter, rgn, bg);
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
if (q->autoFillBackground())
|
|
|
|
fillRegion(painter, rgn, autoFillBrush);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
if (q->testAttribute(Qt::WA_StyledBackground)) {
|
|
|
|
painter->setClipRegion(rgn);
|
|
|
|
QStyleOption opt;
|
|
|
|
opt.initFrom(q);
|
|
|
|
q->style()->drawPrimitive(QStyle::PE_Widget, &opt, painter, q);
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
#ifndef QT_NO_SCROLLAREA
|
|
|
|
if (resetBrushOrigin)
|
|
|
|
painter->setBrushOrigin(oldBrushOrigin);
|
|
|
|
#endif // QT_NO_SCROLLAREA
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
|
|
\internal
|
|
|
|
This function is called when a widget is hidden or destroyed.
|
|
|
|
It resets some application global pointers that should only refer active,
|
|
|
|
visible widgets.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
#ifdef Q_WS_MAC
|
|
|
|
extern QPointer<QWidget> qt_button_down;
|
|
|
|
#else
|
|
|
|
extern QWidget *qt_button_down;
|
|
|
|
#endif
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
void QWidgetPrivate::deactivateWidgetCleanup()
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
Q_Q(QWidget);
|
|
|
|
// If this was the active application window, reset it
|
|
|
|
if (QApplication::activeWindow() == q)
|
|
|
|
QApplication::setActiveWindow(0);
|
|
|
|
// If the is the active mouse press widget, reset it
|
|
|
|
if (q == qt_button_down)
|
|
|
|
qt_button_down = 0;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/*!
|
|
|
|
Returns a pointer to the widget with window identifer/handle \a
|
|
|
|
id.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
The window identifier type depends on the underlying window
|
|
|
|
system, see \c qwindowdefs.h for the actual definition. If there
|
|
|
|
is no widget with this identifier, 0 is returned.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
QWidget *QWidget::find(WId id)
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
return QWidgetPrivate::mapper ? QWidgetPrivate::mapper->value(id, 0) : 0;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/*!
|
|
|
|
\fn WId QWidget::internalWinId() const
|
|
|
|
\internal
|
|
|
|
Returns the window system identifier of the widget, or 0 if the widget is not created yet.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/*!
|
|
|
|
\fn WId QWidget::winId() const
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Returns the window system identifier of the widget.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Portable in principle, but if you use it you are probably about to
|
|
|
|
do something non-portable. Be careful.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
If a widget is non-native (alien) and winId() is invoked on it, that widget
|
|
|
|
will be provided a native handle.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
On Mac OS X, the type returned depends on which framework Qt was linked
|
|
|
|
against. If Qt is using Carbon, the {WId} is actually an HIViewRef. If Qt
|
|
|
|
is using Cocoa, {WId} is a pointer to an NSView.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
This value may change at run-time. An event with type QEvent::WinIdChange
|
|
|
|
will be sent to the widget following a change in window system identifier.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
\sa find()
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
WId QWidget::winId() const
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
if (!testAttribute(Qt::WA_WState_Created) || !internalWinId()) {
|
|
|
|
#ifdef ALIEN_DEBUG
|
|
|
|
qDebug() << "QWidget::winId: creating native window for" << this;
|
|
|
|
#endif
|
|
|
|
QWidget *that = const_cast<QWidget*>(this);
|
|
|
|
that->setAttribute(Qt::WA_NativeWindow);
|
|
|
|
that->d_func()->createWinId();
|
|
|
|
return that->data->winid;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
return data->winid;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
void QWidgetPrivate::createWinId(WId winid)
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
Q_Q(QWidget);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
#ifdef ALIEN_DEBUG
|
|
|
|
qDebug() << "QWidgetPrivate::createWinId for" << q << winid;
|
|
|
|
#endif
|
|
|
|
const bool forceNativeWindow = q->testAttribute(Qt::WA_NativeWindow);
|
|
|
|
if (!q->testAttribute(Qt::WA_WState_Created) || (forceNativeWindow && !q->internalWinId())) {
|
|
|
|
if (!q->isWindow()) {
|
|
|
|
QWidget *parent = q->parentWidget();
|
|
|
|
QWidgetPrivate *pd = parent->d_func();
|
|
|
|
if (forceNativeWindow && !q->testAttribute(Qt::WA_DontCreateNativeAncestors))
|
|
|
|
parent->setAttribute(Qt::WA_NativeWindow);
|
|
|
|
if (!parent->internalWinId()) {
|
|
|
|
pd->createWinId();
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
for (int i = 0; i < pd->children.size(); ++i) {
|
|
|
|
QWidget *w = qobject_cast<QWidget *>(pd->children.at(i));
|
|
|
|
if (w && !w->isWindow() && (!w->testAttribute(Qt::WA_WState_Created)
|
|
|
|
|| (!w->internalWinId() && w->testAttribute(Qt::WA_NativeWindow)))) {
|
|
|
|
if (w!=q) {
|
|
|
|
w->create();
|
|
|
|
} else {
|
|
|
|
w->create(winid);
|
|
|
|
// if the window has already been created, we
|
|
|
|
// need to raise it to its proper stacking position
|
|
|
|
if (winid)
|
|
|
|
w->raise();
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
} else {
|
|
|
|
q->create();
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/*!
|
|
|
|
\internal
|
|
|
|
Ensures that the widget has a window system identifier, i.e. that it is known to the windowing system.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
void QWidget::createWinId()
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
Q_D(QWidget);
|
|
|
|
#ifdef ALIEN_DEBUG
|
|
|
|
qDebug() << "QWidget::createWinId" << this;
|
|
|
|
#endif
|
|
|
|
// qWarning("QWidget::createWinId is obsolete, please fix your code.");
|
|
|
|
d->createWinId();
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/*!
|
|
|
|
\since 4.4
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Returns the effective window system identifier of the widget, i.e. the
|
|
|
|
native parent's window system identifier.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
If the widget is native, this function returns the native widget ID.
|
|
|
|
Otherwise, the window ID of the first native parent widget, i.e., the
|
|
|
|
top-level widget that contains this widget, is returned.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
\note We recommend that you do not store this value as it is likely to
|
|
|
|
change at run-time.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
\sa nativeParentWidget()
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
WId QWidget::effectiveWinId() const
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
WId id = internalWinId();
|
|
|
|
if (id || !testAttribute(Qt::WA_WState_Created))
|
|
|
|
return id;
|
|
|
|
QWidget *realParent = nativeParentWidget();
|
|
|
|
if (!realParent && d_func()->inSetParent) {
|
|
|
|
// In transitional state. This is really just a workaround. The real problem
|
|
|
|
// is that QWidgetPrivate::setParent_sys (platform specific code) first sets
|
|
|
|
// the window id to 0 (setWinId(0)) before it sets the Qt::WA_WState_Created
|
|
|
|
// attribute to false. The correct way is to do it the other way around, and
|
|
|
|
// in that case the Qt::WA_WState_Created logic above will kick in and
|
|
|
|
// return 0 whenever the widget is in a transitional state. However, changing
|
|
|
|
// the original logic for all platforms is far more intrusive and might
|
|
|
|
// break existing applications.
|
|
|
|
// Note: The widget can only be in a transitional state when changing its
|
|
|
|
// parent -- everything else is an internal error -- hence explicitly checking
|
|
|
|
// against 'inSetParent' rather than doing an unconditional return whenever
|
|
|
|
// 'realParent' is 0 (which may cause strange artifacts and headache later).
|
|
|
|
return 0;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// This widget *must* have a native parent widget.
|
|
|
|
Q_ASSERT(realParent);
|
|
|
|
Q_ASSERT(realParent->internalWinId());
|
|
|
|
return realParent->internalWinId();
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
#ifndef QT_NO_STYLE_STYLESHEET
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/*!
|
|
|
|
\property QWidget::styleSheet
|
|
|
|
\brief the widget's style sheet
|
|
|
|
\since 4.2
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
The style sheet contains a textual description of customizations to the
|
|
|
|
widget's style, as described in the \l{Qt Style Sheets} document.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Since Qt 4.5, Qt style sheets fully supports Mac OS X.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
\warning Qt style sheets are currently not supported for custom QStyle
|
|
|
|
subclasses. We plan to address this in some future release.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
\sa setStyle(), QApplication::styleSheet, {Qt Style Sheets}
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
QString QWidget::styleSheet() const
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
Q_D(const QWidget);
|
|
|
|
if (!d->extra)
|
|
|
|
return QString();
|
|
|
|
return d->extra->styleSheet;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
void QWidget::setStyleSheet(const QString& styleSheet)
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
Q_D(QWidget);
|
|
|
|
d->createExtra();
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
QStyleSheetStyle *proxy = qobject_cast<QStyleSheetStyle *>(d->extra->style);
|
|
|
|
d->extra->styleSheet = styleSheet;
|
|
|
|
if (styleSheet.isEmpty()) { // stylesheet removed
|
|
|
|
if (!proxy)
|
|
|
|
return;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
d->inheritStyle();
|
|
|
|
return;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
if (proxy) { // style sheet update
|
|
|
|
proxy->repolish(this);
|
|
|
|
return;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
if (testAttribute(Qt::WA_SetStyle)) {
|
|
|
|
d->setStyle_helper(new QStyleSheetStyle(d->extra->style), true);
|
|
|
|
} else {
|
|
|
|
d->setStyle_helper(new QStyleSheetStyle(0), true);
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
#endif // QT_NO_STYLE_STYLESHEET
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/*!
|
|
|
|
\sa QWidget::setStyle(), QApplication::setStyle(), QApplication::style()
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
QStyle *QWidget::style() const
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
Q_D(const QWidget);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
if (d->extra && d->extra->style)
|
|
|
|
return d->extra->style;
|
|
|
|
return QApplication::style();
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/*!
|
|
|
|
Sets the widget's GUI style to \a style. The ownership of the style
|
|
|
|
object is not transferred.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
If no style is set, the widget uses the application's style,
|
|
|
|
QApplication::style() instead.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Setting a widget's style has no effect on existing or future child
|
|
|
|
widgets.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
\warning This function is particularly useful for demonstration
|
|
|
|
purposes, where you want to show Qt's styling capabilities. Real
|
|
|
|
applications should avoid it and use one consistent GUI style
|
|
|
|
instead.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
\warning Qt style sheets are currently not supported for custom QStyle
|
|
|
|
subclasses. We plan to address this in some future release.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
\sa style(), QStyle, QApplication::style(), QApplication::setStyle()
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
void QWidget::setStyle(QStyle *style)
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
Q_D(QWidget);
|
|
|
|
setAttribute(Qt::WA_SetStyle, style != 0);
|
|
|
|
d->createExtra();
|
|
|
|
#ifndef QT_NO_STYLE_STYLESHEET
|
|
|
|
if (QStyleSheetStyle *proxy = qobject_cast<QStyleSheetStyle *>(style)) {
|
|
|
|
//if for some reason someone try to set a QStyleSheetStyle, ref it
|
|
|
|
//(this may happen for exemple in QButtonDialogBox which propagates its style)
|
|
|
|
proxy->ref();
|
|
|
|
d->setStyle_helper(style, false);
|
|
|
|
} else if (qobject_cast<QStyleSheetStyle *>(d->extra->style) || !qApp->styleSheet().isEmpty()) {
|
|
|
|
// if we have an application stylesheet or have a proxy already, propagate
|
|
|
|
d->setStyle_helper(new QStyleSheetStyle(style), true);
|
|
|
|
} else
|
|
|
|
#endif
|
|
|
|
d->setStyle_helper(style, false);
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
void QWidgetPrivate::setStyle_helper(QStyle *newStyle, bool propagate, bool
|
|
|
|
#ifdef Q_WS_MAC
|
|
|
|
metalHack
|
|
|
|
#endif
|
|
|
|
)
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
Q_Q(QWidget);
|
|
|
|
QStyle *oldStyle = q->style();
|
|
|
|
#ifndef QT_NO_STYLE_STYLESHEET
|
|
|
|
QWeakPointer<QStyle> origStyle;
|
|
|
|
#endif
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
#ifdef Q_WS_MAC
|
|
|
|
// the metalhack boolean allows Qt/Mac to do a proper re-polish depending
|
|
|
|
// on how the Qt::WA_MacBrushedMetal attribute is set. It is only ever
|
|
|
|
// set when changing that attribute and passes the widget's CURRENT style.
|
|
|
|
// therefore no need to do a reassignment.
|
|
|
|
if (!metalHack)
|
|
|
|
#endif
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
createExtra();
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
#ifndef QT_NO_STYLE_STYLESHEET
|
|
|
|
origStyle = extra->style.data();
|
|
|
|
#endif
|
|
|
|
extra->style = newStyle;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
// repolish
|
|
|
|
if (q->windowType() != Qt::Desktop) {
|
|
|
|
if (polished) {
|
|
|
|
oldStyle->unpolish(q);
|
|
|
|
#ifdef Q_WS_MAC
|
|
|
|
if (metalHack)
|
|
|
|
macUpdateMetalAttribute();
|
|
|
|
#endif
|
|
|
|
q->style()->polish(q);
|
|
|
|
#ifdef Q_WS_MAC
|
|
|
|
} else if (metalHack) {
|
|
|
|
macUpdateMetalAttribute();
|
|
|
|
#endif
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
if (propagate) {
|
|
|
|
for (int i = 0; i < children.size(); ++i) {
|
|
|
|
QWidget *c = qobject_cast<QWidget*>(children.at(i));
|
|
|
|
if (c)
|
|
|
|
c->d_func()->inheritStyle();
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
#ifndef QT_NO_STYLE_STYLESHEET
|
|
|
|
if (!qobject_cast<QStyleSheetStyle*>(newStyle)) {
|
|
|
|
if (const QStyleSheetStyle* cssStyle = qobject_cast<QStyleSheetStyle*>(origStyle.data())) {
|
|
|
|
cssStyle->clearWidgetFont(q);
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
#endif
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
QEvent e(QEvent::StyleChange);
|
|
|
|
QApplication::sendEvent(q, &e);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
#ifndef QT_NO_STYLE_STYLESHEET
|
|
|
|
// dereference the old stylesheet style
|
|
|
|
if (QStyleSheetStyle *proxy = qobject_cast<QStyleSheetStyle *>(origStyle.data()))
|
|
|
|
proxy->deref();
|
|
|
|
#endif
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
// Inherits style from the current parent and propagates it as necessary
|
|
|
|
void QWidgetPrivate::inheritStyle()
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
#ifndef QT_NO_STYLE_STYLESHEET
|
|
|
|
Q_Q(QWidget);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
QStyleSheetStyle *proxy = extra ? qobject_cast<QStyleSheetStyle *>(extra->style) : 0;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
if (!q->styleSheet().isEmpty()) {
|
|
|
|
Q_ASSERT(proxy);
|
|
|
|
proxy->repolish(q);
|
|
|
|
return;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
QStyle *origStyle = proxy ? proxy->base : (extra ? (QStyle*)extra->style : 0);
|
|
|
|
QWidget *parent = q->parentWidget();
|
|
|
|
QStyle *parentStyle = (parent && parent->d_func()->extra) ? (QStyle*)parent->d_func()->extra->style : 0;
|
|
|
|
// If we have stylesheet on app or parent has stylesheet style, we need
|
|
|
|
// to be running a proxy
|
|
|
|
if (!qApp->styleSheet().isEmpty() || qobject_cast<QStyleSheetStyle *>(parentStyle)) {
|
|
|
|
QStyle *newStyle = parentStyle;
|
|
|
|
if (q->testAttribute(Qt::WA_SetStyle))
|
|
|
|
newStyle = new QStyleSheetStyle(origStyle);
|
|
|
|
else if (QStyleSheetStyle *newProxy = qobject_cast<QStyleSheetStyle *>(parentStyle))
|
|
|
|
newProxy->ref();
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
setStyle_helper(newStyle, true);
|
|
|
|
return;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
// So, we have no stylesheet on parent/app and we have an empty stylesheet
|
|
|
|
// we just need our original style back
|
|
|
|
if (origStyle == (extra ? (QStyle*)extra->style : 0)) // is it any different?
|
|
|
|
return;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
// We could have inherited the proxy from our parent (which has a custom style)
|
|
|
|
// In such a case we need to start following the application style (i.e revert
|
|
|
|
// the propagation behavior of QStyleSheetStyle)
|
|
|
|
if (!q->testAttribute(Qt::WA_SetStyle))
|
|
|
|
origStyle = 0;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
setStyle_helper(origStyle, true);
|
|
|
|
#endif // QT_NO_STYLE_STYLESHEET
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/*!
|
|
|
|
\fn bool QWidget::isWindow() const
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Returns true if the widget is an independent window, otherwise
|
|
|
|
returns false.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
A window is a widget that isn't visually the child of any other
|
|
|
|
widget and that usually has a frame and a
|
|
|
|
\l{QWidget::setWindowTitle()}{window title}.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
A window can have a \l{QWidget::parentWidget()}{parent widget}.
|
|
|
|
It will then be grouped with its parent and deleted when the
|
|
|
|
parent is deleted, minimized when the parent is minimized etc. If
|
|
|
|
supported by the window manager, it will also have a common
|
|
|
|
taskbar entry with its parent.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
QDialog and QMainWindow widgets are by default windows, even if a
|
|
|
|
parent widget is specified in the constructor. This behavior is
|
|
|
|
specified by the Qt::Window flag.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
\sa window(), isModal(), parentWidget()
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/*!
|
|
|
|
\property QWidget::modal
|
|
|
|
\brief whether the widget is a modal widget
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
This property only makes sense for windows. A modal widget
|
|
|
|
prevents widgets in all other windows from getting any input.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
By default, this property is false.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
\sa isWindow(), windowModality, QDialog
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/*!
|
|
|
|
\property QWidget::windowModality
|
|
|
|
\brief which windows are blocked by the modal widget
|
|
|
|
\since 4.1
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
This property only makes sense for windows. A modal widget
|
|
|
|
prevents widgets in other windows from getting input. The value of
|
|
|
|
this property controls which windows are blocked when the widget
|
|
|
|
is visible. Changing this property while the window is visible has
|
|
|
|
no effect; you must hide() the widget first, then show() it again.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
By default, this property is Qt::NonModal.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
\sa isWindow(), QWidget::modal, QDialog
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Qt::WindowModality QWidget::windowModality() const
|
|
|
|
{
|
2016-07-21 13:50:52 +00:00
|
|
|
return data->window_modality;
|
2015-12-10 05:06:13 +02:00
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
void QWidget::setWindowModality(Qt::WindowModality windowModality)
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
data->window_modality = windowModality;
|
|
|
|
// setModal_sys() will be called by setAttribute()
|
|
|
|
setAttribute(Qt::WA_ShowModal, (data->window_modality != Qt::NonModal));
|
|
|
|
setAttribute(Qt::WA_SetWindowModality, true);
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/*!
|
|
|
|
\fn bool QWidget::underMouse() const
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Returns true if the widget is under the mouse cursor; otherwise
|
|
|
|
returns false.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
This value is not updated properly during drag and drop
|
|
|
|
operations.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
\sa enterEvent(), leaveEvent()
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/*!
|
|
|
|
\property QWidget::minimized
|
|
|
|
\brief whether this widget is minimized (iconified)
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
This property is only relevant for windows.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
By default, this property is false.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
\sa showMinimized(), visible, show(), hide(), showNormal(), maximized
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
bool QWidget::isMinimized() const
|
|
|
|
{ return data->window_state & Qt::WindowMinimized; }
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/*!
|
|
|
|
Shows the widget minimized, as an icon.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Calling this function only affects \l{isWindow()}{windows}.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
\sa showNormal(), showMaximized(), show(), hide(), isVisible(),
|
|
|
|
isMinimized()
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
void QWidget::showMinimized()
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
bool isMin = isMinimized();
|
|
|
|
if (isMin && isVisible())
|
|
|
|
return;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
ensurePolished();
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
if (!isMin)
|
|
|
|
setWindowState((windowState() & ~Qt::WindowActive) | Qt::WindowMinimized);
|
|
|
|
show();
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/*!
|
|
|
|
\property QWidget::maximized
|
|
|
|
\brief whether this widget is maximized
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
This property is only relevant for windows.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
\note Due to limitations on some window systems, this does not always
|
|
|
|
report the expected results (e.g., if the user on X11 maximizes the
|
|
|
|
window via the window manager, Qt has no way of distinguishing this
|
|
|
|
from any other resize). This is expected to improve as window manager
|
|
|
|
protocols evolve.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
By default, this property is false.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
\sa windowState(), showMaximized(), visible, show(), hide(), showNormal(), minimized
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
bool QWidget::isMaximized() const
|
|
|
|
{ return data->window_state & Qt::WindowMaximized; }
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/*!
|
|
|
|
Returns the current window state. The window state is a OR'ed
|
|
|
|
combination of Qt::WindowState: Qt::WindowMinimized,
|
|
|
|
Qt::WindowMaximized, Qt::WindowFullScreen, and Qt::WindowActive.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
\sa Qt::WindowState setWindowState()
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
Qt::WindowStates QWidget::windowState() const
|
|
|
|
{
|
2016-07-21 13:50:52 +00:00
|
|
|
return data->window_state;
|
2015-12-10 05:06:13 +02:00
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/*!\internal
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
The function sets the window state on child widgets similar to
|
|
|
|
setWindowState(). The difference is that the window state changed
|
|
|
|
event has the isOverride() flag set. It exists mainly to keep
|
|
|
|
Q3Workspace working.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
void QWidget::overrideWindowState(Qt::WindowStates newstate)
|
|
|
|
{
|
2016-07-21 13:50:52 +00:00
|
|
|
QWindowStateChangeEvent e(data->window_state, true);
|
2015-12-10 05:06:13 +02:00
|
|
|
data->window_state = newstate;
|
|
|
|
QApplication::sendEvent(this, &e);
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/*!
|
|
|
|
\fn void QWidget::setWindowState(Qt::WindowStates windowState)
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Sets the window state to \a windowState. The window state is a OR'ed
|
|
|
|
combination of Qt::WindowState: Qt::WindowMinimized,
|
|
|
|
Qt::WindowMaximized, Qt::WindowFullScreen, and Qt::WindowActive.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
If the window is not visible (i.e. isVisible() returns false), the
|
|
|
|
window state will take effect when show() is called. For visible
|
|
|
|
windows, the change is immediate. For example, to toggle between
|
|
|
|
full-screen and normal mode, use the following code:
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
\snippet doc/src/snippets/code/src_gui_kernel_qwidget.cpp 0
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
In order to restore and activate a minimized window (while
|
|
|
|
preserving its maximized and/or full-screen state), use the following:
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
\snippet doc/src/snippets/code/src_gui_kernel_qwidget.cpp 1
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Calling this function will hide the widget. You must call show() to make
|
|
|
|
the widget visible again.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
\note On some window systems Qt::WindowActive is not immediate, and may be
|
|
|
|
ignored in certain cases.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
When the window state changes, the widget receives a changeEvent()
|
|
|
|
of type QEvent::WindowStateChange.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
\sa Qt::WindowState windowState()
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/*!
|
|
|
|
\property QWidget::fullScreen
|
|
|
|
\brief whether the widget is shown in full screen mode
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
A widget in full screen mode occupies the whole screen area and does not
|
|
|
|
display window decorations, such as a title bar.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
By default, this property is false.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
\sa windowState(), minimized, maximized
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
bool QWidget::isFullScreen() const
|
|
|
|
{ return data->window_state & Qt::WindowFullScreen; }
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/*!
|
|
|
|
Shows the widget in full-screen mode.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Calling this function only affects \l{isWindow()}{windows}.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
To return from full-screen mode, call showNormal().
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Full-screen mode works fine under Windows, but has certain
|
|
|
|
problems under X. These problems are due to limitations of the
|
|
|
|
ICCCM protocol that specifies the communication between X11
|
|
|
|
clients and the window manager. ICCCM simply does not understand
|
|
|
|
the concept of non-decorated full-screen windows. Therefore, the
|
|
|
|
best we can do is to request a borderless window and place and
|
|
|
|
resize it to fill the entire screen. Depending on the window
|
|
|
|
manager, this may or may not work. The borderless window is
|
|
|
|
requested using MOTIF hints, which are at least partially
|
|
|
|
supported by virtually all modern window managers.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
An alternative would be to bypass the window manager entirely and
|
|
|
|
create a window with the Qt::X11BypassWindowManagerHint flag. This
|
|
|
|
has other severe problems though, like totally broken keyboard focus
|
|
|
|
and very strange effects on desktop changes or when the user raises
|
|
|
|
other windows.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
X11 window managers that follow modern post-ICCCM specifications
|
|
|
|
support full-screen mode properly.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
\sa showNormal(), showMaximized(), show(), hide(), isVisible()
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
void QWidget::showFullScreen()
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
#ifdef Q_WS_MAC
|
|
|
|
// If the unified toolbar is enabled, we have to disable it before going fullscreen.
|
|
|
|
QMainWindow *mainWindow = qobject_cast<QMainWindow*>(this);
|
|
|
|
if (mainWindow && mainWindow->unifiedTitleAndToolBarOnMac()) {
|
|
|
|
mainWindow->setUnifiedTitleAndToolBarOnMac(false);
|
|
|
|
QMainWindowLayout *mainLayout = qobject_cast<QMainWindowLayout*>(mainWindow->layout());
|
|
|
|
mainLayout->activateUnifiedToolbarAfterFullScreen = true;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
#endif // Q_WS_MAC
|
|
|
|
ensurePolished();
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
setWindowState((windowState() & ~(Qt::WindowMinimized | Qt::WindowMaximized))
|
|
|
|
| Qt::WindowFullScreen);
|
|
|
|
show();
|
|
|
|
activateWindow();
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/*!
|
|
|
|
Shows the widget maximized.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Calling this function only affects \l{isWindow()}{windows}.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
On X11, this function may not work properly with certain window
|
|
|
|
managers. See the \l{Window Geometry} documentation for an explanation.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
\sa setWindowState(), showNormal(), showMinimized(), show(), hide(), isVisible()
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
void QWidget::showMaximized()
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
ensurePolished();
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
setWindowState((windowState() & ~(Qt::WindowMinimized | Qt::WindowFullScreen))
|
|
|
|
| Qt::WindowMaximized);
|
|
|
|
#ifdef Q_WS_MAC
|
|
|
|
// If the unified toolbar was enabled before going fullscreen, we have to enable it back.
|
|
|
|
QMainWindow *mainWindow = qobject_cast<QMainWindow*>(this);
|
|
|
|
if (mainWindow)
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
QMainWindowLayout *mainLayout = qobject_cast<QMainWindowLayout*>(mainWindow->layout());
|
|
|
|
if (mainLayout->activateUnifiedToolbarAfterFullScreen) {
|
|
|
|
mainWindow->setUnifiedTitleAndToolBarOnMac(true);
|
|
|
|
mainLayout->activateUnifiedToolbarAfterFullScreen = false;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
#endif // Q_WS_MAC
|
|
|
|
show();
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/*!
|
|
|
|
Restores the widget after it has been maximized or minimized.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Calling this function only affects \l{isWindow()}{windows}.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
\sa setWindowState(), showMinimized(), showMaximized(), show(), hide(), isVisible()
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
void QWidget::showNormal()
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
ensurePolished();
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
setWindowState(windowState() & ~(Qt::WindowMinimized
|
|
|
|
| Qt::WindowMaximized
|
|
|
|
| Qt::WindowFullScreen));
|
|
|
|
#ifdef Q_WS_MAC
|
|
|
|
// If the unified toolbar was enabled before going fullscreen, we have to enable it back.
|
|
|
|
QMainWindow *mainWindow = qobject_cast<QMainWindow*>(this);
|
|
|
|
if (mainWindow)
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
QMainWindowLayout *mainLayout = qobject_cast<QMainWindowLayout*>(mainWindow->layout());
|
|
|
|
if (mainLayout->activateUnifiedToolbarAfterFullScreen) {
|
|
|
|
mainWindow->setUnifiedTitleAndToolBarOnMac(true);
|
|
|
|
mainLayout->activateUnifiedToolbarAfterFullScreen = false;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
#endif // Q_WS_MAC
|
|
|
|
show();
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/*!
|
|
|
|
Returns true if this widget would become enabled if \a ancestor is
|
|
|
|
enabled; otherwise returns false.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
This is the case if neither the widget itself nor every parent up
|
|
|
|
to but excluding \a ancestor has been explicitly disabled.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
isEnabledTo(0) is equivalent to isEnabled().
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
\sa setEnabled() enabled
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
bool QWidget::isEnabledTo(QWidget* ancestor) const
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
const QWidget * w = this;
|
|
|
|
while (!w->testAttribute(Qt::WA_ForceDisabled)
|
|
|
|
&& !w->isWindow()
|
|
|
|
&& w->parentWidget()
|
|
|
|
&& w->parentWidget() != ancestor)
|
|
|
|
w = w->parentWidget();
|
|
|
|
return !w->testAttribute(Qt::WA_ForceDisabled);
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
#ifndef QT_NO_ACTION
|
|
|
|
/*!
|
|
|
|
Appends the action \a action to this widget's list of actions.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
All QWidgets have a list of \l{QAction}s, however they can be
|
|
|
|
represented graphically in many different ways. The default use of
|
|
|
|
the QAction list (as returned by actions()) is to create a context
|
|
|
|
QMenu.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
A QWidget should only have one of each action and adding an action
|
|
|
|
it already has will not cause the same action to be in the widget twice.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
The ownership of \a action is not transferred to this QWidget.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
\sa removeAction(), insertAction(), actions(), QMenu
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
void QWidget::addAction(QAction *action)
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
insertAction(0, action);
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/*!
|
|
|
|
Appends the actions \a actions to this widget's list of actions.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
\sa removeAction(), QMenu, addAction()
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
void QWidget::addActions(QList<QAction*> actions)
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
for(int i = 0; i < actions.count(); i++)
|
|
|
|
insertAction(0, actions.at(i));
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/*!
|
|
|
|
Inserts the action \a action to this widget's list of actions,
|
|
|
|
before the action \a before. It appends the action if \a before is 0 or
|
|
|
|
\a before is not a valid action for this widget.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
A QWidget should only have one of each action.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
\sa removeAction(), addAction(), QMenu, contextMenuPolicy, actions()
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
void QWidget::insertAction(QAction *before, QAction *action)
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
if(!action) {
|
|
|
|
qWarning("QWidget::insertAction: Attempt to insert null action");
|
|
|
|
return;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Q_D(QWidget);
|
|
|
|
if(d->actions.contains(action))
|
|
|
|
removeAction(action);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
int pos = d->actions.indexOf(before);
|
|
|
|
if (pos < 0) {
|
|
|
|
before = 0;
|
|
|
|
pos = d->actions.size();
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
d->actions.insert(pos, action);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
QActionPrivate *apriv = action->d_func();
|
|
|
|
apriv->widgets.append(this);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
QActionEvent e(QEvent::ActionAdded, action, before);
|
|
|
|
QApplication::sendEvent(this, &e);
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/*!
|
|
|
|
Inserts the actions \a actions to this widget's list of actions,
|
|
|
|
before the action \a before. It appends the action if \a before is 0 or
|
|
|
|
\a before is not a valid action for this widget.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
A QWidget can have at most one of each action.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
\sa removeAction(), QMenu, insertAction(), contextMenuPolicy
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
void QWidget::insertActions(QAction *before, QList<QAction*> actions)
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
for(int i = 0; i < actions.count(); ++i)
|
|
|
|
insertAction(before, actions.at(i));
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/*!
|
|
|
|
Removes the action \a action from this widget's list of actions.
|
|
|
|
\sa insertAction(), actions(), insertAction()
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
void QWidget::removeAction(QAction *action)
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
if (!action)
|
|
|
|
return;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Q_D(QWidget);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
QActionPrivate *apriv = action->d_func();
|
|
|
|
apriv->widgets.removeAll(this);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
if (d->actions.removeAll(action)) {
|
|
|
|
QActionEvent e(QEvent::ActionRemoved, action);
|
|
|
|
QApplication::sendEvent(this, &e);
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/*!
|
|
|
|
Returns the (possibly empty) list of this widget's actions.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
\sa contextMenuPolicy, insertAction(), removeAction()
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
QList<QAction*> QWidget::actions() const
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
Q_D(const QWidget);
|
|
|
|
return d->actions;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
#endif // QT_NO_ACTION
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/*!
|
|
|
|
\fn bool QWidget::isEnabledToTLW() const
|
|
|
|
\obsolete
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
This function is deprecated. It is equivalent to isEnabled()
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/*!
|
|
|
|
\property QWidget::enabled
|
|
|
|
\brief whether the widget is enabled
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
In general an enabled widget handles keyboard and mouse events; a disabled
|
|
|
|
widget does not. An exception is made with \l{QAbstractButton}.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Some widgets display themselves differently when they are
|
|
|
|
disabled. For example a button might draw its label grayed out. If
|
|
|
|
your widget needs to know when it becomes enabled or disabled, you
|
|
|
|
can use the changeEvent() with type QEvent::EnabledChange.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Disabling a widget implicitly disables all its children. Enabling
|
|
|
|
respectively enables all child widgets unless they have been
|
|
|
|
explicitly disabled.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
By default, this property is true.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
\sa isEnabledTo(), QKeyEvent, QMouseEvent, changeEvent()
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
void QWidget::setEnabled(bool enable)
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
Q_D(QWidget);
|
|
|
|
setAttribute(Qt::WA_ForceDisabled, !enable);
|
|
|
|
d->setEnabled_helper(enable);
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
void QWidgetPrivate::setEnabled_helper(bool enable)
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
Q_Q(QWidget);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
if (enable && !q->isWindow() && q->parentWidget() && !q->parentWidget()->isEnabled())
|
|
|
|
return; // nothing we can do
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
if (enable != q->testAttribute(Qt::WA_Disabled))
|
|
|
|
return; // nothing to do
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
q->setAttribute(Qt::WA_Disabled, !enable);
|
|
|
|
updateSystemBackground();
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
if (!enable && q->window()->focusWidget() == q) {
|
|
|
|
bool parentIsEnabled = (!q->parentWidget() || q->parentWidget()->isEnabled());
|
|
|
|
if (!parentIsEnabled || !q->focusNextChild())
|
|
|
|
q->clearFocus();
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Qt::WidgetAttribute attribute = enable ? Qt::WA_ForceDisabled : Qt::WA_Disabled;
|
|
|
|
for (int i = 0; i < children.size(); ++i) {
|
|
|
|
QWidget *w = qobject_cast<QWidget *>(children.at(i));
|
|
|
|
if (w && !w->testAttribute(attribute))
|
|
|
|
w->d_func()->setEnabled_helper(enable);
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
#if defined(Q_WS_X11)
|
|
|
|
if (q->testAttribute(Qt::WA_SetCursor) || q->isWindow()) {
|
|
|
|
// enforce the windows behavior of clearing the cursor on
|
|
|
|
// disabled widgets
|
|
|
|
qt_x11_enforce_cursor(q);
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
#endif
|
|
|
|
#if defined(Q_WS_MAC)
|
|
|
|
setEnabled_helper_sys(enable);
|
|
|
|
#endif
|
|
|
|
#ifndef QT_NO_IM
|
|
|
|
if (q->testAttribute(Qt::WA_InputMethodEnabled) && q->hasFocus()) {
|
|
|
|
QWidget *focusWidget = effectiveFocusWidget();
|
|
|
|
QInputContext *qic = focusWidget->d_func()->inputContext();
|
|
|
|
if (enable) {
|
|
|
|
if (focusWidget->testAttribute(Qt::WA_InputMethodEnabled))
|
|
|
|
qic->setFocusWidget(focusWidget);
|
|
|
|
} else {
|
|
|
|
qic->reset();
|
|
|
|
qic->setFocusWidget(0);
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
#endif //QT_NO_IM
|
|
|
|
QEvent e(QEvent::EnabledChange);
|
|
|
|
QApplication::sendEvent(q, &e);
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/*!
|
|
|
|
\property QWidget::acceptDrops
|
|
|
|
\brief whether drop events are enabled for this widget
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Setting this property to true announces to the system that this
|
|
|
|
widget \e may be able to accept drop events.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
If the widget is the desktop (windowType() == Qt::Desktop), this may
|
|
|
|
fail if another application is using the desktop; you can call
|
|
|
|
acceptDrops() to test if this occurs.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
\warning Do not modify this property in a drag and drop event handler.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
By default, this property is false.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
\sa {Drag and Drop}
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
bool QWidget::acceptDrops() const
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
return testAttribute(Qt::WA_AcceptDrops);
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
void QWidget::setAcceptDrops(bool on)
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
setAttribute(Qt::WA_AcceptDrops, on);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/*!
|
|
|
|
\fn void QWidget::enabledChange(bool)
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
\internal
|
|
|
|
\obsolete
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/*!
|
|
|
|
\fn void QWidget::paletteChange(const QPalette &)
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
\internal
|
|
|
|
\obsolete
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/*!
|
|
|
|
\fn void QWidget::fontChange(const QFont &)
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
\internal
|
|
|
|
\obsolete
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/*!
|
|
|
|
\fn void QWidget::windowActivationChange(bool)
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
\internal
|
|
|
|
\obsolete
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/*!
|
|
|
|
\fn void QWidget::languageChange()
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
\obsolete
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/*!
|
|
|
|
\fn void QWidget::styleChange(QStyle& style)
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
\internal
|
|
|
|
\obsolete
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/*!
|
|
|
|
Disables widget input events if \a disable is true; otherwise
|
|
|
|
enables input events.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
See the \l enabled documentation for more information.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
\sa isEnabledTo(), QKeyEvent, QMouseEvent, changeEvent()
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
void QWidget::setDisabled(bool disable)
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
setEnabled(!disable);
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/*!
|
|
|
|
\property QWidget::frameGeometry
|
|
|
|
\brief geometry of the widget relative to its parent including any
|
|
|
|
window frame
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
See the \l{Window Geometry} documentation for an overview of geometry
|
|
|
|
issues with windows.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
By default, this property contains a value that depends on the user's
|
|
|
|
platform and screen geometry.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
\sa geometry() x() y() pos()
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
QRect QWidget::frameGeometry() const
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
Q_D(const QWidget);
|
|
|
|
if (isWindow() && ! (windowType() == Qt::Popup)) {
|
|
|
|
QRect fs = d->frameStrut();
|
|
|
|
return QRect(data->crect.x() - fs.left(),
|
|
|
|
data->crect.y() - fs.top(),
|
|
|
|
data->crect.width() + fs.left() + fs.right(),
|
|
|
|
data->crect.height() + fs.top() + fs.bottom());
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
return data->crect;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/*!
|
|
|
|
\property QWidget::x
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
\brief the x coordinate of the widget relative to its parent including
|
|
|
|
any window frame
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
See the \l{Window Geometry} documentation for an overview of geometry
|
|
|
|
issues with windows.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
By default, this property has a value of 0.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
\sa frameGeometry, y, pos
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
int QWidget::x() const
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
Q_D(const QWidget);
|
|
|
|
if (isWindow() && ! (windowType() == Qt::Popup))
|
|
|
|
return data->crect.x() - d->frameStrut().left();
|
|
|
|
return data->crect.x();
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/*!
|
|
|
|
\property QWidget::y
|
|
|
|
\brief the y coordinate of the widget relative to its parent and
|
|
|
|
including any window frame
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
See the \l{Window Geometry} documentation for an overview of geometry
|
|
|
|
issues with windows.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
By default, this property has a value of 0.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
\sa frameGeometry, x, pos
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
int QWidget::y() const
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
Q_D(const QWidget);
|
|
|
|
if (isWindow() && ! (windowType() == Qt::Popup))
|
|
|
|
return data->crect.y() - d->frameStrut().top();
|
|
|
|
return data->crect.y();
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/*!
|
|
|
|
\property QWidget::pos
|
|
|
|
\brief the position of the widget within its parent widget
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
If the widget is a window, the position is that of the widget on
|
|
|
|
the desktop, including its frame.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
When changing the position, the widget, if visible, receives a
|
|
|
|
move event (moveEvent()) immediately. If the widget is not
|
|
|
|
currently visible, it is guaranteed to receive an event before it
|
|
|
|
is shown.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
By default, this property contains a position that refers to the
|
|
|
|
origin.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
\warning Calling move() or setGeometry() inside moveEvent() can
|
|
|
|
lead to infinite recursion.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
See the \l{Window Geometry} documentation for an overview of geometry
|
|
|
|
issues with windows.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
\sa frameGeometry, size x(), y()
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
QPoint QWidget::pos() const
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
Q_D(const QWidget);
|
|
|
|
if (isWindow() && ! (windowType() == Qt::Popup)) {
|
|
|
|
QRect fs = d->frameStrut();
|
|
|
|
return QPoint(data->crect.x() - fs.left(), data->crect.y() - fs.top());
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
return data->crect.topLeft();
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/*!
|
|
|
|
\property QWidget::geometry
|
|
|
|
\brief the geometry of the widget relative to its parent and
|
|
|
|
excluding the window frame
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
When changing the geometry, the widget, if visible, receives a
|
|
|
|
move event (moveEvent()) and/or a resize event (resizeEvent())
|
|
|
|
immediately. If the widget is not currently visible, it is
|
|
|
|
guaranteed to receive appropriate events before it is shown.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
The size component is adjusted if it lies outside the range
|
|
|
|
defined by minimumSize() and maximumSize().
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
\warning Calling setGeometry() inside resizeEvent() or moveEvent()
|
|
|
|
can lead to infinite recursion.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
See the \l{Window Geometry} documentation for an overview of geometry
|
|
|
|
issues with windows.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
By default, this property contains a value that depends on the user's
|
|
|
|
platform and screen geometry.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
\sa frameGeometry(), rect(), move(), resize(), moveEvent(),
|
|
|
|
resizeEvent(), minimumSize(), maximumSize()
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/*!
|
|
|
|
\property QWidget::normalGeometry
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
\brief the geometry of the widget as it will appear when shown as
|
|
|
|
a normal (not maximized or full screen) top-level widget
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
For child widgets this property always holds an empty rectangle.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
By default, this property contains an empty rectangle.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
\sa QWidget::windowState(), QWidget::geometry
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/*!
|
|
|
|
\property QWidget::size
|
|
|
|
\brief the size of the widget excluding any window frame
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
If the widget is visible when it is being resized, it receives a resize event
|
|
|
|
(resizeEvent()) immediately. If the widget is not currently
|
|
|
|
visible, it is guaranteed to receive an event before it is shown.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
The size is adjusted if it lies outside the range defined by
|
|
|
|
minimumSize() and maximumSize().
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
By default, this property contains a value that depends on the user's
|
|
|
|
platform and screen geometry.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
\warning Calling resize() or setGeometry() inside resizeEvent() can
|
|
|
|
lead to infinite recursion.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
\note Setting the size to \c{QSize(0, 0)} will cause the widget to not
|
|
|
|
appear on screen. This also applies to windows.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
\sa pos, geometry, minimumSize, maximumSize, resizeEvent(), adjustSize()
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/*!
|
|
|
|
\property QWidget::width
|
|
|
|
\brief the width of the widget excluding any window frame
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
See the \l{Window Geometry} documentation for an overview of geometry
|
|
|
|
issues with windows.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
\note Do not use this function to find the width of a screen on
|
|
|
|
a \l{QDesktopWidget}{multiple screen desktop}. Read
|
|
|
|
\l{QDesktopWidget#Screen Geometry}{this note} for details.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
By default, this property contains a value that depends on the user's
|
|
|
|
platform and screen geometry.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
\sa geometry, height, size
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/*!
|
|
|
|
\property QWidget::height
|
|
|
|
\brief the height of the widget excluding any window frame
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
See the \l{Window Geometry} documentation for an overview of geometry
|
|
|
|
issues with windows.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
\note Do not use this function to find the height of a screen
|
|
|
|
on a \l{QDesktopWidget}{multiple screen desktop}. Read
|
|
|
|
\l{QDesktopWidget#Screen Geometry}{this note} for details.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
By default, this property contains a value that depends on the user's
|
|
|
|
platform and screen geometry.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
\sa geometry, width, size
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/*!
|
|
|
|
\property QWidget::rect
|
|
|
|
\brief the internal geometry of the widget excluding any window
|
|
|
|
frame
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
The rect property equals QRect(0, 0, width(), height()).
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
See the \l{Window Geometry} documentation for an overview of geometry
|
|
|
|
issues with windows.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
By default, this property contains a value that depends on the user's
|
|
|
|
platform and screen geometry.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
\sa size
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
QRect QWidget::normalGeometry() const
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
Q_D(const QWidget);
|
|
|
|
if (!d->extra || !d->extra->topextra)
|
|
|
|
return QRect();
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
if (!isMaximized() && !isFullScreen())
|
|
|
|
return geometry();
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
return d->topData()->normalGeometry;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/*!
|
|
|
|
\property QWidget::childrenRect
|
|
|
|
\brief the bounding rectangle of the widget's children
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Hidden children are excluded.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
By default, for a widget with no children, this property contains a
|
|
|
|
rectangle with zero width and height located at the origin.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
\sa childrenRegion() geometry()
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
QRect QWidget::childrenRect() const
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
Q_D(const QWidget);
|
|
|
|
QRect r(0, 0, 0, 0);
|
|
|
|
for (int i = 0; i < d->children.size(); ++i) {
|
|
|
|
QWidget *w = qobject_cast<QWidget *>(d->children.at(i));
|
|
|
|
if (w && !w->isWindow() && !w->isHidden())
|
|
|
|
r |= w->geometry();
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
return r;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/*!
|
|
|
|
\property QWidget::childrenRegion
|
|
|
|
\brief the combined region occupied by the widget's children
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Hidden children are excluded.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
By default, for a widget with no children, this property contains an
|
|
|
|
empty region.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
\sa childrenRect() geometry() mask()
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
QRegion QWidget::childrenRegion() const
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
Q_D(const QWidget);
|
|
|
|
QRegion r;
|
|
|
|
for (int i = 0; i < d->children.size(); ++i) {
|
|
|
|
QWidget *w = qobject_cast<QWidget *>(d->children.at(i));
|
|
|
|
if (w && !w->isWindow() && !w->isHidden()) {
|
|
|
|
QRegion mask = w->mask();
|
|
|
|
if (mask.isEmpty())
|
|
|
|
r |= w->geometry();
|
|
|
|
else
|
|
|
|
r |= mask.translated(w->pos());
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
return r;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/*!
|
|
|
|
\property QWidget::minimumSize
|
|
|
|
\brief the widget's minimum size
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
The widget cannot be resized to a smaller size than the minimum
|
|
|
|
widget size. The widget's size is forced to the minimum size if
|
|
|
|
the current size is smaller.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
The minimum size set by this function will override the minimum size
|
|
|
|
defined by QLayout. In order to unset the minimum size, use a
|
|
|
|
value of \c{QSize(0, 0)}.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
By default, this property contains a size with zero width and height.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
\sa minimumWidth, minimumHeight, maximumSize, sizeIncrement
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
QSize QWidget::minimumSize() const
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
Q_D(const QWidget);
|
|
|
|
return d->extra ? QSize(d->extra->minw, d->extra->minh) : QSize(0, 0);
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/*!
|
|
|
|
\property QWidget::maximumSize
|
|
|
|
\brief the widget's maximum size in pixels
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
The widget cannot be resized to a larger size than the maximum
|
|
|
|
widget size.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
By default, this property contains a size in which both width and height
|
|
|
|
have values of 16777215.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
\note The definition of the \c QWIDGETSIZE_MAX macro limits the maximum size
|
|
|
|
of widgets.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
\sa maximumWidth, maximumHeight, minimumSize, sizeIncrement
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
QSize QWidget::maximumSize() const
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
Q_D(const QWidget);
|
|
|
|
return d->extra ? QSize(d->extra->maxw, d->extra->maxh)
|
|
|
|
: QSize(QWIDGETSIZE_MAX, QWIDGETSIZE_MAX);
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/*!
|
|
|
|
\property QWidget::minimumWidth
|
|
|
|
\brief the widget's minimum width in pixels
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
This property corresponds to the width held by the \l minimumSize property.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
By default, this property has a value of 0.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
\sa minimumSize, minimumHeight
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/*!
|
|
|
|
\property QWidget::minimumHeight
|
|
|
|
\brief the widget's minimum height in pixels
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
This property corresponds to the height held by the \l minimumSize property.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
By default, this property has a value of 0.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
\sa minimumSize, minimumWidth
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/*!
|
|
|
|
\property QWidget::maximumWidth
|
|
|
|
\brief the widget's maximum width in pixels
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
This property corresponds to the width held by the \l maximumSize property.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
By default, this property contains a value of 16777215.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
\note The definition of the \c QWIDGETSIZE_MAX macro limits the maximum size
|
|
|
|
of widgets.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
\sa maximumSize, maximumHeight
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/*!
|
|
|
|
\property QWidget::maximumHeight
|
|
|
|
\brief the widget's maximum height in pixels
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
This property corresponds to the height held by the \l maximumSize property.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
By default, this property contains a value of 16777215.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
\note The definition of the \c QWIDGETSIZE_MAX macro limits the maximum size
|
|
|
|
of widgets.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
\sa maximumSize, maximumWidth
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/*!
|
|
|
|
\property QWidget::sizeIncrement
|
|
|
|
\brief the size increment of the widget
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
When the user resizes the window, the size will move in steps of
|
|
|
|
sizeIncrement().width() pixels horizontally and
|
|
|
|
sizeIncrement.height() pixels vertically, with baseSize() as the
|
|
|
|
basis. Preferred widget sizes are for non-negative integers \e i
|
|
|
|
and \e j:
|
|
|
|
\snippet doc/src/snippets/code/src_gui_kernel_qwidget.cpp 2
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Note that while you can set the size increment for all widgets, it
|
|
|
|
only affects windows.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
By default, this property contains a size with zero width and height.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
\warning The size increment has no effect under Windows, and may
|
|
|
|
be disregarded by the window manager on X11.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
\sa size, minimumSize, maximumSize
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
QSize QWidget::sizeIncrement() const
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
Q_D(const QWidget);
|
|
|
|
return (d->extra && d->extra->topextra)
|
|
|
|
? QSize(d->extra->topextra->incw, d->extra->topextra->inch)
|
|
|
|
: QSize(0, 0);
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/*!
|
|
|
|
\property QWidget::baseSize
|
|
|
|
\brief the base size of the widget
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
The base size is used to calculate a proper widget size if the
|
|
|
|
widget defines sizeIncrement().
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
By default, for a newly-created widget, this property contains a size with
|
|
|
|
zero width and height.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
\sa setSizeIncrement()
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
QSize QWidget::baseSize() const
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
Q_D(const QWidget);
|
|
|
|
return (d->extra != 0 && d->extra->topextra != 0)
|
|
|
|
? QSize(d->extra->topextra->basew, d->extra->topextra->baseh)
|
|
|
|
: QSize(0, 0);
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
bool QWidgetPrivate::setMinimumSize_helper(int &minw, int &minh)
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
Q_Q(QWidget);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
int mw = minw, mh = minh;
|
|
|
|
if (mw == QWIDGETSIZE_MAX)
|
|
|
|
mw = 0;
|
|
|
|
if (mh == QWIDGETSIZE_MAX)
|
|
|
|
mh = 0;
|
|
|
|
if (minw > QWIDGETSIZE_MAX || minh > QWIDGETSIZE_MAX) {
|
|
|
|
qWarning("QWidget::setMinimumSize: (%s/%s) "
|
|
|
|
"The largest allowed size is (%d,%d)",
|
|
|
|
q->objectName().toLocal8Bit().data(), q->metaObject()->className(), QWIDGETSIZE_MAX,
|
|
|
|
QWIDGETSIZE_MAX);
|
|
|
|
minw = mw = qMin<int>(minw, QWIDGETSIZE_MAX);
|
|
|
|
minh = mh = qMin<int>(minh, QWIDGETSIZE_MAX);
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if (minw < 0 || minh < 0) {
|
|
|
|
qWarning("QWidget::setMinimumSize: (%s/%s) Negative sizes (%d,%d) "
|
|
|
|
"are not possible",
|
|
|
|
q->objectName().toLocal8Bit().data(), q->metaObject()->className(), minw, minh);
|
|
|
|
minw = mw = qMax(minw, 0);
|
|
|
|
minh = mh = qMax(minh, 0);
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
createExtra();
|
|
|
|
if (extra->minw == mw && extra->minh == mh)
|
|
|
|
return false;
|
|
|
|
extra->minw = mw;
|
|
|
|
extra->minh = mh;
|
|
|
|
extra->explicitMinSize = (mw ? Qt::Horizontal : 0) | (mh ? Qt::Vertical : 0);
|
|
|
|
return true;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/*!
|
|
|
|
\overload
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
This function corresponds to setMinimumSize(QSize(minw, minh)).
|
|
|
|
Sets the minimum width to \a minw and the minimum height to \a
|
|
|
|
minh.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
void QWidget::setMinimumSize(int minw, int minh)
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
Q_D(QWidget);
|
|
|
|
if (!d->setMinimumSize_helper(minw, minh))
|
|
|
|
return;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
if (isWindow())
|
|
|
|
d->setConstraints_sys();
|
|
|
|
if (minw > width() || minh > height()) {
|
|
|
|
bool resized = testAttribute(Qt::WA_Resized);
|
|
|
|
bool maximized = isMaximized();
|
|
|
|
resize(qMax(minw,width()), qMax(minh,height()));
|
|
|
|
setAttribute(Qt::WA_Resized, resized); //not a user resize
|
|
|
|
if (maximized)
|
|
|
|
data->window_state = data->window_state | Qt::WindowMaximized;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
#ifndef QT_NO_GRAPHICSVIEW
|
|
|
|
if (d->extra) {
|
|
|
|
if (d->extra->proxyWidget)
|
|
|
|
d->extra->proxyWidget->setMinimumSize(minw, minh);
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
#endif
|
|
|
|
d->updateGeometry_helper(d->extra->minw == d->extra->maxw && d->extra->minh == d->extra->maxh);
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
bool QWidgetPrivate::setMaximumSize_helper(int &maxw, int &maxh)
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
Q_Q(QWidget);
|
|
|
|
if (maxw > QWIDGETSIZE_MAX || maxh > QWIDGETSIZE_MAX) {
|
|
|
|
qWarning("QWidget::setMaximumSize: (%s/%s) "
|
|
|
|
"The largest allowed size is (%d,%d)",
|
|
|
|
q->objectName().toLocal8Bit().data(), q->metaObject()->className(), QWIDGETSIZE_MAX,
|
|
|
|
QWIDGETSIZE_MAX);
|
|
|
|
maxw = qMin<int>(maxw, QWIDGETSIZE_MAX);
|
|
|
|
maxh = qMin<int>(maxh, QWIDGETSIZE_MAX);
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if (maxw < 0 || maxh < 0) {
|
|
|
|
qWarning("QWidget::setMaximumSize: (%s/%s) Negative sizes (%d,%d) "
|
|
|
|
"are not possible",
|
|
|
|
q->objectName().toLocal8Bit().data(), q->metaObject()->className(), maxw, maxh);
|
|
|
|
maxw = qMax(maxw, 0);
|
|
|
|
maxh = qMax(maxh, 0);
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
createExtra();
|
|
|
|
if (extra->maxw == maxw && extra->maxh == maxh)
|
|
|
|
return false;
|
|
|
|
extra->maxw = maxw;
|
|
|
|
extra->maxh = maxh;
|
|
|
|
extra->explicitMaxSize = (maxw != QWIDGETSIZE_MAX ? Qt::Horizontal : 0) |
|
|
|
|
(maxh != QWIDGETSIZE_MAX ? Qt::Vertical : 0);
|
|
|
|
return true;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/*!
|
|
|
|
\overload
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
This function corresponds to setMaximumSize(QSize(\a maxw, \a
|
|
|
|
maxh)). Sets the maximum width to \a maxw and the maximum height
|
|
|
|
to \a maxh.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
void QWidget::setMaximumSize(int maxw, int maxh)
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
Q_D(QWidget);
|
|
|
|
if (!d->setMaximumSize_helper(maxw, maxh))
|
|
|
|
return;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
if (isWindow())
|
|
|
|
d->setConstraints_sys();
|
|
|
|
if (maxw < width() || maxh < height()) {
|
|
|
|
bool resized = testAttribute(Qt::WA_Resized);
|
|
|
|
resize(qMin(maxw,width()), qMin(maxh,height()));
|
|
|
|
setAttribute(Qt::WA_Resized, resized); //not a user resize
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
#ifndef QT_NO_GRAPHICSVIEW
|
|
|
|
if (d->extra) {
|
|
|
|
if (d->extra->proxyWidget)
|
|
|
|
d->extra->proxyWidget->setMaximumSize(maxw, maxh);
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
#endif
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
d->updateGeometry_helper(d->extra->minw == d->extra->maxw && d->extra->minh == d->extra->maxh);
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/*!
|
|
|
|
\overload
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Sets the x (width) size increment to \a w and the y (height) size
|
|
|
|
increment to \a h.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
void QWidget::setSizeIncrement(int w, int h)
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
Q_D(QWidget);
|
|
|
|
d->createTLExtra();
|
|
|
|
QTLWExtra* x = d->topData();
|
|
|
|
if (x->incw == w && x->inch == h)
|
|
|
|
return;
|
|
|
|
x->incw = w;
|
|
|
|
x->inch = h;
|
|
|
|
if (isWindow())
|
|
|
|
d->setConstraints_sys();
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/*!
|
|
|
|
\overload
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
This corresponds to setBaseSize(QSize(\a basew, \a baseh)). Sets
|
|
|
|
the widgets base size to width \a basew and height \a baseh.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
void QWidget::setBaseSize(int basew, int baseh)
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
Q_D(QWidget);
|
|
|
|
d->createTLExtra();
|
|
|
|
QTLWExtra* x = d->topData();
|
|
|
|
if (x->basew == basew && x->baseh == baseh)
|
|
|
|
return;
|
|
|
|
x->basew = basew;
|
|
|
|
x->baseh = baseh;
|
|
|
|
if (isWindow())
|
|
|
|
d->setConstraints_sys();
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/*!
|
|
|
|
Sets both the minimum and maximum sizes of the widget to \a s,
|
|
|
|
thereby preventing it from ever growing or shrinking.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
This will override the default size constraints set by QLayout.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
To remove constraints, set the size to QWIDGETSIZE_MAX.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Alternatively, if you want the widget to have a
|
|
|
|
fixed size based on its contents, you can call
|
|
|
|
QLayout::setSizeConstraint(QLayout::SetFixedSize);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
\sa maximumSize, minimumSize
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
void QWidget::setFixedSize(const QSize & s)
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
setFixedSize(s.width(), s.height());
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/*!
|
|
|
|
\fn void QWidget::setFixedSize(int w, int h)
|
|
|
|
\overload
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Sets the width of the widget to \a w and the height to \a h.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
void QWidget::setFixedSize(int w, int h)
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
Q_D(QWidget);
|
|
|
|
bool minSizeSet = d->setMinimumSize_helper(w, h);
|
|
|
|
bool maxSizeSet = d->setMaximumSize_helper(w, h);
|
|
|
|
if (!minSizeSet && !maxSizeSet)
|
|
|
|
return;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
if (isWindow())
|
|
|
|
d->setConstraints_sys();
|
|
|
|
else
|
|
|
|
d->updateGeometry_helper(true);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
if (w != QWIDGETSIZE_MAX || h != QWIDGETSIZE_MAX)
|
|
|
|
resize(w, h);
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
void QWidget::setMinimumWidth(int w)
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
Q_D(QWidget);
|
|
|
|
d->createExtra();
|
|
|
|
uint expl = d->extra->explicitMinSize | (w ? Qt::Horizontal : 0);
|
|
|
|
setMinimumSize(w, minimumSize().height());
|
|
|
|
d->extra->explicitMinSize = expl;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
void QWidget::setMinimumHeight(int h)
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
Q_D(QWidget);
|
|
|
|
d->createExtra();
|
|
|
|
uint expl = d->extra->explicitMinSize | (h ? Qt::Vertical : 0);
|
|
|
|
setMinimumSize(minimumSize().width(), h);
|
|
|
|
d->extra->explicitMinSize = expl;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
void QWidget::setMaximumWidth(int w)
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
Q_D(QWidget);
|
|
|
|
d->createExtra();
|
|
|
|
uint expl = d->extra->explicitMaxSize | (w == QWIDGETSIZE_MAX ? 0 : Qt::Horizontal);
|
|
|
|
setMaximumSize(w, maximumSize().height());
|
|
|
|
d->extra->explicitMaxSize = expl;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
void QWidget::setMaximumHeight(int h)
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
Q_D(QWidget);
|
|
|
|
d->createExtra();
|
|
|
|
uint expl = d->extra->explicitMaxSize | (h == QWIDGETSIZE_MAX ? 0 : Qt::Vertical);
|
|
|
|
setMaximumSize(maximumSize().width(), h);
|
|
|
|
d->extra->explicitMaxSize = expl;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/*!
|
|
|
|
Sets both the minimum and maximum width of the widget to \a w
|
|
|
|
without changing the heights. Provided for convenience.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
\sa sizeHint() minimumSize() maximumSize() setFixedSize()
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
void QWidget::setFixedWidth(int w)
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
Q_D(QWidget);
|
|
|
|
d->createExtra();
|
|
|
|
uint explMin = d->extra->explicitMinSize | Qt::Horizontal;
|
|
|
|
uint explMax = d->extra->explicitMaxSize | Qt::Horizontal;
|
|
|
|
setMinimumSize(w, minimumSize().height());
|
|
|
|
setMaximumSize(w, maximumSize().height());
|
|
|
|
d->extra->explicitMinSize = explMin;
|
|
|
|
d->extra->explicitMaxSize = explMax;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/*!
|
|
|
|
Sets both the minimum and maximum heights of the widget to \a h
|
|
|
|
without changing the widths. Provided for convenience.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
\sa sizeHint() minimumSize() maximumSize() setFixedSize()
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
void QWidget::setFixedHeight(int h)
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
Q_D(QWidget);
|
|
|
|
d->createExtra();
|
|
|
|
uint explMin = d->extra->explicitMinSize | Qt::Vertical;
|
|
|
|
uint explMax = d->extra->explicitMaxSize | Qt::Vertical;
|
|
|
|
setMinimumSize(minimumSize().width(), h);
|
|
|
|
setMaximumSize(maximumSize().width(), h);
|
|
|
|
d->extra->explicitMinSize = explMin;
|
|
|
|
d->extra->explicitMaxSize = explMax;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/*!
|
|
|
|
Translates the widget coordinate \a pos to the coordinate system
|
|
|
|
of \a parent. The \a parent must not be 0 and must be a parent
|
|
|
|
of the calling widget.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
\sa mapFrom() mapToParent() mapToGlobal() underMouse()
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
QPoint QWidget::mapTo(QWidget * parent, const QPoint & pos) const
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
QPoint p = pos;
|
|
|
|
if (parent) {
|
|
|
|
const QWidget * w = this;
|
|
|
|
while (w != parent) {
|
|
|
|
Q_ASSERT_X(w, "QWidget::mapTo(QWidget *parent, const QPoint &pos)",
|
|
|
|
"parent must be in parent hierarchy");
|
|
|
|
p = w->mapToParent(p);
|
|
|
|
w = w->parentWidget();
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
return p;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/*!
|
|
|
|
Translates the widget coordinate \a pos from the coordinate system
|
|
|
|
of \a parent to this widget's coordinate system. The \a parent
|
|
|
|
must not be 0 and must be a parent of the calling widget.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
\sa mapTo() mapFromParent() mapFromGlobal() underMouse()
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
QPoint QWidget::mapFrom(QWidget * parent, const QPoint & pos) const
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
QPoint p(pos);
|
|
|
|
if (parent) {
|
|
|
|
const QWidget * w = this;
|
|
|
|
while (w != parent) {
|
|
|
|
Q_ASSERT_X(w, "QWidget::mapFrom(QWidget *parent, const QPoint &pos)",
|
|
|
|
"parent must be in parent hierarchy");
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
p = w->mapFromParent(p);
|
|
|
|
w = w->parentWidget();
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
return p;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/*!
|
|
|
|
Translates the widget coordinate \a pos to a coordinate in the
|
|
|
|
parent widget.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Same as mapToGlobal() if the widget has no parent.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
\sa mapFromParent() mapTo() mapToGlobal() underMouse()
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
QPoint QWidget::mapToParent(const QPoint &pos) const
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
return pos + data->crect.topLeft();
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/*!
|
|
|
|
Translates the parent widget coordinate \a pos to widget
|
|
|
|
coordinates.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Same as mapFromGlobal() if the widget has no parent.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
\sa mapToParent() mapFrom() mapFromGlobal() underMouse()
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
QPoint QWidget::mapFromParent(const QPoint &pos) const
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
return pos - data->crect.topLeft();
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/*!
|
|
|
|
Returns the window for this widget, i.e. the next ancestor widget
|
|
|
|
that has (or could have) a window-system frame.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
If the widget is a window, the widget itself is returned.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Typical usage is changing the window title:
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
\snippet doc/src/snippets/code/src_gui_kernel_qwidget.cpp 3
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
\sa isWindow()
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
QWidget *QWidget::window() const
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
QWidget *w = (QWidget *)this;
|
|
|
|
QWidget *p = w->parentWidget();
|
|
|
|
while (!w->isWindow() && p) {
|
|
|
|
w = p;
|
|
|
|
p = p->parentWidget();
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
return w;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/*!
|
|
|
|
\since 4.4
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Returns the native parent for this widget, i.e. the next ancestor widget
|
|
|
|
that has a system identifier, or 0 if it does not have any native parent.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
\sa effectiveWinId()
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
QWidget *QWidget::nativeParentWidget() const
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
QWidget *parent = parentWidget();
|
|
|
|
while (parent && !parent->internalWinId())
|
|
|
|
parent = parent->parentWidget();
|
|
|
|
return parent;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/*! \fn QWidget *QWidget::topLevelWidget() const
|
|
|
|
\obsolete
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Use window() instead.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/*!
|
|
|
|
Returns the background role of the widget.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
The background role defines the brush from the widget's \l palette that
|
|
|
|
is used to render the background.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
If no explicit background role is set, the widget inherts its parent
|
|
|
|
widget's background role.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
\sa setBackgroundRole(), foregroundRole()
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
QPalette::ColorRole QWidget::backgroundRole() const
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
const QWidget *w = this;
|
|
|
|
do {
|
|
|
|
QPalette::ColorRole role = w->d_func()->bg_role;
|
|
|
|
if (role != QPalette::NoRole)
|
|
|
|
return role;
|
|
|
|
if (w->isWindow() || w->windowType() == Qt::SubWindow)
|
|
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
w = w->parentWidget();
|
|
|
|
} while (w);
|
|
|
|
return QPalette::Window;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/*!
|
|
|
|
Sets the background role of the widget to \a role.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
The background role defines the brush from the widget's \l palette that
|
|
|
|
is used to render the background.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
If \a role is QPalette::NoRole, then the widget inherits its
|
|
|
|
parent's background role.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Note that styles are free to choose any color from the palette.
|
|
|
|
You can modify the palette or set a style sheet if you don't
|
|
|
|
achieve the result you want with setBackgroundRole().
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
\sa backgroundRole(), foregroundRole()
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
void QWidget::setBackgroundRole(QPalette::ColorRole role)
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
Q_D(QWidget);
|
|
|
|
d->bg_role = role;
|
|
|
|
d->updateSystemBackground();
|
|
|
|
d->propagatePaletteChange();
|
|
|
|
d->updateIsOpaque();
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/*!
|
|
|
|
Returns the foreground role.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
The foreground role defines the color from the widget's \l palette that
|
|
|
|
is used to draw the foreground.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
If no explicit foreground role is set, the function returns a role
|
|
|
|
that contrasts with the background role.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
\sa setForegroundRole(), backgroundRole()
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
QPalette::ColorRole QWidget::foregroundRole() const
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
Q_D(const QWidget);
|
|
|
|
QPalette::ColorRole rl = QPalette::ColorRole(d->fg_role);
|
|
|
|
if (rl != QPalette::NoRole)
|
|
|
|
return rl;
|
|
|
|
QPalette::ColorRole role = QPalette::WindowText;
|
|
|
|
switch (backgroundRole()) {
|
|
|
|
case QPalette::Button:
|
|
|
|
role = QPalette::ButtonText;
|
|
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
case QPalette::Base:
|
|
|
|
role = QPalette::Text;
|
|
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
case QPalette::Dark:
|
|
|
|
case QPalette::Shadow:
|
|
|
|
role = QPalette::Light;
|
|
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
case QPalette::Highlight:
|
|
|
|
role = QPalette::HighlightedText;
|
|
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
case QPalette::ToolTipBase:
|
|
|
|
role = QPalette::ToolTipText;
|
|
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
default:
|
|
|
|
;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
return role;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/*!
|
|
|
|
Sets the foreground role of the widget to \a role.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
The foreground role defines the color from the widget's \l palette that
|
|
|
|
is used to draw the foreground.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
If \a role is QPalette::NoRole, the widget uses a foreground role
|
|
|
|
that contrasts with the background role.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Note that styles are free to choose any color from the palette.
|
|
|
|
You can modify the palette or set a style sheet if you don't
|
|
|
|
achieve the result you want with setForegroundRole().
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
\sa foregroundRole(), backgroundRole()
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
void QWidget::setForegroundRole(QPalette::ColorRole role)
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
Q_D(QWidget);
|
|
|
|
d->fg_role = role;
|
|
|
|
d->updateSystemBackground();
|
|
|
|
d->propagatePaletteChange();
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/*!
|
|
|
|
\property QWidget::palette
|
|
|
|
\brief the widget's palette
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
This property describes the widget's palette. The palette is used by the
|
|
|
|
widget's style when rendering standard components, and is available as a
|
|
|
|
means to ensure that custom widgets can maintain consistency with the
|
|
|
|
native platform's look and feel. It's common that different platforms, or
|
|
|
|
different styles, have different palettes.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
When you assign a new palette to a widget, the color roles from this
|
|
|
|
palette are combined with the widget's default palette to form the
|
|
|
|
widget's final palette. The palette entry for the widget's background role
|
|
|
|
is used to fill the widget's background (see QWidget::autoFillBackground),
|
|
|
|
and the foreground role initializes QPainter's pen.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
The default depends on the system environment. QApplication maintains a
|
|
|
|
system/theme palette which serves as a default for all widgets. There may
|
|
|
|
also be special palette defaults for certain types of widgets (e.g., on
|
|
|
|
Windows XP and Vista, all classes that derive from QMenuBar have a special
|
|
|
|
default palette). You can also define default palettes for widgets
|
|
|
|
yourself by passing a custom palette and the name of a widget to
|
|
|
|
QApplication::setPalette(). Finally, the style always has the option of
|
|
|
|
polishing the palette as it's assigned (see QStyle::polish()).
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
QWidget propagates explicit palette roles from parent to child. If you
|
|
|
|
assign a brush or color to a specific role on a palette and assign that
|
|
|
|
palette to a widget, that role will propagate to all the widget's
|
|
|
|
children, overriding any system defaults for that role. Note that palettes
|
|
|
|
by default don't propagate to windows (see isWindow()) unless the
|
|
|
|
Qt::WA_WindowPropagation attribute is enabled.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
QWidget's palette propagation is similar to its font propagation.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
The current style, which is used to render the content of all standard Qt
|
|
|
|
widgets, is free to choose colors and brushes from the widget palette, or
|
|
|
|
in some cases, to ignore the palette (partially, or completely). In
|
|
|
|
particular, certain styles like GTK style, Mac style, Windows XP, and
|
|
|
|
Vista style, depend on third party APIs to render the content of widgets,
|
|
|
|
and these styles typically do not follow the palette. Because of this,
|
|
|
|
assigning roles to a widget's palette is not guaranteed to change the
|
|
|
|
appearance of the widget. Instead, you may choose to apply a \l
|
|
|
|
styleSheet. You can refer to our Knowledge Base article
|
|
|
|
\l{http://qt.nokia.com/developer/knowledgebase/22}{here} for more
|
|
|
|
information.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
\warning Do not use this function in conjunction with \l{Qt Style Sheets}.
|
|
|
|
When using style sheets, the palette of a widget can be customized using
|
|
|
|
the "color", "background-color", "selection-color",
|
|
|
|
"selection-background-color" and "alternate-background-color".
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
\sa QApplication::palette(), QWidget::font()
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
const QPalette &QWidget::palette() const
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
if (!isEnabled()) {
|
|
|
|
data->pal.setCurrentColorGroup(QPalette::Disabled);
|
|
|
|
} else if ((!isVisible() || isActiveWindow())
|
|
|
|
#if defined(Q_OS_WIN) && !defined(Q_WS_WINCE)
|
|
|
|
&& !QApplicationPrivate::isBlockedByModal(const_cast<QWidget *>(this))
|
|
|
|
#endif
|
|
|
|
) {
|
|
|
|
data->pal.setCurrentColorGroup(QPalette::Active);
|
|
|
|
} else {
|
|
|
|
#ifdef Q_WS_MAC
|
|
|
|
extern bool qt_mac_can_clickThrough(const QWidget *); //qwidget_mac.cpp
|
|
|
|
if (qt_mac_can_clickThrough(this))
|
|
|
|
data->pal.setCurrentColorGroup(QPalette::Active);
|
|
|
|
else
|
|
|
|
#endif
|
|
|
|
data->pal.setCurrentColorGroup(QPalette::Inactive);
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
return data->pal;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
void QWidget::setPalette(const QPalette &palette)
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
Q_D(QWidget);
|
|
|
|
setAttribute(Qt::WA_SetPalette, palette.resolve() != 0);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
// Determine which palette is inherited from this widget's ancestors and
|
|
|
|
// QApplication::palette, resolve this against \a palette (attributes from
|
|
|
|
// the inherited palette are copied over this widget's palette). Then
|
|
|
|
// propagate this palette to this widget's children.
|
|
|
|
QPalette naturalPalette = d->naturalWidgetPalette(d->inheritedPaletteResolveMask);
|
|
|
|
QPalette resolvedPalette = palette.resolve(naturalPalette);
|
|
|
|
d->setPalette_helper(resolvedPalette);
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/*!
|
|
|
|
\internal
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Returns the palette that the widget \a w inherits from its ancestors and
|
|
|
|
QApplication::palette. \a inheritedMask is the combination of the widget's
|
|
|
|
ancestors palette request masks (i.e., which attributes from the parent
|
|
|
|
widget's palette are implicitly imposed on this widget by the user). Note
|
|
|
|
that this font does not take into account the palette set on \a w itself.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
QPalette QWidgetPrivate::naturalWidgetPalette(uint inheritedMask) const
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
Q_Q(const QWidget);
|
|
|
|
QPalette naturalPalette = QApplication::palette(q);
|
|
|
|
if (!q->testAttribute(Qt::WA_StyleSheet)
|
|
|
|
&& (!q->isWindow() || q->testAttribute(Qt::WA_WindowPropagation)
|
|
|
|
#ifndef QT_NO_GRAPHICSVIEW
|
|
|
|
|| (extra && extra->proxyWidget)
|
|
|
|
#endif //QT_NO_GRAPHICSVIEW
|
|
|
|
)) {
|
|
|
|
if (QWidget *p = q->parentWidget()) {
|
|
|
|
if (!p->testAttribute(Qt::WA_StyleSheet)) {
|
|
|
|
if (!naturalPalette.isCopyOf(QApplication::palette())) {
|
|
|
|
QPalette inheritedPalette = p->palette();
|
|
|
|
inheritedPalette.resolve(inheritedMask);
|
|
|
|
naturalPalette = inheritedPalette.resolve(naturalPalette);
|
|
|
|
} else {
|
|
|
|
naturalPalette = p->palette();
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
#ifndef QT_NO_GRAPHICSVIEW
|
|
|
|
else if (extra && extra->proxyWidget) {
|
|
|
|
QPalette inheritedPalette = extra->proxyWidget->palette();
|
|
|
|
inheritedPalette.resolve(inheritedMask);
|
|
|
|
naturalPalette = inheritedPalette.resolve(naturalPalette);
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
#endif //QT_NO_GRAPHICSVIEW
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
naturalPalette.resolve(0);
|
|
|
|
return naturalPalette;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/*!
|
|
|
|
\internal
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Determine which palette is inherited from this widget's ancestors and
|
|
|
|
QApplication::palette, resolve this against this widget's palette
|
|
|
|
(attributes from the inherited palette are copied over this widget's
|
|
|
|
palette). Then propagate this palette to this widget's children.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
void QWidgetPrivate::resolvePalette()
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
QPalette naturalPalette = naturalWidgetPalette(inheritedPaletteResolveMask);
|
|
|
|
QPalette resolvedPalette = data.pal.resolve(naturalPalette);
|
|
|
|
setPalette_helper(resolvedPalette);
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
void QWidgetPrivate::setPalette_helper(const QPalette &palette)
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
Q_Q(QWidget);
|
|
|
|
if (data.pal == palette && data.pal.resolve() == palette.resolve())
|
|
|
|
return;
|
|
|
|
data.pal = palette;
|
|
|
|
updateSystemBackground();
|
|
|
|
propagatePaletteChange();
|
|
|
|
updateIsOpaque();
|
|
|
|
q->update();
|
|
|
|
updateIsOpaque();
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/*!
|
|
|
|
\property QWidget::font
|
|
|
|
\brief the font currently set for the widget
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
This property describes the widget's requested font. The font is used by
|
|
|
|
the widget's style when rendering standard components, and is available as
|
|
|
|
a means to ensure that custom widgets can maintain consistency with the
|
|
|
|
native platform's look and feel. It's common that different platforms, or
|
|
|
|
different styles, define different fonts for an application.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
When you assign a new font to a widget, the properties from this font are
|
|
|
|
combined with the widget's default font to form the widget's final
|
|
|
|
font. You can call fontInfo() to get a copy of the widget's final
|
|
|
|
font. The final font is also used to initialize QPainter's font.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
The default depends on the system environment. QApplication maintains a
|
|
|
|
system/theme font which serves as a default for all widgets. There may
|
|
|
|
also be special font defaults for certain types of widgets. You can also
|
|
|
|
define default fonts for widgets yourself by passing a custom font and the
|
|
|
|
name of a widget to QApplication::setFont(). Finally, the font is matched
|
|
|
|
against Qt's font database to find the best match.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
QWidget propagates explicit font properties from parent to child. If you
|
|
|
|
change a specific property on a font and assign that font to a widget,
|
|
|
|
that property will propagate to all the widget's children, overriding any
|
|
|
|
system defaults for that property. Note that fonts by default don't
|
|
|
|
propagate to windows (see isWindow()) unless the Qt::WA_WindowPropagation
|
|
|
|
attribute is enabled.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
QWidget's font propagation is similar to its palette propagation.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
The current style, which is used to render the content of all standard Qt
|
|
|
|
widgets, is free to choose to use the widget font, or in some cases, to
|
|
|
|
ignore it (partially, or completely). In particular, certain styles like
|
|
|
|
GTK style, Mac style, Windows XP, and Vista style, apply special
|
|
|
|
modifications to the widget font to match the platform's native look and
|
|
|
|
feel. Because of this, assigning properties to a widget's font is not
|
|
|
|
guaranteed to change the appearance of the widget. Instead, you may choose
|
|
|
|
to apply a \l styleSheet.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
\note If \l{Qt Style Sheets} are used on the same widget as setFont(),
|
|
|
|
style sheets will take precedence if the settings conflict.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
\sa fontInfo(), fontMetrics()
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
void QWidget::setFont(const QFont &font)
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
Q_D(QWidget);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
#ifndef QT_NO_STYLE_STYLESHEET
|
|
|
|
const QStyleSheetStyle* style;
|
|
|
|
if (d->extra && (style = qobject_cast<const QStyleSheetStyle*>(d->extra->style))) {
|
|
|
|
style->saveWidgetFont(this, font);
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
#endif
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
setAttribute(Qt::WA_SetFont, font.resolve() != 0);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
// Determine which font is inherited from this widget's ancestors and
|
|
|
|
// QApplication::font, resolve this against \a font (attributes from the
|
|
|
|
// inherited font are copied over). Then propagate this font to this
|
|
|
|
// widget's children.
|
|
|
|
QFont naturalFont = d->naturalWidgetFont(d->inheritedFontResolveMask);
|
|
|
|
QFont resolvedFont = font.resolve(naturalFont);
|
|
|
|
d->setFont_helper(resolvedFont);
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
|
|
\internal
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Returns the font that the widget \a w inherits from its ancestors and
|
|
|
|
QApplication::font. \a inheritedMask is the combination of the widget's
|
|
|
|
ancestors font request masks (i.e., which attributes from the parent
|
|
|
|
widget's font are implicitly imposed on this widget by the user). Note
|
|
|
|
that this font does not take into account the font set on \a w itself.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
### Stylesheet has a different font propagation mechanism. When a stylesheet
|
|
|
|
is applied, fonts are not propagated anymore
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
QFont QWidgetPrivate::naturalWidgetFont(uint inheritedMask) const
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
Q_Q(const QWidget);
|
|
|
|
QFont naturalFont = QApplication::font(q);
|
|
|
|
if (!q->testAttribute(Qt::WA_StyleSheet)
|
|
|
|
&& (!q->isWindow() || q->testAttribute(Qt::WA_WindowPropagation)
|
|
|
|
#ifndef QT_NO_GRAPHICSVIEW
|
|
|
|
|| (extra && extra->proxyWidget)
|
|
|
|
#endif //QT_NO_GRAPHICSVIEW
|
|
|
|
)) {
|
|
|
|
if (QWidget *p = q->parentWidget()) {
|
|
|
|
if (!p->testAttribute(Qt::WA_StyleSheet)) {
|
|
|
|
if (!naturalFont.isCopyOf(QApplication::font())) {
|
|
|
|
QFont inheritedFont = p->font();
|
|
|
|
inheritedFont.resolve(inheritedMask);
|
|
|
|
naturalFont = inheritedFont.resolve(naturalFont);
|
|
|
|
} else {
|
|
|
|
naturalFont = p->font();
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
#ifndef QT_NO_GRAPHICSVIEW
|
|
|
|
else if (extra && extra->proxyWidget) {
|
|
|
|
QFont inheritedFont = extra->proxyWidget->font();
|
|
|
|
inheritedFont.resolve(inheritedMask);
|
|
|
|
naturalFont = inheritedFont.resolve(naturalFont);
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
#endif //QT_NO_GRAPHICSVIEW
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
naturalFont.resolve(0);
|
|
|
|
return naturalFont;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/*!
|
|
|
|
\internal
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Determine which font is implicitly imposed on this widget by its ancestors
|
|
|
|
and QApplication::font, resolve this against its own font (attributes from
|
|
|
|
the implicit font are copied over). Then propagate this font to this
|
|
|
|
widget's children.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
void QWidgetPrivate::resolveFont()
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
QFont naturalFont = naturalWidgetFont(inheritedFontResolveMask);
|
|
|
|
QFont resolvedFont = data.fnt.resolve(naturalFont);
|
|
|
|
setFont_helper(resolvedFont);
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/*!
|
|
|
|
\internal
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Assign \a font to this widget, and propagate it to all children, except
|
|
|
|
style sheet widgets (handled differently) and windows that don't enable
|
|
|
|
window propagation. \a implicitMask is the union of all ancestor widgets'
|
|
|
|
font request masks, and determines which attributes from this widget's
|
|
|
|
font should propagate.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
void QWidgetPrivate::updateFont(const QFont &font)
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
Q_Q(QWidget);
|
|
|
|
#ifndef QT_NO_STYLE_STYLESHEET
|
|
|
|
const QStyleSheetStyle* cssStyle;
|
|
|
|
cssStyle = extra ? qobject_cast<const QStyleSheetStyle*>(extra->style) : 0;
|
|
|
|
#endif
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
data.fnt = QFont(font, q);
|
|
|
|
#if defined(Q_WS_X11)
|
|
|
|
// make sure the font set on this widget is associated with the correct screen
|
|
|
|
data.fnt.x11SetScreen(xinfo.screen());
|
|
|
|
#endif
|
|
|
|
// Combine new mask with natural mask and propagate to children.
|
|
|
|
#ifndef QT_NO_GRAPHICSVIEW
|
|
|
|
if (!q->parentWidget() && extra && extra->proxyWidget) {
|
|
|
|
QGraphicsProxyWidget *p = extra->proxyWidget;
|
|
|
|
inheritedFontResolveMask = p->d_func()->inheritedFontResolveMask | p->font().resolve();
|
|
|
|
} else
|
|
|
|
#endif //QT_NO_GRAPHICSVIEW
|
|
|
|
if (q->isWindow() && !q->testAttribute(Qt::WA_WindowPropagation)) {
|
|
|
|
inheritedFontResolveMask = 0;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
uint newMask = data.fnt.resolve() | inheritedFontResolveMask;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
for (int i = 0; i < children.size(); ++i) {
|
|
|
|
QWidget *w = qobject_cast<QWidget*>(children.at(i));
|
|
|
|
if (w) {
|
|
|
|
if (0) {
|
|
|
|
#ifndef QT_NO_STYLE_STYLESHEET
|
|
|
|
} else if (w->testAttribute(Qt::WA_StyleSheet)) {
|
|
|
|
// Style sheets follow a different font propagation scheme.
|
|
|
|
if (cssStyle)
|
|
|
|
cssStyle->updateStyleSheetFont(w);
|
|
|
|
#endif
|
|
|
|
} else if ((!w->isWindow() || w->testAttribute(Qt::WA_WindowPropagation))) {
|
|
|
|
// Propagate font changes.
|
|
|
|
QWidgetPrivate *wd = w->d_func();
|
|
|
|
wd->inheritedFontResolveMask = newMask;
|
|
|
|
wd->resolveFont();
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
#ifndef QT_NO_STYLE_STYLESHEET
|
|
|
|
if (cssStyle) {
|
|
|
|
cssStyle->updateStyleSheetFont(q);
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
#endif
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
QEvent e(QEvent::FontChange);
|
|
|
|
QApplication::sendEvent(q, &e);
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
void QWidgetPrivate::setLayoutDirection_helper(Qt::LayoutDirection direction)
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
Q_Q(QWidget);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
if ( (direction == Qt::RightToLeft) == q->testAttribute(Qt::WA_RightToLeft))
|
|
|
|
return;
|
|
|
|
q->setAttribute(Qt::WA_RightToLeft, (direction == Qt::RightToLeft));
|
|
|
|
if (!children.isEmpty()) {
|
|
|
|
for (int i = 0; i < children.size(); ++i) {
|
|
|
|
QWidget *w = qobject_cast<QWidget*>(children.at(i));
|
|
|
|
if (w && !w->isWindow() && !w->testAttribute(Qt::WA_SetLayoutDirection))
|
|
|
|
w->d_func()->setLayoutDirection_helper(direction);
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
QEvent e(QEvent::LayoutDirectionChange);
|
|
|
|
QApplication::sendEvent(q, &e);
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
void QWidgetPrivate::resolveLayoutDirection()
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
Q_Q(const QWidget);
|
|
|
|
if (!q->testAttribute(Qt::WA_SetLayoutDirection))
|
|
|
|
setLayoutDirection_helper(q->isWindow() ? QApplication::layoutDirection() : q->parentWidget()->layoutDirection());
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/*!
|
|
|
|
\property QWidget::layoutDirection
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
\brief the layout direction for this widget
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
By default, this property is set to Qt::LeftToRight.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
When the layout direction is set on a widget, it will propagate to
|
|
|
|
the widget's children, but not to a child that is a window and not
|
|
|
|
to a child for which setLayoutDirection() has been explicitly
|
|
|
|
called. Also, child widgets added \e after setLayoutDirection()
|
|
|
|
has been called for the parent do not inherit the parent's layout
|
|
|
|
direction.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
This method no longer affects text layout direction since Qt 4.7.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
\sa QApplication::layoutDirection
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
void QWidget::setLayoutDirection(Qt::LayoutDirection direction)
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
Q_D(QWidget);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
if (direction == Qt::LayoutDirectionAuto) {
|
|
|
|
unsetLayoutDirection();
|
|
|
|
return;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
setAttribute(Qt::WA_SetLayoutDirection);
|
|
|
|
d->setLayoutDirection_helper(direction);
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Qt::LayoutDirection QWidget::layoutDirection() const
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
return testAttribute(Qt::WA_RightToLeft) ? Qt::RightToLeft : Qt::LeftToRight;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
void QWidget::unsetLayoutDirection()
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
Q_D(QWidget);
|
|
|
|
setAttribute(Qt::WA_SetLayoutDirection, false);
|
|
|
|
d->resolveLayoutDirection();
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/*!
|
|
|
|
\fn QFontMetrics QWidget::fontMetrics() const
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Returns the font metrics for the widget's current font.
|
|
|
|
Equivalent to QFontMetrics(widget->font()).
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
\sa font(), fontInfo(), setFont()
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/*!
|
|
|
|
\fn QFontInfo QWidget::fontInfo() const
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Returns the font info for the widget's current font.
|
|
|
|
Equivalent to QFontInto(widget->font()).
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
\sa font(), fontMetrics(), setFont()
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/*!
|
|
|
|
\property QWidget::cursor
|
|
|
|
\brief the cursor shape for this widget
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
The mouse cursor will assume this shape when it's over this
|
|
|
|
widget. See the \link Qt::CursorShape list of predefined cursor
|
|
|
|
objects\endlink for a range of useful shapes.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
An editor widget might use an I-beam cursor:
|
|
|
|
\snippet doc/src/snippets/code/src_gui_kernel_qwidget.cpp 6
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
If no cursor has been set, or after a call to unsetCursor(), the
|
|
|
|
parent's cursor is used.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
By default, this property contains a cursor with the Qt::ArrowCursor
|
|
|
|
shape.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Some underlying window implementations will reset the cursor if it
|
|
|
|
leaves a widget even if the mouse is grabbed. If you want to have
|
|
|
|
a cursor set for all widgets, even when outside the window, consider
|
|
|
|
QApplication::setOverrideCursor().
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
\sa QApplication::setOverrideCursor()
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
#ifndef QT_NO_CURSOR
|
|
|
|
QCursor QWidget::cursor() const
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
Q_D(const QWidget);
|
|
|
|
if (testAttribute(Qt::WA_SetCursor))
|
|
|
|
return (d->extra && d->extra->curs)
|
|
|
|
? *d->extra->curs
|
|
|
|
: QCursor(Qt::ArrowCursor);
|
|
|
|
if (isWindow() || !parentWidget())
|
|
|
|
return QCursor(Qt::ArrowCursor);
|
|
|
|
return parentWidget()->cursor();
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
void QWidget::setCursor(const QCursor &cursor)
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
Q_D(QWidget);
|
|
|
|
// On Mac we must set the cursor even if it is the ArrowCursor.
|
2016-06-21 16:52:02 +00:00
|
|
|
#if !defined(Q_WS_MAC)
|
2015-12-10 05:06:13 +02:00
|
|
|
if (cursor.shape() != Qt::ArrowCursor
|
|
|
|
|| (d->extra && d->extra->curs))
|
|
|
|
#endif
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
d->createExtra();
|
|
|
|
QCursor *newCursor = new QCursor(cursor);
|
|
|
|
delete d->extra->curs;
|
|
|
|
d->extra->curs = newCursor;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
setAttribute(Qt::WA_SetCursor);
|
|
|
|
d->setCursor_sys(cursor);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
QEvent event(QEvent::CursorChange);
|
|
|
|
QApplication::sendEvent(this, &event);
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
void QWidget::unsetCursor()
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
Q_D(QWidget);
|
|
|
|
if (d->extra) {
|
|
|
|
delete d->extra->curs;
|
|
|
|
d->extra->curs = 0;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if (!isWindow())
|
|
|
|
setAttribute(Qt::WA_SetCursor, false);
|
|
|
|
d->unsetCursor_sys();
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
QEvent event(QEvent::CursorChange);
|
|
|
|
QApplication::sendEvent(this, &event);
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
#endif
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/*!
|
|
|
|
\enum QWidget::RenderFlag
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
This enum describes how to render the widget when calling QWidget::render().
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
\value DrawWindowBackground If you enable this option, the widget's background
|
|
|
|
is rendered into the target even if autoFillBackground is not set. By default,
|
|
|
|
this option is enabled.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
\value DrawChildren If you enable this option, the widget's children
|
|
|
|
are rendered recursively into the target. By default, this option is enabled.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
\value IgnoreMask If you enable this option, the widget's QWidget::mask()
|
|
|
|
is ignored when rendering into the target. By default, this option is disabled.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
\since 4.3
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/*!
|
|
|
|
\since 4.3
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Renders the \a sourceRegion of this widget into the \a target
|
|
|
|
using \a renderFlags to determine how to render. Rendering
|
|
|
|
starts at \a targetOffset in the \a target. For example:
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
\snippet doc/src/snippets/code/src_gui_kernel_qwidget.cpp 7
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
If \a sourceRegion is a null region, this function will use QWidget::rect() as
|
|
|
|
the region, i.e. the entire widget.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Ensure that you call QPainter::end() for the \a target device's
|
|
|
|
active painter (if any) before rendering. For example:
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
\snippet doc/src/snippets/code/src_gui_kernel_qwidget.cpp 8
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
\note To obtain the contents of an OpenGL widget, use QGLWidget::grabFrameBuffer()
|
|
|
|
or QGLWidget::renderPixmap() instead.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
void QWidget::render(QPaintDevice *target, const QPoint &targetOffset,
|
|
|
|
const QRegion &sourceRegion, RenderFlags renderFlags)
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
d_func()->render(target, targetOffset, sourceRegion, renderFlags, false);
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/*!
|
|
|
|
\overload
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Renders the widget into the \a painter's QPainter::device().
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Transformations and settings applied to the \a painter will be used
|
|
|
|
when rendering.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
\note The \a painter must be active. On Mac OS X the widget will be
|
|
|
|
rendered into a QPixmap and then drawn by the \a painter.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
\sa QPainter::device()
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
void QWidget::render(QPainter *painter, const QPoint &targetOffset,
|
|
|
|
const QRegion &sourceRegion, RenderFlags renderFlags)
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
if (!painter) {
|
|
|
|
qWarning("QWidget::render: Null pointer to painter");
|
|
|
|
return;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
if (!painter->isActive()) {
|
|
|
|
qWarning("QWidget::render: Cannot render with an inactive painter");
|
|
|
|
return;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
const qreal opacity = painter->opacity();
|
|
|
|
if (qFuzzyIsNull(opacity))
|
|
|
|
return; // Fully transparent.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Q_D(QWidget);
|
|
|
|
const bool inRenderWithPainter = d->extra && d->extra->inRenderWithPainter;
|
|
|
|
const QRegion toBePainted = !inRenderWithPainter ? d->prepareToRender(sourceRegion, renderFlags)
|
|
|
|
: sourceRegion;
|
|
|
|
if (toBePainted.isEmpty())
|
|
|
|
return;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
if (!d->extra)
|
|
|
|
d->createExtra();
|
|
|
|
d->extra->inRenderWithPainter = true;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
#ifdef Q_WS_MAC
|
|
|
|
d->render_helper(painter, targetOffset, toBePainted, renderFlags);
|
|
|
|
#else
|
|
|
|
QPaintEngine *engine = painter->paintEngine();
|
|
|
|
Q_ASSERT(engine);
|
|
|
|
QPaintEnginePrivate *enginePriv = engine->d_func();
|
|
|
|
Q_ASSERT(enginePriv);
|
|
|
|
QPaintDevice *target = engine->paintDevice();
|
|
|
|
Q_ASSERT(target);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
// Render via a pixmap when dealing with non-opaque painters or printers.
|
|
|
|
if (!inRenderWithPainter && (opacity < 1.0 || (target->devType() == QInternal::Printer))) {
|
|
|
|
d->render_helper(painter, targetOffset, toBePainted, renderFlags);
|
|
|
|
d->extra->inRenderWithPainter = false;
|
|
|
|
return;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
// Set new shared painter.
|
|
|
|
QPainter *oldPainter = d->sharedPainter();
|
|
|
|
d->setSharedPainter(painter);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
// Save current system clip, viewport and transform,
|
|
|
|
const QTransform oldTransform = enginePriv->systemTransform;
|
|
|
|
const QRegion oldSystemClip = enginePriv->systemClip;
|
|
|
|
const QRegion oldSystemViewport = enginePriv->systemViewport;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
// This ensures that all painting triggered by render() is clipped to the current engine clip.
|
|
|
|
if (painter->hasClipping()) {
|
|
|
|
const QRegion painterClip = painter->deviceTransform().map(painter->clipRegion());
|
|
|
|
enginePriv->setSystemViewport(oldSystemClip.isEmpty() ? painterClip : oldSystemClip & painterClip);
|
|
|
|
} else {
|
|
|
|
enginePriv->setSystemViewport(oldSystemClip);
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
render(target, targetOffset, toBePainted, renderFlags);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
// Restore system clip, viewport and transform.
|
|
|
|
enginePriv->systemClip = oldSystemClip;
|
|
|
|
enginePriv->setSystemViewport(oldSystemViewport);
|
|
|
|
enginePriv->setSystemTransform(oldTransform);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
// Restore shared painter.
|
|
|
|
d->setSharedPainter(oldPainter);
|
|
|
|
#endif
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
d->extra->inRenderWithPainter = false;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/*!
|
|
|
|
\brief The graphicsEffect function returns a pointer to the
|
|
|
|
widget's graphics effect.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
If the widget has no graphics effect, 0 is returned.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
\since 4.6
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
\sa setGraphicsEffect()
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
#ifndef QT_NO_GRAPHICSEFFECT
|
|
|
|
QGraphicsEffect *QWidget::graphicsEffect() const
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
Q_D(const QWidget);
|
|
|
|
return d->graphicsEffect;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
#endif //QT_NO_GRAPHICSEFFECT
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/*!
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
\brief The setGraphicsEffect function is for setting the widget's graphics effect.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Sets \a effect as the widget's effect. If there already is an effect installed
|
|
|
|
on this widget, QWidget will delete the existing effect before installing
|
|
|
|
the new \a effect.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
If \a effect is the installed on a different widget, setGraphicsEffect() will remove
|
|
|
|
the effect from the widget and install it on this widget.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
QWidget takes ownership of \a effect.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
\note This function will apply the effect on itself and all its children.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
\note Graphics effects are not supported on Mac, so they will not cause any difference
|
|
|
|
to the rendering of the widget.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
\since 4.6
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
\sa graphicsEffect()
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
#ifndef QT_NO_GRAPHICSEFFECT
|
|
|
|
void QWidget::setGraphicsEffect(QGraphicsEffect *effect)
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
Q_D(QWidget);
|
|
|
|
if (d->graphicsEffect == effect)
|
|
|
|
return;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
if (d->graphicsEffect) {
|
|
|
|
d->invalidateBuffer(rect());
|
|
|
|
delete d->graphicsEffect;
|
|
|
|
d->graphicsEffect = 0;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
if (effect) {
|
|
|
|
// Set new effect.
|
|
|
|
QGraphicsEffectSourcePrivate *sourced = new QWidgetEffectSourcePrivate(this);
|
|
|
|
QGraphicsEffectSource *source = new QGraphicsEffectSource(*sourced);
|
|
|
|
d->graphicsEffect = effect;
|
|
|
|
effect->d_func()->setGraphicsEffectSource(source);
|
|
|
|
update();
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
d->updateIsOpaque();
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
#endif //QT_NO_GRAPHICSEFFECT
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
bool QWidgetPrivate::isAboutToShow() const
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
if (data.in_show)
|
|
|
|
return true;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Q_Q(const QWidget);
|
|
|
|
if (q->isHidden())
|
|
|
|
return false;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
// The widget will be shown if any of its ancestors are about to show.
|
|
|
|
QWidget *parent = q->parentWidget();
|
|
|
|
return parent ? parent->d_func()->isAboutToShow() : false;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
QRegion QWidgetPrivate::prepareToRender(const QRegion ®ion, QWidget::RenderFlags renderFlags)
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
Q_Q(QWidget);
|
|
|
|
const bool isVisible = q->isVisible();
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
// Make sure the widget is laid out correctly.
|
|
|
|
if (!isVisible && !isAboutToShow()) {
|
|
|
|
QWidget *topLevel = q->window();
|
|
|
|
(void)topLevel->d_func()->topData(); // Make sure we at least have top-data.
|
|
|
|
topLevel->ensurePolished();
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
// Invalidate the layout of hidden ancestors (incl. myself) and pretend
|
|
|
|
// they're not explicitly hidden.
|
|
|
|
QWidget *widget = q;
|
|
|
|
QWidgetList hiddenWidgets;
|
|
|
|
while (widget) {
|
|
|
|
if (widget->isHidden()) {
|
|
|
|
widget->setAttribute(Qt::WA_WState_Hidden, false);
|
|
|
|
hiddenWidgets.append(widget);
|
|
|
|
if (!widget->isWindow() && widget->parentWidget()->d_func()->layout)
|
|
|
|
widget->d_func()->updateGeometry_helper(true);
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
widget = widget->parentWidget();
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
// Activate top-level layout.
|
|
|
|
if (topLevel->d_func()->layout)
|
|
|
|
topLevel->d_func()->layout->activate();
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
// Adjust size if necessary.
|
|
|
|
QTLWExtra *topLevelExtra = topLevel->d_func()->maybeTopData();
|
|
|
|
if (topLevelExtra && !topLevelExtra->sizeAdjusted
|
|
|
|
&& !topLevel->testAttribute(Qt::WA_Resized)) {
|
|
|
|
topLevel->adjustSize();
|
|
|
|
topLevel->setAttribute(Qt::WA_Resized, false);
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
// Activate child layouts.
|
|
|
|
topLevel->d_func()->activateChildLayoutsRecursively();
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
// We're not cheating with WA_WState_Hidden anymore.
|
|
|
|
for (int i = 0; i < hiddenWidgets.size(); ++i) {
|
|
|
|
QWidget *widget = hiddenWidgets.at(i);
|
|
|
|
widget->setAttribute(Qt::WA_WState_Hidden);
|
|
|
|
if (!widget->isWindow() && widget->parentWidget()->d_func()->layout)
|
|
|
|
widget->parentWidget()->d_func()->layout->invalidate();
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
} else if (isVisible) {
|
|
|
|
q->window()->d_func()->sendPendingMoveAndResizeEvents(true, true);
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
// Calculate the region to be painted.
|
|
|
|
QRegion toBePainted = !region.isEmpty() ? region : QRegion(q->rect());
|
|
|
|
if (!(renderFlags & QWidget::IgnoreMask) && extra && extra->hasMask)
|
|
|
|
toBePainted &= extra->mask;
|
|
|
|
return toBePainted;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
void QWidgetPrivate::render_helper(QPainter *painter, const QPoint &targetOffset, const QRegion &toBePainted,
|
|
|
|
QWidget::RenderFlags renderFlags)
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
Q_ASSERT(painter);
|
|
|
|
Q_ASSERT(!toBePainted.isEmpty());
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Q_Q(QWidget);
|
|
|
|
#ifndef Q_WS_MAC
|
|
|
|
const QTransform originalTransform = painter->worldTransform();
|
|
|
|
const bool useDeviceCoordinates = originalTransform.isScaling();
|
|
|
|
if (!useDeviceCoordinates) {
|
|
|
|
#endif
|
|
|
|
// Render via a pixmap.
|
|
|
|
const QRect rect = toBePainted.boundingRect();
|
|
|
|
const QSize size = rect.size();
|
|
|
|
if (size.isNull())
|
|
|
|
return;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
QPixmap pixmap(size);
|
|
|
|
if (!(renderFlags & QWidget::DrawWindowBackground) || !isOpaque)
|
|
|
|
pixmap.fill(Qt::transparent);
|
|
|
|
q->render(&pixmap, QPoint(), toBePainted, renderFlags);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
const bool restore = !(painter->renderHints() & QPainter::SmoothPixmapTransform);
|
|
|
|
painter->setRenderHints(QPainter::SmoothPixmapTransform, true);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
painter->drawPixmap(targetOffset, pixmap);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
if (restore)
|
|
|
|
painter->setRenderHints(QPainter::SmoothPixmapTransform, false);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
#ifndef Q_WS_MAC
|
|
|
|
} else {
|
|
|
|
// Render via a pixmap in device coordinates (to avoid pixmap scaling).
|
|
|
|
QTransform transform = originalTransform;
|
|
|
|
transform.translate(targetOffset.x(), targetOffset.y());
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
QPaintDevice *device = painter->device();
|
|
|
|
Q_ASSERT(device);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
// Calculate device rect.
|
|
|
|
const QRectF rect(toBePainted.boundingRect());
|
|
|
|
QRect deviceRect = transform.mapRect(QRectF(0, 0, rect.width(), rect.height())).toAlignedRect();
|
|
|
|
deviceRect &= QRect(0, 0, device->width(), device->height());
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
QPixmap pixmap(deviceRect.size());
|
|
|
|
pixmap.fill(Qt::transparent);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
// Create a pixmap device coordinate painter.
|
|
|
|
QPainter pixmapPainter(&pixmap);
|
|
|
|
pixmapPainter.setRenderHints(painter->renderHints());
|
|
|
|
transform *= QTransform::fromTranslate(-deviceRect.x(), -deviceRect.y());
|
|
|
|
pixmapPainter.setTransform(transform);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
q->render(&pixmapPainter, QPoint(), toBePainted, renderFlags);
|
|
|
|
pixmapPainter.end();
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
// And then draw the pixmap.
|
|
|
|
painter->setTransform(QTransform());
|
|
|
|
painter->drawPixmap(deviceRect.topLeft(), pixmap);
|
|
|
|
painter->setTransform(originalTransform);
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
#endif
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
void QWidgetPrivate::drawWidget(QPaintDevice *pdev, const QRegion &rgn, const QPoint &offset, int flags,
|
|
|
|
QPainter *sharedPainter, QWidgetBackingStore *backingStore)
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
if (rgn.isEmpty())
|
|
|
|
return;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
#if defined(Q_WS_MAC) && defined(QT_MAC_USE_COCOA)
|
|
|
|
if (qt_mac_clearDirtyOnWidgetInsideDrawWidget)
|
|
|
|
dirtyOnWidget = QRegion();
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
// We disable the rendering of QToolBar in the backingStore if
|
|
|
|
// it's supposed to be in the unified toolbar on Mac OS X.
|
|
|
|
if (backingStore && isInUnifiedToolbar)
|
|
|
|
return;
|
|
|
|
#endif // Q_WS_MAC && QT_MAC_USE_COCOA
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Q_Q(QWidget);
|
|
|
|
#if !defined(QT_NO_GRAPHICSEFFECT) && !defined(Q_WS_MAC)
|
|
|
|
if (graphicsEffect && graphicsEffect->isEnabled()) {
|
|
|
|
QGraphicsEffectSource *source = graphicsEffect->d_func()->source;
|
|
|
|
QWidgetEffectSourcePrivate *sourced = static_cast<QWidgetEffectSourcePrivate *>
|
|
|
|
(source->d_func());
|
|
|
|
if (!sourced->context) {
|
|
|
|
QWidgetPaintContext context(pdev, rgn, offset, flags, sharedPainter, backingStore);
|
|
|
|
sourced->context = &context;
|
|
|
|
if (!sharedPainter) {
|
|
|
|
QPaintEngine *paintEngine = pdev->paintEngine();
|
|
|
|
paintEngine->d_func()->systemClip = rgn.translated(offset);
|
|
|
|
QPainter p(pdev);
|
|
|
|
p.translate(offset);
|
|
|
|
context.painter = &p;
|
|
|
|
graphicsEffect->draw(&p);
|
|
|
|
paintEngine->d_func()->systemClip = QRegion();
|
|
|
|
} else {
|
|
|
|
context.painter = sharedPainter;
|
|
|
|
if (sharedPainter->worldTransform() != sourced->lastEffectTransform) {
|
|
|
|
sourced->invalidateCache();
|
|
|
|
sourced->lastEffectTransform = sharedPainter->worldTransform();
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
sharedPainter->save();
|
|
|
|
sharedPainter->translate(offset);
|
|
|
|
graphicsEffect->draw(sharedPainter);
|
|
|
|
sharedPainter->restore();
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
sourced->context = 0;
|
|
|
|
return;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
#endif //QT_NO_GRAFFICSEFFECT
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
const bool asRoot = flags & DrawAsRoot;
|
|
|
|
const bool alsoOnScreen = flags & DrawPaintOnScreen;
|
|
|
|
const bool recursive = flags & DrawRecursive;
|
|
|
|
const bool alsoInvisible = flags & DrawInvisible;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Q_ASSERT(sharedPainter ? sharedPainter->isActive() : true);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
QRegion toBePainted(rgn);
|
|
|
|
if (asRoot && !alsoInvisible)
|
|
|
|
toBePainted &= clipRect(); //(rgn & visibleRegion());
|
|
|
|
if (!(flags & DontSubtractOpaqueChildren))
|
|
|
|
subtractOpaqueChildren(toBePainted, q->rect());
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
if (!toBePainted.isEmpty()) {
|
|
|
|
bool onScreen = paintOnScreen();
|
|
|
|
if (!onScreen || alsoOnScreen) {
|
|
|
|
//update the "in paint event" flag
|
|
|
|
if (q->testAttribute(Qt::WA_WState_InPaintEvent))
|
|
|
|
qWarning("QWidget::repaint: Recursive repaint detected");
|
|
|
|
q->setAttribute(Qt::WA_WState_InPaintEvent);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
//clip away the new area
|
|
|
|
#ifndef QT_NO_PAINT_DEBUG
|
|
|
|
bool flushed = QWidgetBackingStore::flushPaint(q, toBePainted);
|
|
|
|
#endif
|
|
|
|
QPaintEngine *paintEngine = pdev->paintEngine();
|
|
|
|
if (paintEngine) {
|
|
|
|
setRedirected(pdev, -offset);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
#ifdef Q_WS_MAC
|
|
|
|
// (Alien support) Special case for Mac when redirecting: If the paint device
|
|
|
|
// is of the Widget type we need to set WA_WState_InPaintEvent since painting
|
|
|
|
// outside the paint event is not supported on QWidgets. The attributeis
|
|
|
|
// restored further down.
|
|
|
|
if (pdev->devType() == QInternal::Widget)
|
|
|
|
static_cast<QWidget *>(pdev)->setAttribute(Qt::WA_WState_InPaintEvent);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
#endif
|
|
|
|
if (sharedPainter)
|
|
|
|
paintEngine->d_func()->systemClip = toBePainted;
|
|
|
|
else
|
|
|
|
paintEngine->d_func()->systemRect = q->data->crect;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
//paint the background
|
|
|
|
if ((asRoot || q->autoFillBackground() || onScreen || q->testAttribute(Qt::WA_StyledBackground))
|
|
|
|
&& !q->testAttribute(Qt::WA_OpaquePaintEvent) && !q->testAttribute(Qt::WA_NoSystemBackground)) {
|
|
|
|
QPainter p(q);
|
|
|
|
paintBackground(&p, toBePainted, (asRoot || onScreen) ? flags | DrawAsRoot : 0);
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
if (!sharedPainter)
|
|
|
|
paintEngine->d_func()->systemClip = toBePainted.translated(offset);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
if (!onScreen && !asRoot && !isOpaque && q->testAttribute(Qt::WA_TintedBackground)) {
|
|
|
|
QPainter p(q);
|
|
|
|
QColor tint = q->palette().window().color();
|
|
|
|
tint.setAlphaF(qreal(.6));
|
|
|
|
p.fillRect(toBePainted.boundingRect(), tint);
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
#if 0
|
|
|
|
qDebug() << "painting" << q << "opaque ==" << isOpaque();
|
|
|
|
qDebug() << "clipping to" << toBePainted << "location == " << offset
|
|
|
|
<< "geometry ==" << QRect(q->mapTo(q->window(), QPoint(0, 0)), q->size());
|
|
|
|
#endif
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
//actually send the paint event
|
|
|
|
QPaintEvent e(toBePainted);
|
|
|
|
QCoreApplication::sendSpontaneousEvent(q, &e);
|
|
|
|
if (backingStore && !onScreen && !asRoot && (q->internalWinId() || !q->nativeParentWidget()->isWindow()))
|
|
|
|
backingStore->markDirtyOnScreen(toBePainted, q, offset);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
//restore
|
|
|
|
if (paintEngine) {
|
|
|
|
#ifdef Q_WS_MAC
|
|
|
|
if (pdev->devType() == QInternal::Widget)
|
|
|
|
static_cast<QWidget *>(pdev)->setAttribute(Qt::WA_WState_InPaintEvent, false);
|
|
|
|
#endif
|
|
|
|
restoreRedirected();
|
|
|
|
if (!sharedPainter)
|
|
|
|
paintEngine->d_func()->systemRect = QRect();
|
|
|
|
else
|
|
|
|
paintEngine->d_func()->currentClipWidget = 0;
|
|
|
|
paintEngine->d_func()->systemClip = QRegion();
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
q->setAttribute(Qt::WA_WState_InPaintEvent, false);
|
|
|
|
if (q->paintingActive() && !q->testAttribute(Qt::WA_PaintOutsidePaintEvent))
|
|
|
|
qWarning("QWidget::repaint: It is dangerous to leave painters active on a widget outside of the PaintEvent");
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
if (paintEngine && paintEngine->autoDestruct()) {
|
|
|
|
delete paintEngine;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
#ifndef QT_NO_PAINT_DEBUG
|
|
|
|
if (flushed)
|
|
|
|
QWidgetBackingStore::unflushPaint(q, toBePainted);
|
|
|
|
#endif
|
|
|
|
} else if (q->isWindow()) {
|
|
|
|
QPaintEngine *engine = pdev->paintEngine();
|
|
|
|
if (engine) {
|
|
|
|
QPainter p(pdev);
|
|
|
|
p.setClipRegion(toBePainted);
|
|
|
|
const QBrush bg = q->palette().brush(QPalette::Window);
|
|
|
|
if (bg.style() == Qt::TexturePattern)
|
|
|
|
p.drawTiledPixmap(q->rect(), bg.texture());
|
|
|
|
else
|
|
|
|
p.fillRect(q->rect(), bg);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
if (engine->autoDestruct())
|
|
|
|
delete engine;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
if (recursive && !children.isEmpty()) {
|
|
|
|
paintSiblingsRecursive(pdev, children, children.size() - 1, rgn, offset, flags & ~DrawAsRoot
|
|
|
|
#ifdef Q_BACKINGSTORE_SUBSURFACES
|
|
|
|
, q->windowSurface()
|
|
|
|
#endif
|
|
|
|
, sharedPainter, backingStore);
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
void QWidgetPrivate::render(QPaintDevice *target, const QPoint &targetOffset,
|
|
|
|
const QRegion &sourceRegion, QWidget::RenderFlags renderFlags,
|
|
|
|
bool readyToRender)
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
if (!target) {
|
|
|
|
qWarning("QWidget::render: null pointer to paint device");
|
|
|
|
return;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
const bool inRenderWithPainter = extra && extra->inRenderWithPainter;
|
|
|
|
QRegion paintRegion = !inRenderWithPainter && !readyToRender
|
|
|
|
? prepareToRender(sourceRegion, renderFlags)
|
|
|
|
: sourceRegion;
|
|
|
|
if (paintRegion.isEmpty())
|
|
|
|
return;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
#ifndef Q_WS_MAC
|
|
|
|
QPainter *oldSharedPainter = inRenderWithPainter ? sharedPainter() : 0;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
// Use the target's shared painter if set (typically set when doing
|
|
|
|
// "other->render(widget);" in the widget's paintEvent.
|
|
|
|
if (target->devType() == QInternal::Widget) {
|
|
|
|
QWidgetPrivate *targetPrivate = static_cast<QWidget *>(target)->d_func();
|
|
|
|
if (targetPrivate->extra && targetPrivate->extra->inRenderWithPainter) {
|
|
|
|
QPainter *targetPainter = targetPrivate->sharedPainter();
|
|
|
|
if (targetPainter && targetPainter->isActive())
|
|
|
|
setSharedPainter(targetPainter);
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
#endif
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
// Use the target's redirected device if set and adjust offset and paint
|
|
|
|
// region accordingly. This is typically the case when people call render
|
|
|
|
// from the paintEvent.
|
|
|
|
QPoint offset = targetOffset;
|
|
|
|
offset -= paintRegion.boundingRect().topLeft();
|
|
|
|
QPoint redirectionOffset;
|
|
|
|
QPaintDevice *redirected = 0;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
if (target->devType() == QInternal::Widget)
|
|
|
|
redirected = static_cast<QWidget *>(target)->d_func()->redirected(&redirectionOffset);
|
|
|
|
if (!redirected)
|
|
|
|
redirected = QPainter::redirected(target, &redirectionOffset);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
if (redirected) {
|
|
|
|
target = redirected;
|
|
|
|
offset -= redirectionOffset;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
if (!inRenderWithPainter) { // Clip handled by shared painter (in qpainter.cpp).
|
|
|
|
if (QPaintEngine *targetEngine = target->paintEngine()) {
|
|
|
|
const QRegion targetSystemClip = targetEngine->systemClip();
|
|
|
|
if (!targetSystemClip.isEmpty())
|
|
|
|
paintRegion &= targetSystemClip.translated(-offset);
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
// Set backingstore flags.
|
|
|
|
int flags = DrawPaintOnScreen | DrawInvisible;
|
|
|
|
if (renderFlags & QWidget::DrawWindowBackground)
|
|
|
|
flags |= DrawAsRoot;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
if (renderFlags & QWidget::DrawChildren)
|
|
|
|
flags |= DrawRecursive;
|
|
|
|
else
|
|
|
|
flags |= DontSubtractOpaqueChildren;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
if (target->devType() == QInternal::Printer) {
|
|
|
|
QPainter p(target);
|
|
|
|
render_helper(&p, targetOffset, paintRegion, renderFlags);
|
|
|
|
return;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
#ifndef Q_WS_MAC
|
|
|
|
// Render via backingstore.
|
|
|
|
drawWidget(target, paintRegion, offset, flags, sharedPainter());
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
// Restore shared painter.
|
|
|
|
if (oldSharedPainter)
|
|
|
|
setSharedPainter(oldSharedPainter);
|
|
|
|
#else
|
|
|
|
// Render via backingstore (no shared painter).
|
|
|
|
drawWidget(target, paintRegion, offset, flags, 0);
|
|
|
|
#endif
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
void QWidgetPrivate::paintSiblingsRecursive(QPaintDevice *pdev, const QObjectList& siblings, int index, const QRegion &rgn,
|
|
|
|
const QPoint &offset, int flags
|
|
|
|
#ifdef Q_BACKINGSTORE_SUBSURFACES
|
|
|
|
, const QWindowSurface *currentSurface
|
|
|
|
#endif
|
|
|
|
, QPainter *sharedPainter, QWidgetBackingStore *backingStore)
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
QWidget *w = 0;
|
|
|
|
QRect boundingRect;
|
|
|
|
bool dirtyBoundingRect = true;
|
|
|
|
const bool exludeOpaqueChildren = (flags & DontDrawOpaqueChildren);
|
|
|
|
const bool excludeNativeChildren = (flags & DontDrawNativeChildren);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
do {
|
|
|
|
QWidget *x = qobject_cast<QWidget*>(siblings.at(index));
|
|
|
|
if (x && !(exludeOpaqueChildren && x->d_func()->isOpaque) && !x->isHidden() && !x->isWindow()
|
|
|
|
&& !(excludeNativeChildren && x->internalWinId())) {
|
|
|
|
if (dirtyBoundingRect) {
|
|
|
|
boundingRect = rgn.boundingRect();
|
|
|
|
dirtyBoundingRect = false;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
if (qRectIntersects(boundingRect, x->d_func()->effectiveRectFor(x->data->crect))) {
|
|
|
|
#ifdef Q_BACKINGSTORE_SUBSURFACES
|
|
|
|
if (x->windowSurface() == currentSurface)
|
|
|
|
#endif
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
w = x;
|
|
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
--index;
|
|
|
|
} while (index >= 0);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
if (!w)
|
|
|
|
return;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
QWidgetPrivate *wd = w->d_func();
|
|
|
|
const QPoint widgetPos(w->data->crect.topLeft());
|
|
|
|
const bool hasMask = wd->extra && wd->extra->hasMask && !wd->graphicsEffect;
|
|
|
|
if (index > 0) {
|
|
|
|
QRegion wr(rgn);
|
|
|
|
if (wd->isOpaque)
|
|
|
|
wr -= hasMask ? wd->extra->mask.translated(widgetPos) : w->data->crect;
|
|
|
|
paintSiblingsRecursive(pdev, siblings, --index, wr, offset, flags
|
|
|
|
#ifdef Q_BACKINGSTORE_SUBSURFACES
|
|
|
|
, currentSurface
|
|
|
|
#endif
|
|
|
|
, sharedPainter, backingStore);
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
if (w->updatesEnabled()
|
|
|
|
#ifndef QT_NO_GRAPHICSVIEW
|
|
|
|
&& (!w->d_func()->extra || !w->d_func()->extra->proxyWidget)
|
|
|
|
#endif //QT_NO_GRAPHICSVIEW
|
|
|
|
) {
|
|
|
|
QRegion wRegion(rgn);
|
|
|
|
wRegion &= wd->effectiveRectFor(w->data->crect);
|
|
|
|
wRegion.translate(-widgetPos);
|
|
|
|
if (hasMask)
|
|
|
|
wRegion &= wd->extra->mask;
|
|
|
|
wd->drawWidget(pdev, wRegion, offset + widgetPos, flags, sharedPainter, backingStore);
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
#ifndef QT_NO_GRAPHICSEFFECT
|
|
|
|
QRectF QWidgetEffectSourcePrivate::boundingRect(Qt::CoordinateSystem system) const
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
if (system != Qt::DeviceCoordinates)
|
|
|
|
return m_widget->rect();
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
if (!context) {
|
|
|
|
// Device coordinates without context not yet supported.
|
|
|
|
qWarning("QGraphicsEffectSource::boundingRect: Not yet implemented, lacking device context");
|
|
|
|
return QRectF();
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
return context->painter->worldTransform().mapRect(m_widget->rect());
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
void QWidgetEffectSourcePrivate::draw(QPainter *painter)
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
if (!context || context->painter != painter) {
|
|
|
|
m_widget->render(painter);
|
|
|
|
return;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
// The region saved in the context is neither clipped to the rect
|
|
|
|
// nor the mask, so we have to clip it here before calling drawWidget.
|
|
|
|
QRegion toBePainted = context->rgn;
|
|
|
|
toBePainted &= m_widget->rect();
|
|
|
|
QWidgetPrivate *wd = qt_widget_private(m_widget);
|
|
|
|
if (wd->extra && wd->extra->hasMask)
|
|
|
|
toBePainted &= wd->extra->mask;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
wd->drawWidget(context->pdev, toBePainted, context->offset, context->flags,
|
|
|
|
context->sharedPainter, context->backingStore);
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
QPixmap QWidgetEffectSourcePrivate::pixmap(Qt::CoordinateSystem system, QPoint *offset,
|
|
|
|
QGraphicsEffect::PixmapPadMode mode) const
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
const bool deviceCoordinates = (system == Qt::DeviceCoordinates);
|
|
|
|
if (!context && deviceCoordinates) {
|
|
|
|
// Device coordinates without context not yet supported.
|
|
|
|
qWarning("QGraphicsEffectSource::pixmap: Not yet implemented, lacking device context");
|
|
|
|
return QPixmap();
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
QPoint pixmapOffset;
|
|
|
|
QRectF sourceRect = m_widget->rect();
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
if (deviceCoordinates) {
|
|
|
|
const QTransform &painterTransform = context->painter->worldTransform();
|
|
|
|
sourceRect = painterTransform.mapRect(sourceRect);
|
|
|
|
pixmapOffset = painterTransform.map(pixmapOffset);
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
QRect effectRect;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
if (mode == QGraphicsEffect::PadToEffectiveBoundingRect)
|
|
|
|
effectRect = m_widget->graphicsEffect()->boundingRectFor(sourceRect).toAlignedRect();
|
|
|
|
else if (mode == QGraphicsEffect::PadToTransparentBorder)
|
|
|
|
effectRect = sourceRect.adjusted(-1, -1, 1, 1).toAlignedRect();
|
|
|
|
else
|
|
|
|
effectRect = sourceRect.toAlignedRect();
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
if (offset)
|
|
|
|
*offset = effectRect.topLeft();
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
pixmapOffset -= effectRect.topLeft();
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
QPixmap pixmap(effectRect.size());
|
|
|
|
pixmap.fill(Qt::transparent);
|
|
|
|
m_widget->render(&pixmap, pixmapOffset, QRegion(), QWidget::DrawChildren);
|
|
|
|
return pixmap;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
#endif //QT_NO_GRAPHICSEFFECT
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
#ifndef QT_NO_GRAPHICSVIEW
|
|
|
|
/*!
|
|
|
|
\internal
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Finds the nearest widget embedded in a graphics proxy widget along the chain formed by this
|
|
|
|
widget and its ancestors. The search starts at \a origin (inclusive).
|
|
|
|
If successful, the function returns the proxy that embeds the widget, or 0 if no embedded
|
|
|
|
widget was found.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
QGraphicsProxyWidget * QWidgetPrivate::nearestGraphicsProxyWidget(const QWidget *origin)
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
if (origin) {
|
|
|
|
QWExtra *extra = origin->d_func()->extra;
|
|
|
|
if (extra && extra->proxyWidget)
|
|
|
|
return extra->proxyWidget;
|
|
|
|
return nearestGraphicsProxyWidget(origin->parentWidget());
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
return 0;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
#endif
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/*!
|
|
|
|
\property QWidget::locale
|
|
|
|
\brief the widget's locale
|
|
|
|
\since 4.3
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
As long as no special locale has been set, this is either
|
|
|
|
the parent's locale or (if this widget is a top level widget),
|
|
|
|
the default locale.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
If the widget displays dates or numbers, these should be formatted
|
|
|
|
using the widget's locale.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
\sa QLocale QLocale::setDefault()
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
void QWidgetPrivate::setLocale_helper(const QLocale &loc, bool forceUpdate)
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
Q_Q(QWidget);
|
|
|
|
if (locale == loc && !forceUpdate)
|
|
|
|
return;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
locale = loc;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
if (!children.isEmpty()) {
|
|
|
|
for (int i = 0; i < children.size(); ++i) {
|
|
|
|
QWidget *w = qobject_cast<QWidget*>(children.at(i));
|
|
|
|
if (!w)
|
|
|
|
continue;
|
|
|
|
if (w->testAttribute(Qt::WA_SetLocale))
|
|
|
|
continue;
|
|
|
|
if (w->isWindow() && !w->testAttribute(Qt::WA_WindowPropagation))
|
|
|
|
continue;
|
|
|
|
w->d_func()->setLocale_helper(loc, forceUpdate);
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
QEvent e(QEvent::LocaleChange);
|
|
|
|
QApplication::sendEvent(q, &e);
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
void QWidget::setLocale(const QLocale &locale)
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
Q_D(QWidget);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
setAttribute(Qt::WA_SetLocale);
|
|
|
|
d->setLocale_helper(locale);
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
QLocale QWidget::locale() const
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
Q_D(const QWidget);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
return d->locale;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
void QWidgetPrivate::resolveLocale()
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
Q_Q(const QWidget);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
if (!q->testAttribute(Qt::WA_SetLocale)) {
|
|
|
|
setLocale_helper(q->isWindow()
|
|
|
|
? QLocale()
|
|
|
|
: q->parentWidget()->locale());
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
void QWidget::unsetLocale()
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
Q_D(QWidget);
|
|
|
|
setAttribute(Qt::WA_SetLocale, false);
|
|
|
|
d->resolveLocale();
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
static QString constructWindowTitleFromFilePath(const QString &filePath)
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
QFileInfo fi(filePath);
|
|
|
|
QString windowTitle = fi.fileName() + QLatin1String("[*]");
|
|
|
|
#ifndef Q_WS_MAC
|
|
|
|
QString appName = QApplication::applicationName();
|
|
|
|
if (!appName.isEmpty())
|
|
|
|
windowTitle += QLatin1Char(' ') + QChar(0x2014) + QLatin1Char(' ') + appName;
|
|
|
|
#endif
|
|
|
|
return windowTitle;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/*!
|
|
|
|
\property QWidget::windowTitle
|
|
|
|
\brief the window title (caption)
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
This property only makes sense for top-level widgets, such as
|
|
|
|
windows and dialogs. If no caption has been set, the title is based of the
|
|
|
|
\l windowFilePath. If neither of these is set, then the title is
|
|
|
|
an empty string.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
If you use the \l windowModified mechanism, the window title must
|
|
|
|
contain a "[*]" placeholder, which indicates where the '*' should
|
|
|
|
appear. Normally, it should appear right after the file name
|
|
|
|
(e.g., "document1.txt[*] - Text Editor"). If the \l
|
|
|
|
windowModified property is false (the default), the placeholder
|
|
|
|
is simply removed.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
\sa windowIcon, windowIconText, windowModified, windowFilePath
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
QString QWidget::windowTitle() const
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
Q_D(const QWidget);
|
|
|
|
if (d->extra && d->extra->topextra) {
|
|
|
|
if (!d->extra->topextra->caption.isEmpty())
|
|
|
|
return d->extra->topextra->caption;
|
|
|
|
if (!d->extra->topextra->filePath.isEmpty())
|
|
|
|
return constructWindowTitleFromFilePath(d->extra->topextra->filePath);
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
return QString();
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/*!
|
|
|
|
Returns a modified window title with the [*] place holder
|
|
|
|
replaced according to the rules described in QWidget::setWindowTitle
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
This function assumes that "[*]" can be quoted by another
|
|
|
|
"[*]", so it will replace two place holders by one and
|
|
|
|
a single last one by either "*" or nothing depending on
|
|
|
|
the modified flag.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
\internal
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
QString qt_setWindowTitle_helperHelper(const QString &title, const QWidget *widget)
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
Q_ASSERT(widget);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
QString cap = title;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
if (cap.isEmpty())
|
|
|
|
return cap;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
QLatin1String placeHolder("[*]");
|
|
|
|
int placeHolderLength = 3; // QLatin1String doesn't have length()
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
int index = cap.indexOf(placeHolder);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
// here the magic begins
|
|
|
|
while (index != -1) {
|
|
|
|
index += placeHolderLength;
|
|
|
|
int count = 1;
|
|
|
|
while (cap.indexOf(placeHolder, index) == index) {
|
|
|
|
++count;
|
|
|
|
index += placeHolderLength;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
if (count%2) { // odd number of [*] -> replace last one
|
|
|
|
int lastIndex = cap.lastIndexOf(placeHolder, index - 1);
|
|
|
|
if (widget->isWindowModified()
|
|
|
|
&& widget->style()->styleHint(QStyle::SH_TitleBar_ModifyNotification, 0, widget))
|
|
|
|
cap.replace(lastIndex, 3, QWidget::tr("*"));
|
|
|
|
else
|
|
|
|
cap.remove(lastIndex, 3);
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
index = cap.indexOf(placeHolder, index);
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
cap.replace(QLatin1String("[*][*]"), placeHolder);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
return cap;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
void QWidgetPrivate::setWindowTitle_helper(const QString &title)
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
Q_Q(QWidget);
|
|
|
|
if (q->testAttribute(Qt::WA_WState_Created))
|
|
|
|
setWindowTitle_sys(qt_setWindowTitle_helperHelper(title, q));
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
void QWidgetPrivate::setWindowIconText_helper(const QString &title)
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
Q_Q(QWidget);
|
|
|
|
if (q->testAttribute(Qt::WA_WState_Created))
|
|
|
|
setWindowIconText_sys(qt_setWindowTitle_helperHelper(title, q));
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
void QWidget::setWindowIconText(const QString &iconText)
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
if (QWidget::windowIconText() == iconText)
|
|
|
|
return;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Q_D(QWidget);
|
|
|
|
d->topData()->iconText = iconText;
|
|
|
|
d->setWindowIconText_helper(iconText);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
QEvent e(QEvent::IconTextChange);
|
|
|
|
QApplication::sendEvent(this, &e);
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
void QWidget::setWindowTitle(const QString &title)
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
if (QWidget::windowTitle() == title && !title.isEmpty() && !title.isNull())
|
|
|
|
return;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Q_D(QWidget);
|
|
|
|
d->topData()->caption = title;
|
|
|
|
d->setWindowTitle_helper(title);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
QEvent e(QEvent::WindowTitleChange);
|
|
|
|
QApplication::sendEvent(this, &e);
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/*!
|
|
|
|
\property QWidget::windowIcon
|
|
|
|
\brief the widget's icon
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
This property only makes sense for windows. If no icon
|
|
|
|
has been set, windowIcon() returns the application icon
|
|
|
|
(QApplication::windowIcon()).
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
\sa windowIconText, windowTitle
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
QIcon QWidget::windowIcon() const
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
const QWidget *w = this;
|
|
|
|
while (w) {
|
|
|
|
const QWidgetPrivate *d = w->d_func();
|
|
|
|
if (d->extra && d->extra->topextra && d->extra->topextra->icon)
|
|
|
|
return *d->extra->topextra->icon;
|
|
|
|
w = w->parentWidget();
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
return QApplication::windowIcon();
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
void QWidgetPrivate::setWindowIcon_helper()
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
QEvent e(QEvent::WindowIconChange);
|
|
|
|
QApplication::sendEvent(q_func(), &e);
|
|
|
|
for (int i = 0; i < children.size(); ++i) {
|
|
|
|
QWidget *w = qobject_cast<QWidget *>(children.at(i));
|
|
|
|
if (w && !w->isWindow())
|
|
|
|
QApplication::sendEvent(w, &e);
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
void QWidget::setWindowIcon(const QIcon &icon)
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
Q_D(QWidget);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
setAttribute(Qt::WA_SetWindowIcon, !icon.isNull());
|
|
|
|
d->createTLExtra();
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
if (!d->extra->topextra->icon)
|
|
|
|
d->extra->topextra->icon = new QIcon();
|
|
|
|
*d->extra->topextra->icon = icon;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
delete d->extra->topextra->iconPixmap;
|
|
|
|
d->extra->topextra->iconPixmap = 0;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
d->setWindowIcon_sys();
|
|
|
|
d->setWindowIcon_helper();
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/*!
|
|
|
|
\property QWidget::windowIconText
|
|
|
|
\brief the widget's icon text
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
This property only makes sense for windows. If no icon
|
|
|
|
text has been set, this functions returns an empty string.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
\sa windowIcon, windowTitle
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
QString QWidget::windowIconText() const
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
Q_D(const QWidget);
|
|
|
|
return (d->extra && d->extra->topextra) ? d->extra->topextra->iconText : QString();
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/*!
|
|
|
|
\property QWidget::windowFilePath
|
|
|
|
\since 4.4
|
|
|
|
\brief the file path associated with a widget
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
This property only makes sense for windows. It associates a file path with
|
|
|
|
a window. If you set the file path, but have not set the window title, Qt
|
|
|
|
sets the window title to contain a string created using the following
|
|
|
|
components.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
On Mac OS X:
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
\list
|
|
|
|
\o The file name of the specified path, obtained using QFileInfo::fileName().
|
|
|
|
\endlist
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
On Windows and X11:
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
\list
|
|
|
|
\o The file name of the specified path, obtained using QFileInfo::fileName().
|
|
|
|
\o An optional \c{*} character, if the \l windowModified property is set.
|
|
|
|
\o The \c{0x2014} unicode character, padded either side by spaces.
|
|
|
|
\o The application name, obtained from the application's
|
|
|
|
\l{QCoreApplication::}{applicationName} property.
|
|
|
|
\endlist
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
If the window title is set at any point, then the window title takes precedence and
|
|
|
|
will be shown instead of the file path string.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Additionally, on Mac OS X, this has an added benefit that it sets the
|
|
|
|
\l{http://developer.apple.com/documentation/UserExperience/Conceptual/OSXHIGuidelines/XHIGWindows/chapter_17_section_3.html}{proxy icon}
|
|
|
|
for the window, assuming that the file path exists.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
If no file path is set, this property contains an empty string.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
By default, this property contains an empty string.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
\sa windowTitle, windowIcon
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
QString QWidget::windowFilePath() const
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
Q_D(const QWidget);
|
|
|
|
return (d->extra && d->extra->topextra) ? d->extra->topextra->filePath : QString();
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
void QWidget::setWindowFilePath(const QString &filePath)
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
if (filePath == windowFilePath())
|
|
|
|
return;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Q_D(QWidget);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
d->createTLExtra();
|
|
|
|
d->extra->topextra->filePath = filePath;
|
|
|
|
d->setWindowFilePath_helper(filePath);
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
void QWidgetPrivate::setWindowFilePath_helper(const QString &filePath)
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
if (extra->topextra && extra->topextra->caption.isEmpty()) {
|
|
|
|
#ifdef Q_WS_MAC
|
|
|
|
setWindowTitle_helper(QFileInfo(filePath).fileName());
|
|
|
|
#else
|
|
|
|
Q_Q(QWidget);
|
|
|
|
Q_UNUSED(filePath);
|
|
|
|
setWindowTitle_helper(q->windowTitle());
|
|
|
|
#endif
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
#ifdef Q_WS_MAC
|
|
|
|
setWindowFilePath_sys(filePath);
|
|
|
|
#endif
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/*!
|
|
|
|
Returns the window's role, or an empty string.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
\sa windowIcon, windowTitle
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
QString QWidget::windowRole() const
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
Q_D(const QWidget);
|
|
|
|
return (d->extra && d->extra->topextra) ? d->extra->topextra->role : QString();
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/*!
|
|
|
|
Sets the window's role to \a role. This only makes sense for
|
|
|
|
windows on X11.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
void QWidget::setWindowRole(const QString &role)
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
#if defined(Q_WS_X11)
|
|
|
|
Q_D(QWidget);
|
|
|
|
d->topData()->role = role;
|
|
|
|
d->setWindowRole();
|
|
|
|
#else
|
|
|
|
Q_UNUSED(role)
|
|
|
|
#endif
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/*!
|
|
|
|
\property QWidget::mouseTracking
|
|
|
|
\brief whether mouse tracking is enabled for the widget
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
If mouse tracking is disabled (the default), the widget only
|
|
|
|
receives mouse move events when at least one mouse button is
|
|
|
|
pressed while the mouse is being moved.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
If mouse tracking is enabled, the widget receives mouse move
|
|
|
|
events even if no buttons are pressed.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
\sa mouseMoveEvent()
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/*!
|
|
|
|
Sets the widget's focus proxy to widget \a w. If \a w is 0, the
|
|
|
|
function resets this widget to have no focus proxy.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Some widgets can "have focus", but create a child widget, such as
|
|
|
|
QLineEdit, to actually handle the focus. In this case, the widget
|
|
|
|
can set the line edit to be its focus proxy.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
setFocusProxy() sets the widget which will actually get focus when
|
|
|
|
"this widget" gets it. If there is a focus proxy, setFocus() and
|
|
|
|
hasFocus() operate on the focus proxy.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
\sa focusProxy()
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
void QWidget::setFocusProxy(QWidget * w)
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
Q_D(QWidget);
|
|
|
|
if (!w && !d->extra)
|
|
|
|
return;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
for (QWidget* fp = w; fp; fp = fp->focusProxy()) {
|
|
|
|
if (fp == this) {
|
|
|
|
qWarning("QWidget: %s (%s) already in focus proxy chain", metaObject()->className(), objectName().toLocal8Bit().constData());
|
|
|
|
return;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
d->createExtra();
|
|
|
|
d->extra->focus_proxy = w;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/*!
|
|
|
|
Returns the focus proxy, or 0 if there is no focus proxy.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
\sa setFocusProxy()
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
QWidget * QWidget::focusProxy() const
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
Q_D(const QWidget);
|
|
|
|
return d->extra ? (QWidget *)d->extra->focus_proxy : 0;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/*!
|
|
|
|
\property QWidget::focus
|
|
|
|
\brief whether this widget (or its focus proxy) has the keyboard
|
|
|
|
input focus
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
By default, this property is false.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
\note Obtaining the value of this property for a widget is effectively equivalent
|
|
|
|
to checking whether QApplication::focusWidget() refers to the widget.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
\sa setFocus(), clearFocus(), setFocusPolicy(), QApplication::focusWidget()
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
bool QWidget::hasFocus() const
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
const QWidget* w = this;
|
|
|
|
while (w->d_func()->extra && w->d_func()->extra->focus_proxy)
|
|
|
|
w = w->d_func()->extra->focus_proxy;
|
|
|
|
if (QWidget *window = w->window()) {
|
|
|
|
#ifndef QT_NO_GRAPHICSVIEW
|
|
|
|
QWExtra *e = window->d_func()->extra;
|
|
|
|
if (e && e->proxyWidget && e->proxyWidget->hasFocus() && window->focusWidget() == w)
|
|
|
|
return true;
|
|
|
|
#endif
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
return (QApplication::focusWidget() == w);
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/*!
|
|
|
|
Gives the keyboard input focus to this widget (or its focus
|
|
|
|
proxy) if this widget or one of its parents is the \link
|
|
|
|
isActiveWindow() active window\endlink. The \a reason argument will
|
|
|
|
be passed into any focus event sent from this function, it is used
|
|
|
|
to give an explanation of what caused the widget to get focus.
|
|
|
|
If the window is not active, the widget will be given the focus when
|
|
|
|
the window becomes active.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
First, a focus out event is sent to the focus widget (if any) to
|
|
|
|
tell it that it is about to lose the focus. Then a focus in event
|
|
|
|
is sent to this widget to tell it that it just received the focus.
|
|
|
|
(Nothing happens if the focus in and focus out widgets are the
|
|
|
|
same.)
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
\note On embedded platforms, setFocus() will not cause an input panel
|
|
|
|
to be opened by the input method. If you want this to happen, you
|
|
|
|
have to send a QEvent::RequestSoftwareInputPanel event to the
|
|
|
|
widget yourself.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
setFocus() gives focus to a widget regardless of its focus policy,
|
|
|
|
but does not clear any keyboard grab (see grabKeyboard()).
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Be aware that if the widget is hidden, it will not accept focus
|
|
|
|
until it is shown.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
\warning If you call setFocus() in a function which may itself be
|
|
|
|
called from focusOutEvent() or focusInEvent(), you may get an
|
|
|
|
infinite recursion.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
\sa hasFocus(), clearFocus(), focusInEvent(), focusOutEvent(),
|
|
|
|
setFocusPolicy(), focusWidget(), QApplication::focusWidget(), grabKeyboard(),
|
|
|
|
grabMouse(), {Keyboard Focus}, QEvent::RequestSoftwareInputPanel
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
void QWidget::setFocus(Qt::FocusReason reason)
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
if (!isEnabled())
|
|
|
|
return;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
QWidget *f = this;
|
|
|
|
while (f->d_func()->extra && f->d_func()->extra->focus_proxy)
|
|
|
|
f = f->d_func()->extra->focus_proxy;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
if (QApplication::focusWidget() == f
|
|
|
|
#if defined(Q_WS_WIN)
|
|
|
|
&& GetFocus() == f->internalWinId()
|
|
|
|
#endif
|
|
|
|
)
|
|
|
|
return;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
#ifndef QT_NO_GRAPHICSVIEW
|
|
|
|
QWidget *previousProxyFocus = 0;
|
|
|
|
if (QWExtra *topData = window()->d_func()->extra) {
|
|
|
|
if (topData->proxyWidget && topData->proxyWidget->hasFocus()) {
|
|
|
|
previousProxyFocus = topData->proxyWidget->widget()->focusWidget();
|
|
|
|
if (previousProxyFocus && previousProxyFocus->focusProxy())
|
|
|
|
previousProxyFocus = previousProxyFocus->focusProxy();
|
|
|
|
if (previousProxyFocus == this && !topData->proxyWidget->d_func()->proxyIsGivingFocus)
|
|
|
|
return;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
#endif
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
QWidget *w = f;
|
|
|
|
if (isHidden()) {
|
|
|
|
while (w && w->isHidden()) {
|
|
|
|
w->d_func()->focus_child = f;
|
|
|
|
w = w->isWindow() ? 0 : w->parentWidget();
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
} else {
|
|
|
|
while (w) {
|
|
|
|
w->d_func()->focus_child = f;
|
|
|
|
w = w->isWindow() ? 0 : w->parentWidget();
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
#ifndef QT_NO_GRAPHICSVIEW
|
|
|
|
// Update proxy state
|
|
|
|
if (QWExtra *topData = window()->d_func()->extra) {
|
|
|
|
if (topData->proxyWidget && !topData->proxyWidget->hasFocus()) {
|
|
|
|
topData->proxyWidget->d_func()->focusFromWidgetToProxy = 1;
|
|
|
|
topData->proxyWidget->setFocus(reason);
|
|
|
|
topData->proxyWidget->d_func()->focusFromWidgetToProxy = 0;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
#endif
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
if (f->isActiveWindow()) {
|
|
|
|
QApplicationPrivate::setFocusWidget(f, reason);
|
|
|
|
#ifndef QT_NO_ACCESSIBILITY
|
|
|
|
# ifdef Q_OS_WIN
|
|
|
|
// The negation of the condition in setFocus_sys
|
|
|
|
if (!(testAttribute(Qt::WA_WState_Created) && window()->windowType() != Qt::Popup && internalWinId()))
|
|
|
|
//setFocusWidget will already post a focus event for us (that the AT client receives) on Windows
|
|
|
|
# endif
|
|
|
|
# ifdef Q_OS_UNIX
|
|
|
|
// menus update the focus manually and this would create bogus events
|
|
|
|
if (!(f->inherits("QMenuBar") || f->inherits("QMenu") || f->inherits("QMenuItem")))
|
|
|
|
# endif
|
|
|
|
QAccessible::updateAccessibility(f, 0, QAccessible::Focus);
|
|
|
|
#endif
|
|
|
|
#ifndef QT_NO_GRAPHICSVIEW
|
|
|
|
if (QWExtra *topData = window()->d_func()->extra) {
|
|
|
|
if (topData->proxyWidget) {
|
|
|
|
if (previousProxyFocus && previousProxyFocus != f) {
|
|
|
|
// Send event to self
|
|
|
|
QFocusEvent event(QEvent::FocusOut, reason);
|
|
|
|
QPointer<QWidget> that = previousProxyFocus;
|
|
|
|
QApplication::sendEvent(previousProxyFocus, &event);
|
|
|
|
if (that)
|
|
|
|
QApplication::sendEvent(that->style(), &event);
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if (!isHidden()) {
|
|
|
|
#ifndef QT_NO_GRAPHICSVIEW
|
|
|
|
// Update proxy state
|
|
|
|
if (QWExtra *topData = window()->d_func()->extra)
|
|
|
|
if (topData->proxyWidget && topData->proxyWidget->hasFocus())
|
|
|
|
topData->proxyWidget->d_func()->updateProxyInputMethodAcceptanceFromWidget();
|
|
|
|
#endif
|
|
|
|
// Send event to self
|
|
|
|
QFocusEvent event(QEvent::FocusIn, reason);
|
|
|
|
QPointer<QWidget> that = f;
|
|
|
|
QApplication::sendEvent(f, &event);
|
|
|
|
if (that)
|
|
|
|
QApplication::sendEvent(that->style(), &event);
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
#endif
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/*!
|
|
|
|
\fn void QWidget::setFocus()
|
|
|
|
\overload
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Gives the keyboard input focus to this widget (or its focus
|
|
|
|
proxy) if this widget or one of its parents is the
|
|
|
|
\l{isActiveWindow()}{active window}.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/*!
|
|
|
|
Takes keyboard input focus from the widget.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
If the widget has active focus, a \link focusOutEvent() focus out
|
|
|
|
event\endlink is sent to this widget to tell it that it is about
|
|
|
|
to lose the focus.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
This widget must enable focus setting in order to get the keyboard
|
|
|
|
input focus, i.e. it must call setFocusPolicy().
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
\sa hasFocus(), setFocus(), focusInEvent(), focusOutEvent(),
|
|
|
|
setFocusPolicy(), QApplication::focusWidget()
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
void QWidget::clearFocus()
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
QWidget *w = this;
|
|
|
|
while (w) {
|
|
|
|
if (w->d_func()->focus_child == this)
|
|
|
|
w->d_func()->focus_child = 0;
|
|
|
|
w = w->parentWidget();
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
#ifndef QT_NO_GRAPHICSVIEW
|
|
|
|
QWExtra *topData = d_func()->extra;
|
|
|
|
if (topData && topData->proxyWidget)
|
|
|
|
topData->proxyWidget->clearFocus();
|
|
|
|
#endif
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
if (hasFocus()) {
|
|
|
|
// Update proxy state
|
|
|
|
QApplicationPrivate::setFocusWidget(0, Qt::OtherFocusReason);
|
|
|
|
#if defined(Q_WS_WIN)
|
|
|
|
if (!(windowType() == Qt::Popup) && GetFocus() == internalWinId())
|
|
|
|
SetFocus(0);
|
|
|
|
else
|
|
|
|
#endif
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
#ifndef QT_NO_ACCESSIBILITY
|
|
|
|
QAccessible::updateAccessibility(this, 0, QAccessible::Focus);
|
|
|
|
#endif
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/*!
|
|
|
|
\fn bool QWidget::focusNextChild()
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Finds a new widget to give the keyboard focus to, as appropriate
|
|
|
|
for \key Tab, and returns true if it can find a new widget, or
|
|
|
|
false if it can't.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
\sa focusPreviousChild()
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/*!
|
|
|
|
\fn bool QWidget::focusPreviousChild()
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Finds a new widget to give the keyboard focus to, as appropriate
|
|
|
|
for \key Shift+Tab, and returns true if it can find a new widget,
|
|
|
|
or false if it can't.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
\sa focusNextChild()
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/*!
|
|
|
|
Finds a new widget to give the keyboard focus to, as appropriate
|
|
|
|
for Tab and Shift+Tab, and returns true if it can find a new
|
|
|
|
widget, or false if it can't.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
If \a next is true, this function searches forward, if \a next
|
|
|
|
is false, it searches backward.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Sometimes, you will want to reimplement this function. For
|
|
|
|
example, a web browser might reimplement it to move its "current
|
|
|
|
active link" forward or backward, and call
|
|
|
|
focusNextPrevChild() only when it reaches the last or
|
|
|
|
first link on the "page".
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Child widgets call focusNextPrevChild() on their parent widgets,
|
|
|
|
but only the window that contains the child widgets decides where
|
|
|
|
to redirect focus. By reimplementing this function for an object,
|
|
|
|
you thus gain control of focus traversal for all child widgets.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
\sa focusNextChild(), focusPreviousChild()
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
bool QWidget::focusNextPrevChild(bool next)
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
Q_D(QWidget);
|
|
|
|
QWidget* p = parentWidget();
|
|
|
|
bool isSubWindow = (windowType() == Qt::SubWindow);
|
|
|
|
if (!isWindow() && !isSubWindow && p)
|
|
|
|
return p->focusNextPrevChild(next);
|
|
|
|
#ifndef QT_NO_GRAPHICSVIEW
|
|
|
|
if (d->extra && d->extra->proxyWidget)
|
|
|
|
return d->extra->proxyWidget->focusNextPrevChild(next);
|
|
|
|
#endif
|
|
|
|
QWidget *w = QApplicationPrivate::focusNextPrevChild_helper(this, next);
|
|
|
|
if (!w) return false;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
w->setFocus(next ? Qt::TabFocusReason : Qt::BacktabFocusReason);
|
|
|
|
return true;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/*!
|
|
|
|
Returns the last child of this widget that setFocus had been
|
|
|
|
called on. For top level widgets this is the widget that will get
|
|
|
|
focus in case this window gets activated
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
This is not the same as QApplication::focusWidget(), which returns
|
|
|
|
the focus widget in the currently active window.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
QWidget *QWidget::focusWidget() const
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
return const_cast<QWidget *>(d_func()->focus_child);
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/*!
|
|
|
|
Returns the next widget in this widget's focus chain.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
\sa previousInFocusChain()
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
QWidget *QWidget::nextInFocusChain() const
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
return const_cast<QWidget *>(d_func()->focus_next);
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/*!
|
|
|
|
\brief The previousInFocusChain function returns the previous
|
|
|
|
widget in this widget's focus chain.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
\sa nextInFocusChain()
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
\since 4.6
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
QWidget *QWidget::previousInFocusChain() const
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
return const_cast<QWidget *>(d_func()->focus_prev);
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/*!
|
|
|
|
\property QWidget::isActiveWindow
|
|
|
|
\brief whether this widget's window is the active window
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
The active window is the window that contains the widget that has
|
|
|
|
keyboard focus (The window may still have focus if it has no
|
|
|
|
widgets or none of its widgets accepts keyboard focus).
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
When popup windows are visible, this property is true for both the
|
|
|
|
active window \e and for the popup.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
By default, this property is false.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
\sa activateWindow(), QApplication::activeWindow()
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
bool QWidget::isActiveWindow() const
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
QWidget *tlw = window();
|
|
|
|
if(tlw == QApplication::activeWindow() || (isVisible() && (tlw->windowType() == Qt::Popup)))
|
|
|
|
return true;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
#ifndef QT_NO_GRAPHICSVIEW
|
|
|
|
if (QWExtra *tlwExtra = tlw->d_func()->extra) {
|
|
|
|
if (isVisible() && tlwExtra->proxyWidget)
|
|
|
|
return tlwExtra->proxyWidget->isActiveWindow();
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
#endif
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
#ifdef Q_WS_MAC
|
|
|
|
extern bool qt_mac_is_macdrawer(const QWidget *); //qwidget_mac.cpp
|
|
|
|
if(qt_mac_is_macdrawer(tlw) &&
|
|
|
|
tlw->parentWidget() && tlw->parentWidget()->isActiveWindow())
|
|
|
|
return true;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
extern bool qt_mac_insideKeyWindow(const QWidget *); //qwidget_mac.cpp
|
|
|
|
if (QApplication::testAttribute(Qt::AA_MacPluginApplication) && qt_mac_insideKeyWindow(tlw))
|
|
|
|
return true;
|
|
|
|
#endif
|
|
|
|
if(style()->styleHint(QStyle::SH_Widget_ShareActivation, 0, this)) {
|
|
|
|
if(tlw->windowType() == Qt::Tool &&
|
|
|
|
!tlw->isModal() &&
|
|
|
|
(!tlw->parentWidget() || tlw->parentWidget()->isActiveWindow()))
|
|
|
|
return true;
|
|
|
|
QWidget *w = QApplication::activeWindow();
|
|
|
|
while(w && tlw->windowType() == Qt::Tool &&
|
|
|
|
!w->isModal() && w->parentWidget()) {
|
|
|
|
w = w->parentWidget()->window();
|
|
|
|
if(w == tlw)
|
|
|
|
return true;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
#if defined(Q_WS_WIN32)
|
|
|
|
HWND active = GetActiveWindow();
|
|
|
|
if (!tlw->testAttribute(Qt::WA_WState_Created))
|
|
|
|
return false;
|
|
|
|
return active == tlw->internalWinId() || ::IsChild(active, tlw->internalWinId());
|
|
|
|
#else
|
|
|
|
return false;
|
|
|
|
#endif
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/*!
|
|
|
|
Puts the \a second widget after the \a first widget in the focus order.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Note that since the tab order of the \a second widget is changed, you
|
|
|
|
should order a chain like this:
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
\snippet doc/src/snippets/code/src_gui_kernel_qwidget.cpp 9
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
\e not like this:
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
\snippet doc/src/snippets/code/src_gui_kernel_qwidget.cpp 10
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
If \a first or \a second has a focus proxy, setTabOrder()
|
|
|
|
correctly substitutes the proxy.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
\sa setFocusPolicy(), setFocusProxy(), {Keyboard Focus}
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
void QWidget::setTabOrder(QWidget* first, QWidget *second)
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
if (!first || !second || first->focusPolicy() == Qt::NoFocus || second->focusPolicy() == Qt::NoFocus)
|
|
|
|
return;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
if (first->window() != second->window()) {
|
|
|
|
qWarning("QWidget::setTabOrder: 'first' and 'second' must be in the same window");
|
|
|
|
return;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
QWidget *fp = first->focusProxy();
|
|
|
|
if (fp) {
|
|
|
|
// If first is redirected, set first to the last child of first
|
|
|
|
// that can take keyboard focus so that second is inserted after
|
|
|
|
// that last child, and the focus order within first is (more
|
|
|
|
// likely to be) preserved.
|
|
|
|
QList<QWidget *> l = first->findChildren<QWidget *>();
|
|
|
|
for (int i = l.size()-1; i >= 0; --i) {
|
|
|
|
QWidget * next = l.at(i);
|
|
|
|
if (next->window() == fp->window()) {
|
|
|
|
fp = next;
|
|
|
|
if (fp->focusPolicy() != Qt::NoFocus)
|
|
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
first = fp;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
if (fp == second)
|
|
|
|
return;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
if (QWidget *sp = second->focusProxy())
|
|
|
|
second = sp;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
// QWidget *fp = first->d_func()->focus_prev;
|
|
|
|
QWidget *fn = first->d_func()->focus_next;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
if (fn == second || first == second)
|
|
|
|
return;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
QWidget *sp = second->d_func()->focus_prev;
|
|
|
|
QWidget *sn = second->d_func()->focus_next;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
fn->d_func()->focus_prev = second;
|
|
|
|
first->d_func()->focus_next = second;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
second->d_func()->focus_next = fn;
|
|
|
|
second->d_func()->focus_prev = first;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
sp->d_func()->focus_next = sn;
|
|
|
|
sn->d_func()->focus_prev = sp;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Q_ASSERT(first->d_func()->focus_next->d_func()->focus_prev == first);
|
|
|
|
Q_ASSERT(first->d_func()->focus_prev->d_func()->focus_next == first);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Q_ASSERT(second->d_func()->focus_next->d_func()->focus_prev == second);
|
|
|
|
Q_ASSERT(second->d_func()->focus_prev->d_func()->focus_next == second);
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/*!\internal
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Moves the relevant subwidgets of this widget from the \a oldtlw's
|
|
|
|
tab chain to that of the new parent, if there's anything to move and
|
|
|
|
we're really moving
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
This function is called from QWidget::reparent() *after* the widget
|
|
|
|
has been reparented.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
\sa reparent()
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
void QWidgetPrivate::reparentFocusWidgets(QWidget * oldtlw)
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
Q_Q(QWidget);
|
|
|
|
if (oldtlw == q->window())
|
|
|
|
return; // nothing to do
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
if(focus_child)
|
|
|
|
focus_child->clearFocus();
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
// separate the focus chain into new (children of myself) and old (the rest)
|
|
|
|
QWidget *firstOld = 0;
|
|
|
|
//QWidget *firstNew = q; //invariant
|
|
|
|
QWidget *o = 0; // last in the old list
|
|
|
|
QWidget *n = q; // last in the new list
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
bool prevWasNew = true;
|
|
|
|
QWidget *w = focus_next;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
//Note: for efficiency, we do not maintain the list invariant inside the loop
|
|
|
|
//we append items to the relevant list, and we optimize by not changing pointers
|
|
|
|
//when subsequent items are going into the same list.
|
|
|
|
while (w != q) {
|
|
|
|
bool currentIsNew = q->isAncestorOf(w);
|
|
|
|
if (currentIsNew) {
|
|
|
|
if (!prevWasNew) {
|
|
|
|
//prev was old -- append to new list
|
|
|
|
n->d_func()->focus_next = w;
|
|
|
|
w->d_func()->focus_prev = n;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
n = w;
|
|
|
|
} else {
|
|
|
|
if (prevWasNew) {
|
|
|
|
//prev was new -- append to old list, if there is one
|
|
|
|
if (o) {
|
|
|
|
o->d_func()->focus_next = w;
|
|
|
|
w->d_func()->focus_prev = o;
|
|
|
|
} else {
|
|
|
|
// "create" the old list
|
|
|
|
firstOld = w;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
o = w;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
w = w->d_func()->focus_next;
|
|
|
|
prevWasNew = currentIsNew;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
//repair the old list:
|
|
|
|
if (firstOld) {
|
|
|
|
o->d_func()->focus_next = firstOld;
|
|
|
|
firstOld->d_func()->focus_prev = o;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
if (!q->isWindow()) {
|
|
|
|
QWidget *topLevel = q->window();
|
|
|
|
//insert new chain into toplevel's chain
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
QWidget *prev = topLevel->d_func()->focus_prev;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
topLevel->d_func()->focus_prev = n;
|
|
|
|
prev->d_func()->focus_next = q;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
focus_prev = prev;
|
|
|
|
n->d_func()->focus_next = topLevel;
|
|
|
|
} else {
|
|
|
|
//repair the new list
|
|
|
|
n->d_func()->focus_next = q;
|
|
|
|
focus_prev = n;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/*!\internal
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Measures the shortest distance from a point to a rect.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
This function is called from QDesktopwidget::screen(QPoint) to find the
|
|
|
|
closest screen for a point.
|
|
|
|
In directional KeypadNavigation, it is called to find the closest
|
|
|
|
widget to the current focus widget center.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
int QWidgetPrivate::pointToRect(const QPoint &p, const QRect &r)
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
int dx = 0;
|
|
|
|
int dy = 0;
|
|
|
|
if (p.x() < r.left())
|
|
|
|
dx = r.left() - p.x();
|
|
|
|
else if (p.x() > r.right())
|
|
|
|
dx = p.x() - r.right();
|
|
|
|
if (p.y() < r.top())
|
|
|
|
dy = r.top() - p.y();
|
|
|
|
else if (p.y() > r.bottom())
|
|
|
|
dy = p.y() - r.bottom();
|
|
|
|
return dx + dy;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/*!
|
|
|
|
\property QWidget::frameSize
|
|
|
|
\brief the size of the widget including any window frame
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
By default, this property contains a value that depends on the user's
|
|
|
|
platform and screen geometry.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
QSize QWidget::frameSize() const
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
Q_D(const QWidget);
|
|
|
|
if (isWindow() && !(windowType() == Qt::Popup)) {
|
|
|
|
QRect fs = d->frameStrut();
|
|
|
|
return QSize(data->crect.width() + fs.left() + fs.right(),
|
|
|
|
data->crect.height() + fs.top() + fs.bottom());
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
return data->crect.size();
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/*! \fn void QWidget::move(int x, int y)
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
\overload
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
This corresponds to move(QPoint(\a x, \a y)).
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
void QWidget::move(const QPoint &p)
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
Q_D(QWidget);
|
|
|
|
setAttribute(Qt::WA_Moved);
|
|
|
|
if (isWindow())
|
|
|
|
d->topData()->posFromMove = true;
|
|
|
|
if (testAttribute(Qt::WA_WState_Created)) {
|
|
|
|
d->setGeometry_sys(p.x() + geometry().x() - QWidget::x(),
|
|
|
|
p.y() + geometry().y() - QWidget::y(),
|
|
|
|
width(), height(), true);
|
|
|
|
d->setDirtyOpaqueRegion();
|
|
|
|
} else {
|
|
|
|
data->crect.moveTopLeft(p); // no frame yet
|
|
|
|
setAttribute(Qt::WA_PendingMoveEvent);
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/*! \fn void QWidget::resize(int w, int h)
|
|
|
|
\overload
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
This corresponds to resize(QSize(\a w, \a h)).
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
void QWidget::resize(const QSize &s)
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
Q_D(QWidget);
|
|
|
|
setAttribute(Qt::WA_Resized);
|
|
|
|
if (testAttribute(Qt::WA_WState_Created)) {
|
|
|
|
d->setGeometry_sys(geometry().x(), geometry().y(), s.width(), s.height(), false);
|
|
|
|
d->setDirtyOpaqueRegion();
|
|
|
|
} else {
|
|
|
|
data->crect.setSize(s.boundedTo(maximumSize()).expandedTo(minimumSize()));
|
|
|
|
setAttribute(Qt::WA_PendingResizeEvent);
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
void QWidget::setGeometry(const QRect &r)
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
Q_D(QWidget);
|
|
|
|
setAttribute(Qt::WA_Resized);
|
|
|
|
setAttribute(Qt::WA_Moved);
|
|
|
|
if (isWindow())
|
|
|
|
d->topData()->posFromMove = false;
|
|
|
|
if (testAttribute(Qt::WA_WState_Created)) {
|
|
|
|
d->setGeometry_sys(r.x(), r.y(), r.width(), r.height(), true);
|
|
|
|
d->setDirtyOpaqueRegion();
|
|
|
|
} else {
|
|
|
|
data->crect.setTopLeft(r.topLeft());
|
|
|
|
data->crect.setSize(r.size().boundedTo(maximumSize()).expandedTo(minimumSize()));
|
|
|
|
setAttribute(Qt::WA_PendingMoveEvent);
|
|
|
|
setAttribute(Qt::WA_PendingResizeEvent);
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/*!
|
|
|
|
\since 4.2
|
|
|
|
Saves the current geometry and state for top-level widgets.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
To save the geometry when the window closes, you can
|
|
|
|
implement a close event like this:
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
\snippet doc/src/snippets/code/src_gui_kernel_qwidget.cpp 11
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
See the \l{Window Geometry} documentation for an overview of geometry
|
|
|
|
issues with windows.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Use QMainWindow::saveState() to save the geometry and the state of
|
|
|
|
toolbars and dock widgets.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
\sa restoreGeometry(), QMainWindow::saveState(), QMainWindow::restoreState()
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
QByteArray QWidget::saveGeometry() const
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
#ifdef QT_MAC_USE_COCOA
|
|
|
|
// We check if the window was maximized during this invocation. If so, we need to record the
|
|
|
|
// starting position as 0,0.
|
|
|
|
Q_D(const QWidget);
|
|
|
|
QRect newFramePosition = frameGeometry();
|
|
|
|
QRect newNormalPosition = normalGeometry();
|
|
|
|
if(d->topData()->wasMaximized && !(windowState() & Qt::WindowMaximized)) {
|
|
|
|
// Change the starting position
|
|
|
|
newFramePosition.moveTo(0, 0);
|
|
|
|
newNormalPosition.moveTo(0, 0);
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
#endif // QT_MAC_USE_COCOA
|
|
|
|
QByteArray array;
|
|
|
|
QDataStream stream(&array, QIODevice::WriteOnly);
|
|
|
|
stream.setVersion(QDataStream::Qt_4_0);
|
|
|
|
const quint32 magicNumber = 0x1D9D0CB;
|
|
|
|
quint16 majorVersion = 1;
|
|
|
|
quint16 minorVersion = 0;
|
|
|
|
stream << magicNumber
|
|
|
|
<< majorVersion
|
|
|
|
<< minorVersion
|
|
|
|
#ifdef QT_MAC_USE_COCOA
|
|
|
|
<< newFramePosition
|
|
|
|
<< newNormalPosition
|
|
|
|
#else
|
|
|
|
<< frameGeometry()
|
|
|
|
<< normalGeometry()
|
|
|
|
#endif // QT_MAC_USE_COCOA
|
|
|
|
<< qint32(QApplication::desktop()->screenNumber(this))
|
|
|
|
<< quint8(windowState() & Qt::WindowMaximized)
|
|
|
|
<< quint8(windowState() & Qt::WindowFullScreen);
|
|
|
|
return array;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/*!
|
|
|
|
\since 4.2
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Restores the geometry and state top-level widgets stored in the
|
|
|
|
byte array \a geometry. Returns true on success; otherwise
|
|
|
|
returns false.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
If the restored geometry is off-screen, it will be modified to be
|
|
|
|
inside the available screen geometry.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
To restore geometry saved using QSettings, you can use code like
|
|
|
|
this:
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
\snippet doc/src/snippets/code/src_gui_kernel_qwidget.cpp 12
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
See the \l{Window Geometry} documentation for an overview of geometry
|
|
|
|
issues with windows.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Use QMainWindow::restoreState() to restore the geometry and the
|
|
|
|
state of toolbars and dock widgets.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
\sa saveGeometry(), QSettings, QMainWindow::saveState(), QMainWindow::restoreState()
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
bool QWidget::restoreGeometry(const QByteArray &geometry)
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
if (geometry.size() < 4)
|
|
|
|
return false;
|
|
|
|
QDataStream stream(geometry);
|
|
|
|
stream.setVersion(QDataStream::Qt_4_0);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
const quint32 magicNumber = 0x1D9D0CB;
|
|
|
|
quint32 storedMagicNumber;
|
|
|
|
stream >> storedMagicNumber;
|
|
|
|
if (storedMagicNumber != magicNumber)
|
|
|
|
return false;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
const quint16 currentMajorVersion = 1;
|
|
|
|
quint16 majorVersion = 0;
|
|
|
|
quint16 minorVersion = 0;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
stream >> majorVersion >> minorVersion;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
if (majorVersion != currentMajorVersion)
|
|
|
|
return false;
|
|
|
|
// (Allow all minor versions.)
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
QRect restoredFrameGeometry;
|
|
|
|
QRect restoredNormalGeometry;
|
|
|
|
qint32 restoredScreenNumber;
|
|
|
|
quint8 maximized;
|
|
|
|
quint8 fullScreen;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
stream >> restoredFrameGeometry
|
|
|
|
>> restoredNormalGeometry
|
|
|
|
>> restoredScreenNumber
|
|
|
|
>> maximized
|
|
|
|
>> fullScreen;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
const int frameHeight = 20;
|
|
|
|
if (!restoredFrameGeometry.isValid())
|
|
|
|
restoredFrameGeometry = QRect(QPoint(0,0), sizeHint());
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
if (!restoredNormalGeometry.isValid())
|
|
|
|
restoredNormalGeometry = QRect(QPoint(0, frameHeight), sizeHint());
|
|
|
|
if (!restoredNormalGeometry.isValid()) {
|
|
|
|
// use the widget's adjustedSize if the sizeHint() doesn't help
|
|
|
|
restoredNormalGeometry.setSize(restoredNormalGeometry
|
|
|
|
.size()
|
|
|
|
.expandedTo(d_func()->adjustedSize()));
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
const QDesktopWidget * const desktop = QApplication::desktop();
|
2016-02-17 20:51:10 +02:00
|
|
|
if (restoredScreenNumber >= desktop->screenCount())
|
2015-12-10 05:06:13 +02:00
|
|
|
restoredScreenNumber = desktop->primaryScreen();
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
const QRect availableGeometry = desktop->availableGeometry(restoredScreenNumber);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
// Modify the restored geometry if we are about to restore to coordinates
|
|
|
|
// that would make the window "lost". This happens if:
|
|
|
|
// - The restored geometry is completely oustside the available geometry
|
|
|
|
// - The title bar is outside the available geometry.
|
|
|
|
// - (Mac only) The window is higher than the available geometry. It must
|
|
|
|
// be possible to bring the size grip on screen by moving the window.
|
|
|
|
#ifdef Q_WS_MAC
|
|
|
|
restoredFrameGeometry.setHeight(qMin(restoredFrameGeometry.height(), availableGeometry.height()));
|
|
|
|
restoredNormalGeometry.setHeight(qMin(restoredNormalGeometry.height(), availableGeometry.height() - frameHeight));
|
|
|
|
#endif
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
if (!restoredFrameGeometry.intersects(availableGeometry)) {
|
|
|
|
restoredFrameGeometry.moveBottom(qMin(restoredFrameGeometry.bottom(), availableGeometry.bottom()));
|
|
|
|
restoredFrameGeometry.moveLeft(qMax(restoredFrameGeometry.left(), availableGeometry.left()));
|
|
|
|
restoredFrameGeometry.moveRight(qMin(restoredFrameGeometry.right(), availableGeometry.right()));
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
restoredFrameGeometry.moveTop(qMax(restoredFrameGeometry.top(), availableGeometry.top()));
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
if (!restoredNormalGeometry.intersects(availableGeometry)) {
|
|
|
|
restoredNormalGeometry.moveBottom(qMin(restoredNormalGeometry.bottom(), availableGeometry.bottom()));
|
|
|
|
restoredNormalGeometry.moveLeft(qMax(restoredNormalGeometry.left(), availableGeometry.left()));
|
|
|
|
restoredNormalGeometry.moveRight(qMin(restoredNormalGeometry.right(), availableGeometry.right()));
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
restoredNormalGeometry.moveTop(qMax(restoredNormalGeometry.top(), availableGeometry.top() + frameHeight));
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
if (maximized || fullScreen) {
|
|
|
|
// set geomerty before setting the window state to make
|
|
|
|
// sure the window is maximized to the right screen.
|
|
|
|
Qt::WindowStates ws = windowState();
|
|
|
|
#ifndef Q_WS_WIN
|
|
|
|
setGeometry(restoredNormalGeometry);
|
|
|
|
#else
|
|
|
|
if (ws & Qt::WindowFullScreen) {
|
|
|
|
// Full screen is not a real window state on Windows.
|
|
|
|
move(availableGeometry.topLeft());
|
|
|
|
} else if (ws & Qt::WindowMaximized) {
|
|
|
|
// Setting a geometry on an already maximized window causes this to be
|
|
|
|
// restored into a broken, half-maximized state, non-resizable state (QTBUG-4397).
|
|
|
|
// Move the window in normal state if needed.
|
|
|
|
if (restoredScreenNumber != desktop->screenNumber(this)) {
|
|
|
|
setWindowState(Qt::WindowNoState);
|
|
|
|
setGeometry(restoredNormalGeometry);
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
} else {
|
|
|
|
setGeometry(restoredNormalGeometry);
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
#endif // Q_WS_WIN
|
|
|
|
if (maximized)
|
|
|
|
ws |= Qt::WindowMaximized;
|
|
|
|
if (fullScreen)
|
|
|
|
ws |= Qt::WindowFullScreen;
|
|
|
|
setWindowState(ws);
|
|
|
|
d_func()->topData()->normalGeometry = restoredNormalGeometry;
|
|
|
|
} else {
|
|
|
|
QPoint offset;
|
|
|
|
#ifdef Q_WS_X11
|
|
|
|
if (isFullScreen())
|
|
|
|
offset = d_func()->topData()->fullScreenOffset;
|
|
|
|
#endif
|
|
|
|
setWindowState(windowState() & ~(Qt::WindowMaximized | Qt::WindowFullScreen));
|
|
|
|
move(restoredFrameGeometry.topLeft() + offset);
|
|
|
|
resize(restoredNormalGeometry.size());
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
return true;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/*!\fn void QWidget::setGeometry(int x, int y, int w, int h)
|
|
|
|
\overload
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
This corresponds to setGeometry(QRect(\a x, \a y, \a w, \a h)).
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/*!
|
|
|
|
Sets the margins around the contents of the widget to have the sizes
|
|
|
|
\a left, \a top, \a right, and \a bottom. The margins are used by
|
|
|
|
the layout system, and may be used by subclasses to specify the area
|
|
|
|
to draw in (e.g. excluding the frame).
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Changing the margins will trigger a resizeEvent().
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
\sa contentsRect(), getContentsMargins()
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
void QWidget::setContentsMargins(int left, int top, int right, int bottom)
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
Q_D(QWidget);
|
|
|
|
if (left == d->leftmargin && top == d->topmargin
|
|
|
|
&& right == d->rightmargin && bottom == d->bottommargin)
|
|
|
|
return;
|
|
|
|
d->leftmargin = left;
|
|
|
|
d->topmargin = top;
|
|
|
|
d->rightmargin = right;
|
|
|
|
d->bottommargin = bottom;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
if (QLayout *l=d->layout)
|
|
|
|
l->update(); //force activate; will do updateGeometry
|
|
|
|
else
|
|
|
|
updateGeometry();
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
// ### Qt 5: compat, remove
|
|
|
|
if (isVisible()) {
|
|
|
|
update();
|
|
|
|
QResizeEvent e(data->crect.size(), data->crect.size());
|
|
|
|
QApplication::sendEvent(this, &e);
|
|
|
|
} else {
|
|
|
|
setAttribute(Qt::WA_PendingResizeEvent, true);
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
QEvent e(QEvent::ContentsRectChange);
|
|
|
|
QApplication::sendEvent(this, &e);
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/*!
|
|
|
|
\overload
|
|
|
|
\since 4.6
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
\brief The setContentsMargins function sets the margins around the
|
|
|
|
widget's contents.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Sets the margins around the contents of the widget to have the
|
|
|
|
sizes determined by \a margins. The margins are
|
|
|
|
used by the layout system, and may be used by subclasses to
|
|
|
|
specify the area to draw in (e.g. excluding the frame).
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Changing the margins will trigger a resizeEvent().
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
\sa contentsRect(), getContentsMargins()
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
void QWidget::setContentsMargins(const QMargins &margins)
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
setContentsMargins(margins.left(), margins.top(),
|
|
|
|
margins.right(), margins.bottom());
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/*!
|
|
|
|
Returns the widget's contents margins for \a left, \a top, \a
|
|
|
|
right, and \a bottom.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
\sa setContentsMargins(), contentsRect()
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
void QWidget::getContentsMargins(int *left, int *top, int *right, int *bottom) const
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
Q_D(const QWidget);
|
|
|
|
if (left)
|
|
|
|
*left = d->leftmargin;
|
|
|
|
if (top)
|
|
|
|
*top = d->topmargin;
|
|
|
|
if (right)
|
|
|
|
*right = d->rightmargin;
|
|
|
|
if (bottom)
|
|
|
|
*bottom = d->bottommargin;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/*!
|
|
|
|
\since 4.6
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
\brief The contentsMargins function returns the widget's contents margins.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
\sa getContentsMargins(), setContentsMargins(), contentsRect()
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
QMargins QWidget::contentsMargins() const
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
Q_D(const QWidget);
|
|
|
|
return QMargins(d->leftmargin, d->topmargin, d->rightmargin, d->bottommargin);
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/*!
|
|
|
|
Returns the area inside the widget's margins.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
\sa setContentsMargins(), getContentsMargins()
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
QRect QWidget::contentsRect() const
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
Q_D(const QWidget);
|
|
|
|
return QRect(QPoint(d->leftmargin, d->topmargin),
|
|
|
|
QPoint(data->crect.width() - 1 - d->rightmargin,
|
|
|
|
data->crect.height() - 1 - d->bottommargin));
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/*!
|
|
|
|
\fn void QWidget::customContextMenuRequested(const QPoint &pos)
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
This signal is emitted when the widget's \l contextMenuPolicy is
|
|
|
|
Qt::CustomContextMenu, and the user has requested a context menu on
|
|
|
|
the widget. The position \a pos is the position of the context menu
|
|
|
|
event that the widget receives. Normally this is in widget
|
|
|
|
coordinates. The exception to this rule is QAbstractScrollArea and
|
|
|
|
its subclasses that map the context menu event to coordinates of the
|
|
|
|
\link QAbstractScrollArea::viewport() viewport() \endlink .
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
\sa mapToGlobal() QMenu contextMenuPolicy
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/*!
|
|
|
|
\property QWidget::contextMenuPolicy
|
|
|
|
\brief how the widget shows a context menu
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
The default value of this property is Qt::DefaultContextMenu,
|
|
|
|
which means the contextMenuEvent() handler is called. Other values
|
|
|
|
are Qt::NoContextMenu, Qt::PreventContextMenu,
|
|
|
|
Qt::ActionsContextMenu, and Qt::CustomContextMenu. With
|
|
|
|
Qt::CustomContextMenu, the signal customContextMenuRequested() is
|
|
|
|
emitted.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
\sa contextMenuEvent(), customContextMenuRequested(), actions()
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Qt::ContextMenuPolicy QWidget::contextMenuPolicy() const
|
|
|
|
{
|
2016-07-21 13:50:52 +00:00
|
|
|
return data->context_menu_policy;
|
2015-12-10 05:06:13 +02:00
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
void QWidget::setContextMenuPolicy(Qt::ContextMenuPolicy policy)
|
|
|
|
{
|
2016-07-21 13:50:52 +00:00
|
|
|
data->context_menu_policy = policy;
|
2015-12-10 05:06:13 +02:00
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/*!
|
|
|
|
\property QWidget::focusPolicy
|
|
|
|
\brief the way the widget accepts keyboard focus
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
The policy is Qt::TabFocus if the widget accepts keyboard
|
|
|
|
focus by tabbing, Qt::ClickFocus if the widget accepts
|
|
|
|
focus by clicking, Qt::StrongFocus if it accepts both, and
|
|
|
|
Qt::NoFocus (the default) if it does not accept focus at
|
|
|
|
all.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
You must enable keyboard focus for a widget if it processes
|
|
|
|
keyboard events. This is normally done from the widget's
|
|
|
|
constructor. For instance, the QLineEdit constructor calls
|
|
|
|
setFocusPolicy(Qt::StrongFocus).
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
If the widget has a focus proxy, then the focus policy will
|
|
|
|
be propagated to it.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
\sa focusInEvent(), focusOutEvent(), keyPressEvent(), keyReleaseEvent(), enabled
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Qt::FocusPolicy QWidget::focusPolicy() const
|
|
|
|
{
|
2016-07-21 13:50:52 +00:00
|
|
|
return data->focus_policy;
|
2015-12-10 05:06:13 +02:00
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
void QWidget::setFocusPolicy(Qt::FocusPolicy policy)
|
|
|
|
{
|
2016-07-21 13:50:52 +00:00
|
|
|
data->focus_policy = policy;
|
2015-12-10 05:06:13 +02:00
|
|
|
Q_D(QWidget);
|
|
|
|
if (d->extra && d->extra->focus_proxy)
|
|
|
|
d->extra->focus_proxy->setFocusPolicy(policy);
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/*!
|
|
|
|
\property QWidget::updatesEnabled
|
|
|
|
\brief whether updates are enabled
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
An updates enabled widget receives paint events and has a system
|
|
|
|
background; a disabled widget does not. This also implies that
|
|
|
|
calling update() and repaint() has no effect if updates are
|
|
|
|
disabled.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
By default, this property is true.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
setUpdatesEnabled() is normally used to disable updates for a
|
|
|
|
short period of time, for instance to avoid screen flicker during
|
|
|
|
large changes. In Qt, widgets normally do not generate screen
|
|
|
|
flicker, but on X11 the server might erase regions on the screen
|
|
|
|
when widgets get hidden before they can be replaced by other
|
|
|
|
widgets. Disabling updates solves this.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Example:
|
|
|
|
\snippet doc/src/snippets/code/src_gui_kernel_qwidget.cpp 13
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Disabling a widget implicitly disables all its children. Enabling a widget
|
|
|
|
enables all child widgets \e except top-level widgets or those that
|
|
|
|
have been explicitly disabled. Re-enabling updates implicitly calls
|
|
|
|
update() on the widget.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
\sa paintEvent()
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
void QWidget::setUpdatesEnabled(bool enable)
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
Q_D(QWidget);
|
|
|
|
setAttribute(Qt::WA_ForceUpdatesDisabled, !enable);
|
|
|
|
d->setUpdatesEnabled_helper(enable);
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/*! \fn void QWidget::show()
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Shows the widget and its child widgets. This function is
|
|
|
|
equivalent to setVisible(true).
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
\sa raise(), showEvent(), hide(), setVisible(), showMinimized(), showMaximized(),
|
|
|
|
showNormal(), isVisible()
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/*! \internal
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Makes the widget visible in the isVisible() meaning of the word.
|
|
|
|
It is only called for toplevels or widgets with visible parents.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
void QWidgetPrivate::show_recursive()
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
Q_Q(QWidget);
|
|
|
|
// polish if necessary
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
if (!q->testAttribute(Qt::WA_WState_Created))
|
|
|
|
createRecursively();
|
|
|
|
q->ensurePolished();
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
if (!q->isWindow() && q->parentWidget()->d_func()->layout && !q->parentWidget()->data->in_show)
|
|
|
|
q->parentWidget()->d_func()->layout->activate();
|
|
|
|
// activate our layout before we and our children become visible
|
|
|
|
if (layout)
|
|
|
|
layout->activate();
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
show_helper();
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
void QWidgetPrivate::sendPendingMoveAndResizeEvents(bool recursive, bool disableUpdates)
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
Q_Q(QWidget);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
disableUpdates = disableUpdates && q->updatesEnabled();
|
|
|
|
if (disableUpdates)
|
|
|
|
q->setAttribute(Qt::WA_UpdatesDisabled);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
if (q->testAttribute(Qt::WA_PendingMoveEvent)) {
|
|
|
|
QMoveEvent e(data.crect.topLeft(), data.crect.topLeft());
|
|
|
|
QApplication::sendEvent(q, &e);
|
|
|
|
q->setAttribute(Qt::WA_PendingMoveEvent, false);
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
if (q->testAttribute(Qt::WA_PendingResizeEvent)) {
|
|
|
|
QResizeEvent e(data.crect.size(), QSize());
|
|
|
|
QApplication::sendEvent(q, &e);
|
|
|
|
q->setAttribute(Qt::WA_PendingResizeEvent, false);
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
if (disableUpdates)
|
|
|
|
q->setAttribute(Qt::WA_UpdatesDisabled, false);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
if (!recursive)
|
|
|
|
return;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
for (int i = 0; i < children.size(); ++i) {
|
|
|
|
if (QWidget *child = qobject_cast<QWidget *>(children.at(i)))
|
|
|
|
child->d_func()->sendPendingMoveAndResizeEvents(recursive, disableUpdates);
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
void QWidgetPrivate::activateChildLayoutsRecursively()
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
sendPendingMoveAndResizeEvents(false, true);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
for (int i = 0; i < children.size(); ++i) {
|
|
|
|
QWidget *child = qobject_cast<QWidget *>(children.at(i));
|
|
|
|
if (!child || child->isHidden() || child->isWindow())
|
|
|
|
continue;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
child->ensurePolished();
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
// Activate child's layout
|
|
|
|
QWidgetPrivate *childPrivate = child->d_func();
|
|
|
|
if (childPrivate->layout)
|
|
|
|
childPrivate->layout->activate();
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
// Pretend we're visible.
|
|
|
|
const bool wasVisible = child->isVisible();
|
|
|
|
if (!wasVisible)
|
|
|
|
child->setAttribute(Qt::WA_WState_Visible);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
// Do the same for all my children.
|
|
|
|
childPrivate->activateChildLayoutsRecursively();
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
// We're not cheating anymore.
|
|
|
|
if (!wasVisible)
|
|
|
|
child->setAttribute(Qt::WA_WState_Visible, false);
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
void QWidgetPrivate::show_helper()
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
Q_Q(QWidget);
|
|
|
|
data.in_show = true; // qws optimization
|
|
|
|
// make sure we receive pending move and resize events
|
|
|
|
sendPendingMoveAndResizeEvents();
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
// become visible before showing all children
|
|
|
|
q->setAttribute(Qt::WA_WState_Visible);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
// finally show all children recursively
|
|
|
|
showChildren(false);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
// popup handling: new popups and tools need to be raised, and
|
|
|
|
// existing popups must be closed. Also propagate the current
|
|
|
|
// windows's KeyboardFocusChange status.
|
|
|
|
if (q->isWindow()) {
|
|
|
|
if ((q->windowType() == Qt::Tool) || (q->windowType() == Qt::Popup) || q->windowType() == Qt::ToolTip) {
|
|
|
|
q->raise();
|
|
|
|
if (q->parentWidget() && q->parentWidget()->window()->testAttribute(Qt::WA_KeyboardFocusChange))
|
|
|
|
q->setAttribute(Qt::WA_KeyboardFocusChange);
|
|
|
|
} else {
|
|
|
|
while (QApplication::activePopupWidget()) {
|
|
|
|
if (!QApplication::activePopupWidget()->close())
|
|
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
// Automatic embedding of child windows of widgets already embedded into
|
|
|
|
// QGraphicsProxyWidget when they are shown the first time.
|
|
|
|
bool isEmbedded = false;
|
|
|
|
#ifndef QT_NO_GRAPHICSVIEW
|
|
|
|
if (q->isWindow()) {
|
|
|
|
isEmbedded = q->graphicsProxyWidget() ? true : false;
|
|
|
|
if (!isEmbedded && !bypassGraphicsProxyWidget(q)) {
|
|
|
|
QGraphicsProxyWidget *ancestorProxy = nearestGraphicsProxyWidget(q->parentWidget());
|
|
|
|
if (ancestorProxy) {
|
|
|
|
isEmbedded = true;
|
|
|
|
ancestorProxy->d_func()->embedSubWindow(q);
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
#else
|
|
|
|
Q_UNUSED(isEmbedded);
|
|
|
|
#endif
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
// On Windows, show the popup now so that our own focus handling
|
|
|
|
// stores the correct old focus widget even if it's stolen in the
|
|
|
|
// showevent
|
|
|
|
#if defined(Q_WS_WIN) || defined(Q_WS_MAC)
|
|
|
|
if (!isEmbedded && q->windowType() == Qt::Popup)
|
|
|
|
qApp->d_func()->openPopup(q);
|
|
|
|
#endif
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
// send the show event before showing the window
|
|
|
|
QShowEvent showEvent;
|
|
|
|
QApplication::sendEvent(q, &showEvent);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
if (!isEmbedded && q->isModal() && q->isWindow())
|
|
|
|
// QApplicationPrivate::enterModal *before* show, otherwise the initial
|
|
|
|
// stacking might be wrong
|
|
|
|
QApplicationPrivate::enterModal(q);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
show_sys();
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
#if !defined(Q_WS_WIN) && !defined(Q_WS_MAC)
|
|
|
|
if (!isEmbedded && q->windowType() == Qt::Popup)
|
|
|
|
qApp->d_func()->openPopup(q);
|
|
|
|
#endif
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
#ifndef QT_NO_ACCESSIBILITY
|
|
|
|
if (q->windowType() != Qt::ToolTip) // Tooltips are read aloud twice in MS narrator.
|
|
|
|
QAccessible::updateAccessibility(q, 0, QAccessible::ObjectShow);
|
|
|
|
#endif
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
if (QApplicationPrivate::hidden_focus_widget == q) {
|
|
|
|
QApplicationPrivate::hidden_focus_widget = 0;
|
|
|
|
q->setFocus(Qt::OtherFocusReason);
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
// Process events when showing a Qt::SplashScreen widget before the event loop
|
|
|
|
// is spinnning; otherwise it might not show up on particular platforms.
|
|
|
|
// This makes QSplashScreen behave the same on all platforms.
|
|
|
|
if (!qApp->d_func()->in_exec && q->windowType() == Qt::SplashScreen)
|
|
|
|
QApplication::processEvents();
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
data.in_show = false; // reset qws optimization
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/*! \fn void QWidget::hide()
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Hides the widget. This function is equivalent to
|
|
|
|
setVisible(false).
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
\note If you are working with QDialog or its subclasses and you invoke
|
|
|
|
the show() function after this function, the dialog will be displayed in
|
|
|
|
its original position.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
\sa hideEvent(), isHidden(), show(), setVisible(), isVisible(), close()
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/*!\internal
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
void QWidgetPrivate::hide_helper()
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
Q_Q(QWidget);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
bool isEmbedded = false;
|
|
|
|
#if !defined QT_NO_GRAPHICSVIEW
|
|
|
|
isEmbedded = q->isWindow() && !bypassGraphicsProxyWidget(q) && nearestGraphicsProxyWidget(q->parentWidget()) != 0;
|
|
|
|
#else
|
|
|
|
Q_UNUSED(isEmbedded);
|
|
|
|
#endif
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
if (!isEmbedded && (q->windowType() == Qt::Popup))
|
|
|
|
qApp->d_func()->closePopup(q);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
// Move test modal here. Otherwise, a modal dialog could get
|
|
|
|
// destroyed and we lose all access to its parent because we haven't
|
|
|
|
// left modality. (Eg. modal Progress Dialog)
|
|
|
|
if (!isEmbedded && q->isModal() && q->isWindow())
|
|
|
|
QApplicationPrivate::leaveModal(q);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
#if defined(Q_WS_WIN)
|
|
|
|
if (q->isWindow() && !(q->windowType() == Qt::Popup) && q->parentWidget()
|
|
|
|
&& !q->parentWidget()->isHidden() && q->isActiveWindow())
|
|
|
|
q->parentWidget()->activateWindow(); // Activate parent
|
|
|
|
#endif
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
q->setAttribute(Qt::WA_Mapped, false);
|
|
|
|
hide_sys();
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
bool wasVisible = q->testAttribute(Qt::WA_WState_Visible);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
if (wasVisible) {
|
|
|
|
q->setAttribute(Qt::WA_WState_Visible, false);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
QHideEvent hideEvent;
|
|
|
|
QApplication::sendEvent(q, &hideEvent);
|
|
|
|
hideChildren(false);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
// next bit tries to move the focus if the focus widget is now
|
|
|
|
// hidden.
|
|
|
|
if (wasVisible) {
|
2016-06-21 13:21:19 +00:00
|
|
|
#if defined(Q_WS_WIN) || defined(Q_WS_X11) || defined(Q_WS_MAC)
|
2015-12-10 05:06:13 +02:00
|
|
|
qApp->d_func()->sendSyntheticEnterLeave(q);
|
|
|
|
#endif
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
QWidget *fw = QApplication::focusWidget();
|
|
|
|
while (fw && !fw->isWindow()) {
|
|
|
|
if (fw == q) {
|
|
|
|
q->focusNextPrevChild(true);
|
|
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
fw = fw->parentWidget();
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
if (QWidgetBackingStore *bs = maybeBackingStore())
|
|
|
|
bs->removeDirtyWidget(q);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
#ifndef QT_NO_ACCESSIBILITY
|
|
|
|
if (wasVisible)
|
|
|
|
QAccessible::updateAccessibility(q, 0, QAccessible::ObjectHide);
|
|
|
|
#endif
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/*!
|
|
|
|
\fn bool QWidget::isHidden() const
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Returns true if the widget is hidden, otherwise returns false.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
A hidden widget will only become visible when show() is called on
|
|
|
|
it. It will not be automatically shown when the parent is shown.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
To check visibility, use !isVisible() instead (notice the exclamation mark).
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
isHidden() implies !isVisible(), but a widget can be not visible
|
|
|
|
and not hidden at the same time. This is the case for widgets that are children of
|
|
|
|
widgets that are not visible.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Widgets are hidden if:
|
|
|
|
\list
|
|
|
|
\o they were created as independent windows,
|
|
|
|
\o they were created as children of visible widgets,
|
|
|
|
\o hide() or setVisible(false) was called.
|
|
|
|
\endlist
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
void QWidget::setVisible(bool visible)
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
if (visible) { // show
|
|
|
|
if (testAttribute(Qt::WA_WState_ExplicitShowHide) && !testAttribute(Qt::WA_WState_Hidden))
|
|
|
|
return;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Q_D(QWidget);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
// Designer uses a trick to make grabWidget work without showing
|
|
|
|
if (!isWindow() && parentWidget() && parentWidget()->isVisible()
|
|
|
|
&& !parentWidget()->testAttribute(Qt::WA_WState_Created))
|
|
|
|
parentWidget()->window()->d_func()->createRecursively();
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
//we have to at least create toplevels before applyX11SpecificCommandLineArguments
|
|
|
|
//but not children of non-visible parents
|
|
|
|
QWidget *pw = parentWidget();
|
|
|
|
if (!testAttribute(Qt::WA_WState_Created)
|
|
|
|
&& (isWindow() || pw->testAttribute(Qt::WA_WState_Created))) {
|
|
|
|
create();
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
#if defined(Q_WS_X11)
|
|
|
|
if (windowType() == Qt::Window)
|
|
|
|
QApplicationPrivate::applyX11SpecificCommandLineArguments(this);
|
|
|
|
#endif
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
bool wasResized = testAttribute(Qt::WA_Resized);
|
|
|
|
Qt::WindowStates initialWindowState = windowState();
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
// polish if necessary
|
|
|
|
ensurePolished();
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
// remember that show was called explicitly
|
|
|
|
setAttribute(Qt::WA_WState_ExplicitShowHide);
|
|
|
|
// whether we need to inform the parent widget immediately
|
|
|
|
bool needUpdateGeometry = !isWindow() && testAttribute(Qt::WA_WState_Hidden);
|
|
|
|
// we are no longer hidden
|
|
|
|
setAttribute(Qt::WA_WState_Hidden, false);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
if (needUpdateGeometry)
|
|
|
|
d->updateGeometry_helper(true);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
// activate our layout before we and our children become visible
|
|
|
|
if (d->layout)
|
|
|
|
d->layout->activate();
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
if (!isWindow()) {
|
|
|
|
QWidget *parent = parentWidget();
|
|
|
|
while (parent && parent->isVisible() && parent->d_func()->layout && !parent->data->in_show) {
|
|
|
|
parent->d_func()->layout->activate();
|
|
|
|
if (parent->isWindow())
|
|
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
parent = parent->parentWidget();
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if (parent)
|
|
|
|
parent->d_func()->setDirtyOpaqueRegion();
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
// adjust size if necessary
|
|
|
|
if (!wasResized
|
|
|
|
&& (isWindow() || !parentWidget()->d_func()->layout)) {
|
|
|
|
if (isWindow()) {
|
|
|
|
adjustSize();
|
|
|
|
if (windowState() != initialWindowState)
|
|
|
|
setWindowState(initialWindowState);
|
|
|
|
} else {
|
|
|
|
adjustSize();
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
setAttribute(Qt::WA_Resized, false);
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
setAttribute(Qt::WA_KeyboardFocusChange, false);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
if (isWindow() || parentWidget()->isVisible()) {
|
|
|
|
// remove posted quit events when showing a new window
|
|
|
|
QCoreApplication::removePostedEvents(qApp, QEvent::Quit);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
d->show_helper();
|
|
|
|
|
2016-06-21 13:21:19 +00:00
|
|
|
#if defined(Q_WS_WIN) || defined(Q_WS_X11) || defined(Q_WS_MAC)
|
2015-12-10 05:06:13 +02:00
|
|
|
qApp->d_func()->sendSyntheticEnterLeave(this);
|
|
|
|
#endif
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
QEvent showToParentEvent(QEvent::ShowToParent);
|
|
|
|
QApplication::sendEvent(this, &showToParentEvent);
|
|
|
|
} else { // hide
|
|
|
|
if (testAttribute(Qt::WA_WState_ExplicitShowHide) && testAttribute(Qt::WA_WState_Hidden))
|
|
|
|
return;
|
|
|
|
#if defined(Q_WS_WIN)
|
|
|
|
// reset WS_DISABLED style in a Blocked window
|
|
|
|
if(isWindow() && testAttribute(Qt::WA_WState_Created)
|
|
|
|
&& QApplicationPrivate::isBlockedByModal(this))
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
LONG dwStyle = GetWindowLong(winId(), GWL_STYLE);
|
|
|
|
dwStyle &= ~WS_DISABLED;
|
|
|
|
SetWindowLong(winId(), GWL_STYLE, dwStyle);
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
#endif
|
|
|
|
if (QApplicationPrivate::hidden_focus_widget == this)
|
|
|
|
QApplicationPrivate::hidden_focus_widget = 0;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Q_D(QWidget);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
// hw: The test on getOpaqueRegion() needs to be more intelligent
|
|
|
|
// currently it doesn't work if the widget is hidden (the region will
|
|
|
|
// be clipped). The real check should be testing the cached region
|
|
|
|
// (and dirty flag) directly.
|
|
|
|
if (!isWindow() && parentWidget()) // && !d->getOpaqueRegion().isEmpty())
|
|
|
|
parentWidget()->d_func()->setDirtyOpaqueRegion();
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
setAttribute(Qt::WA_WState_Hidden);
|
|
|
|
setAttribute(Qt::WA_WState_ExplicitShowHide);
|
|
|
|
if (testAttribute(Qt::WA_WState_Created))
|
|
|
|
d->hide_helper();
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
// invalidate layout similar to updateGeometry()
|
|
|
|
if (!isWindow() && parentWidget()) {
|
|
|
|
if (parentWidget()->d_func()->layout)
|
|
|
|
parentWidget()->d_func()->layout->invalidate();
|
|
|
|
else if (parentWidget()->isVisible())
|
|
|
|
QApplication::postEvent(parentWidget(), new QEvent(QEvent::LayoutRequest));
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
QEvent hideToParentEvent(QEvent::HideToParent);
|
|
|
|
QApplication::sendEvent(this, &hideToParentEvent);
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/*!\fn void QWidget::setHidden(bool hidden)
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Convenience function, equivalent to setVisible(!\a hidden).
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
void QWidgetPrivate::_q_showIfNotHidden()
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
Q_Q(QWidget);
|
|
|
|
if ( !(q->isHidden() && q->testAttribute(Qt::WA_WState_ExplicitShowHide)) )
|
|
|
|
q->setVisible(true);
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
void QWidgetPrivate::showChildren(bool spontaneous)
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
QList<QObject*> childList = children;
|
|
|
|
for (int i = 0; i < childList.size(); ++i) {
|
|
|
|
QWidget *widget = qobject_cast<QWidget*>(childList.at(i));
|
|
|
|
if (!widget
|
|
|
|
|| widget->isWindow()
|
|
|
|
|| widget->testAttribute(Qt::WA_WState_Hidden))
|
|
|
|
continue;
|
|
|
|
if (spontaneous) {
|
|
|
|
widget->setAttribute(Qt::WA_Mapped);
|
|
|
|
widget->d_func()->showChildren(true);
|
|
|
|
QShowEvent e;
|
|
|
|
QApplication::sendSpontaneousEvent(widget, &e);
|
|
|
|
} else {
|
|
|
|
if (widget->testAttribute(Qt::WA_WState_ExplicitShowHide))
|
|
|
|
widget->d_func()->show_recursive();
|
|
|
|
else
|
|
|
|
widget->show();
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
void QWidgetPrivate::hideChildren(bool spontaneous)
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
QList<QObject*> childList = children;
|
|
|
|
for (int i = 0; i < childList.size(); ++i) {
|
|
|
|
QWidget *widget = qobject_cast<QWidget*>(childList.at(i));
|
|
|
|
if (!widget || widget->isWindow() || widget->testAttribute(Qt::WA_WState_Hidden))
|
|
|
|
continue;
|
|
|
|
#ifdef QT_MAC_USE_COCOA
|
|
|
|
// Before doing anything we need to make sure that we don't leave anything in a non-consistent state.
|
|
|
|
// When hiding a widget we need to make sure that no mouse_down events are active, because
|
|
|
|
// the mouse_up event will never be received by a hidden widget or one of its descendants.
|
|
|
|
// The solution is simple, before going through with this we check if there are any mouse_down events in
|
|
|
|
// progress, if so we check if it is related to this widget or not. If so, we just reset the mouse_down and
|
|
|
|
// then we continue.
|
|
|
|
// In X11 and Windows we send a mouse_release event, however we don't do that here because we were already
|
|
|
|
// ignoring that from before. I.e. Carbon did not send the mouse release event, so we will not send the
|
|
|
|
// mouse release event. There are two ways to interpret this:
|
|
|
|
// 1. If we don't send the mouse release event, the widget might get into an inconsistent state, i.e. it
|
|
|
|
// might be waiting for a release event that will never arrive.
|
|
|
|
// 2. If we send the mouse release event, then the widget might decide to trigger an action that is not
|
|
|
|
// supposed to trigger because it is not visible.
|
|
|
|
if(widget == qt_button_down)
|
|
|
|
qt_button_down = 0;
|
|
|
|
#endif // QT_MAC_USE_COCOA
|
|
|
|
if (spontaneous)
|
|
|
|
widget->setAttribute(Qt::WA_Mapped, false);
|
|
|
|
else
|
|
|
|
widget->setAttribute(Qt::WA_WState_Visible, false);
|
|
|
|
widget->d_func()->hideChildren(spontaneous);
|
|
|
|
QHideEvent e;
|
|
|
|
if (spontaneous) {
|
|
|
|
QApplication::sendSpontaneousEvent(widget, &e);
|
|
|
|
} else {
|
|
|
|
QApplication::sendEvent(widget, &e);
|
|
|
|
if (widget->internalWinId()
|
|
|
|
&& widget->testAttribute(Qt::WA_DontCreateNativeAncestors)) {
|
|
|
|
// hide_sys() on an ancestor won't have any affect on this
|
|
|
|
// widget, so it needs an explicit hide_sys() of its own
|
|
|
|
widget->d_func()->hide_sys();
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
}
|
2016-06-21 13:21:19 +00:00
|
|
|
#if defined(Q_WS_WIN) || defined(Q_WS_X11) || defined(Q_WS_MAC)
|
2015-12-10 05:06:13 +02:00
|
|
|
qApp->d_func()->sendSyntheticEnterLeave(widget);
|
|
|
|
#endif
|
|
|
|
#ifndef QT_NO_ACCESSIBILITY
|
|
|
|
if (!spontaneous)
|
|
|
|
QAccessible::updateAccessibility(widget, 0, QAccessible::ObjectHide);
|
|
|
|
#endif
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
bool QWidgetPrivate::close_helper(CloseMode mode)
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
if (data.is_closing)
|
|
|
|
return true;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Q_Q(QWidget);
|
|
|
|
data.is_closing = 1;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
QPointer<QWidget> that = q;
|
|
|
|
QPointer<QWidget> parentWidget = q->parentWidget();
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
bool quitOnClose = q->testAttribute(Qt::WA_QuitOnClose);
|
|
|
|
if (mode != CloseNoEvent) {
|
|
|
|
QCloseEvent e;
|
|
|
|
if (mode == CloseWithSpontaneousEvent)
|
|
|
|
QApplication::sendSpontaneousEvent(q, &e);
|
|
|
|
else
|
|
|
|
QApplication::sendEvent(q, &e);
|
|
|
|
if (!that.isNull() && !e.isAccepted()) {
|
|
|
|
data.is_closing = 0;
|
|
|
|
return false;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
if (!that.isNull() && !q->isHidden())
|
|
|
|
q->hide();
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
// Attempt to close the application only if this has WA_QuitOnClose set and a non-visible parent
|
|
|
|
quitOnClose = quitOnClose && (parentWidget.isNull() || !parentWidget->isVisible());
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
if (quitOnClose) {
|
|
|
|
/* if there is no non-withdrawn primary window left (except
|
|
|
|
the ones without QuitOnClose), we emit the lastWindowClosed
|
|
|
|
signal */
|
|
|
|
QWidgetList list = QApplication::topLevelWidgets();
|
|
|
|
bool lastWindowClosed = true;
|
|
|
|
for (int i = 0; i < list.size(); ++i) {
|
|
|
|
QWidget *w = list.at(i);
|
|
|
|
if (!w->isVisible() || w->parentWidget() || !w->testAttribute(Qt::WA_QuitOnClose))
|
|
|
|
continue;
|
|
|
|
lastWindowClosed = false;
|
|
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if (lastWindowClosed)
|
|
|
|
QApplicationPrivate::emitLastWindowClosed();
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
if (!that.isNull()) {
|
|
|
|
data.is_closing = 0;
|
|
|
|
if (q->testAttribute(Qt::WA_DeleteOnClose)) {
|
|
|
|
q->setAttribute(Qt::WA_DeleteOnClose, false);
|
|
|
|
q->deleteLater();
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
return true;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/*!
|
|
|
|
Closes this widget. Returns true if the widget was closed;
|
|
|
|
otherwise returns false.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
First it sends the widget a QCloseEvent. The widget is \link
|
|
|
|
hide() hidden\endlink if it \link QCloseEvent::accept()
|
|
|
|
accepts\endlink the close event. If it \link QCloseEvent::ignore()
|
|
|
|
ignores\endlink the event, nothing happens. The default
|
|
|
|
implementation of QWidget::closeEvent() accepts the close event.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
If the widget has the Qt::WA_DeleteOnClose flag, the widget
|
|
|
|
is also deleted. A close events is delivered to the widget no
|
|
|
|
matter if the widget is visible or not.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
The \l QApplication::lastWindowClosed() signal is emitted when the
|
|
|
|
last visible primary window (i.e. window with no parent) with the
|
|
|
|
Qt::WA_QuitOnClose attribute set is closed. By default this
|
|
|
|
attribute is set for all widgets except transient windows such as
|
|
|
|
splash screens, tool windows, and popup menus.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
bool QWidget::close()
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
return d_func()->close_helper(QWidgetPrivate::CloseWithEvent);
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/*!
|
|
|
|
\property QWidget::visible
|
|
|
|
\brief whether the widget is visible
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Calling setVisible(true) or show() sets the widget to visible
|
|
|
|
status if all its parent widgets up to the window are visible. If
|
|
|
|
an ancestor is not visible, the widget won't become visible until
|
|
|
|
all its ancestors are shown. If its size or position has changed,
|
|
|
|
Qt guarantees that a widget gets move and resize events just
|
|
|
|
before it is shown. If the widget has not been resized yet, Qt
|
|
|
|
will adjust the widget's size to a useful default using
|
|
|
|
adjustSize().
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Calling setVisible(false) or hide() hides a widget explicitly. An
|
|
|
|
explicitly hidden widget will never become visible, even if all
|
|
|
|
its ancestors become visible, unless you show it.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
A widget receives show and hide events when its visibility status
|
|
|
|
changes. Between a hide and a show event, there is no need to
|
|
|
|
waste CPU cycles preparing or displaying information to the user.
|
|
|
|
A video application, for example, might simply stop generating new
|
|
|
|
frames.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
A widget that happens to be obscured by other windows on the
|
|
|
|
screen is considered to be visible. The same applies to iconified
|
|
|
|
windows and windows that exist on another virtual
|
|
|
|
desktop (on platforms that support this concept). A widget
|
|
|
|
receives spontaneous show and hide events when its mapping status
|
|
|
|
is changed by the window system, e.g. a spontaneous hide event
|
|
|
|
when the user minimizes the window, and a spontaneous show event
|
|
|
|
when the window is restored again.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
You almost never have to reimplement the setVisible() function. If
|
|
|
|
you need to change some settings before a widget is shown, use
|
|
|
|
showEvent() instead. If you need to do some delayed initialization
|
|
|
|
use the Polish event delivered to the event() function.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
\sa show(), hide(), isHidden(), isVisibleTo(), isMinimized(),
|
|
|
|
showEvent(), hideEvent()
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/*!
|
|
|
|
Returns true if this widget would become visible if \a ancestor is
|
|
|
|
shown; otherwise returns false.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
The true case occurs if neither the widget itself nor any parent
|
|
|
|
up to but excluding \a ancestor has been explicitly hidden.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
This function will still return true if the widget is obscured by
|
|
|
|
other windows on the screen, but could be physically visible if it
|
|
|
|
or they were to be moved.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
isVisibleTo(0) is identical to isVisible().
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
\sa show() hide() isVisible()
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
bool QWidget::isVisibleTo(QWidget* ancestor) const
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
if (!ancestor)
|
|
|
|
return isVisible();
|
|
|
|
const QWidget * w = this;
|
|
|
|
while (!w->isHidden()
|
|
|
|
&& !w->isWindow()
|
|
|
|
&& w->parentWidget()
|
|
|
|
&& w->parentWidget() != ancestor)
|
|
|
|
w = w->parentWidget();
|
|
|
|
return !w->isHidden();
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/*!
|
|
|
|
Returns the unobscured region where paint events can occur.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
For visible widgets, this is an approximation of the area not
|
|
|
|
covered by other widgets; otherwise, this is an empty region.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
The repaint() function calls this function if necessary, so in
|
|
|
|
general you do not need to call it.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
QRegion QWidget::visibleRegion() const
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
Q_D(const QWidget);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
QRect clipRect = d->clipRect();
|
|
|
|
if (clipRect.isEmpty())
|
|
|
|
return QRegion();
|
|
|
|
QRegion r(clipRect);
|
|
|
|
d->subtractOpaqueChildren(r, clipRect);
|
|
|
|
d->subtractOpaqueSiblings(r);
|
|
|
|
return r;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
QSize QWidgetPrivate::adjustedSize() const
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
Q_Q(const QWidget);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
QSize s = q->sizeHint();
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
if (q->isWindow()) {
|
|
|
|
Qt::Orientations exp;
|
|
|
|
if (layout) {
|
|
|
|
if (layout->hasHeightForWidth())
|
|
|
|
s.setHeight(layout->totalHeightForWidth(s.width()));
|
|
|
|
exp = layout->expandingDirections();
|
|
|
|
} else
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
if (q->sizePolicy().hasHeightForWidth())
|
|
|
|
s.setHeight(q->heightForWidth(s.width()));
|
|
|
|
exp = q->sizePolicy().expandingDirections();
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if (exp & Qt::Horizontal)
|
|
|
|
s.setWidth(qMax(s.width(), 200));
|
|
|
|
if (exp & Qt::Vertical)
|
|
|
|
s.setHeight(qMax(s.height(), 100));
|
|
|
|
#if defined(Q_WS_X11)
|
|
|
|
QRect screen = QApplication::desktop()->screenGeometry(q->x11Info().screen());
|
|
|
|
#else // all others
|
|
|
|
QRect screen = QApplication::desktop()->screenGeometry(q->pos());
|
|
|
|
#endif
|
|
|
|
#if defined (Q_WS_WINCE)
|
|
|
|
s.setWidth(qMin(s.width(), screen.width()));
|
|
|
|
s.setHeight(qMin(s.height(), screen.height()));
|
|
|
|
#else
|
|
|
|
s.setWidth(qMin(s.width(), screen.width()*2/3));
|
|
|
|
s.setHeight(qMin(s.height(), screen.height()*2/3));
|
|
|
|
#endif
|
|
|
|
if (QTLWExtra *extra = maybeTopData())
|
|
|
|
extra->sizeAdjusted = true;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
if (!s.isValid()) {
|
|
|
|
QRect r = q->childrenRect(); // get children rectangle
|
|
|
|
if (r.isNull())
|
|
|
|
return s;
|
|
|
|
s = r.size() + QSize(2 * r.x(), 2 * r.y());
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
return s;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/*!
|
|
|
|
Adjusts the size of the widget to fit its contents.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
This function uses sizeHint() if it is valid, i.e., the size hint's width
|
|
|
|
and height are \>= 0. Otherwise, it sets the size to the children
|
|
|
|
rectangle that covers all child widgets (the union of all child widget
|
|
|
|
rectangles).
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
For windows, the screen size is also taken into account. If the sizeHint()
|
|
|
|
is less than (200, 100) and the size policy is \l{QSizePolicy::Expanding}
|
|
|
|
{expanding}, the window will be at least (200, 100). The maximum size of
|
|
|
|
a window is 2/3 of the screen's width and height.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
\sa sizeHint(), childrenRect()
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
void QWidget::adjustSize()
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
Q_D(QWidget);
|
|
|
|
ensurePolished();
|
|
|
|
QSize s = d->adjustedSize();
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
if (d->layout)
|
|
|
|
d->layout->activate();
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
if (s.isValid())
|
|
|
|
resize(s);
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/*!
|
|
|
|
\property QWidget::sizeHint
|
|
|
|
\brief the recommended size for the widget
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
If the value of this property is an invalid size, no size is
|
|
|
|
recommended.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
The default implementation of sizeHint() returns an invalid size
|
|
|
|
if there is no layout for this widget, and returns the layout's
|
|
|
|
preferred size otherwise.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
\sa QSize::isValid(), minimumSizeHint(), sizePolicy(),
|
|
|
|
setMinimumSize(), updateGeometry()
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
QSize QWidget::sizeHint() const
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
Q_D(const QWidget);
|
|
|
|
if (d->layout)
|
|
|
|
return d->layout->totalSizeHint();
|
|
|
|
return QSize(-1, -1);
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/*!
|
|
|
|
\property QWidget::minimumSizeHint
|
|
|
|
\brief the recommended minimum size for the widget
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
If the value of this property is an invalid size, no minimum size
|
|
|
|
is recommended.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
The default implementation of minimumSizeHint() returns an invalid
|
|
|
|
size if there is no layout for this widget, and returns the
|
|
|
|
layout's minimum size otherwise. Most built-in widgets reimplement
|
|
|
|
minimumSizeHint().
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
\l QLayout will never resize a widget to a size smaller than the
|
|
|
|
minimum size hint unless minimumSize() is set or the size policy is
|
|
|
|
set to QSizePolicy::Ignore. If minimumSize() is set, the minimum
|
|
|
|
size hint will be ignored.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
\sa QSize::isValid(), resize(), setMinimumSize(), sizePolicy()
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
QSize QWidget::minimumSizeHint() const
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
Q_D(const QWidget);
|
|
|
|
if (d->layout)
|
|
|
|
return d->layout->totalMinimumSize();
|
|
|
|
return QSize(-1, -1);
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/*!
|
|
|
|
\fn QWidget *QWidget::parentWidget() const
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Returns the parent of this widget, or 0 if it does not have any
|
|
|
|
parent widget.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/*!
|
|
|
|
Returns true if this widget is a parent, (or grandparent and so on
|
|
|
|
to any level), of the given \a child, and both widgets are within
|
|
|
|
the same window; otherwise returns false.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
bool QWidget::isAncestorOf(const QWidget *child) const
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
while (child) {
|
|
|
|
if (child == this)
|
|
|
|
return true;
|
|
|
|
if (child->isWindow())
|
|
|
|
return false;
|
|
|
|
child = child->parentWidget();
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
return false;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
#if defined(Q_WS_WIN)
|
|
|
|
inline void setDisabledStyle(QWidget *w, bool setStyle)
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
// set/reset WS_DISABLED style.
|
|
|
|
if(w && w->isWindow() && w->isVisible() && w->isEnabled()) {
|
|
|
|
LONG dwStyle = GetWindowLong(w->winId(), GWL_STYLE);
|
|
|
|
LONG newStyle = dwStyle;
|
|
|
|
if (setStyle)
|
|
|
|
newStyle |= WS_DISABLED;
|
|
|
|
else
|
|
|
|
newStyle &= ~WS_DISABLED;
|
|
|
|
if (newStyle != dwStyle) {
|
|
|
|
SetWindowLong(w->winId(), GWL_STYLE, newStyle);
|
|
|
|
// we might need to repaint in some situations (eg. menu)
|
|
|
|
w->repaint();
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
#endif
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/*****************************************************************************
|
|
|
|
QWidget event handling
|
|
|
|
*****************************************************************************/
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/*!
|
|
|
|
This is the main event handler; it handles event \a event. You can
|
|
|
|
reimplement this function in a subclass, but we recommend using
|
|
|
|
one of the specialized event handlers instead.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Key press and release events are treated differently from other
|
|
|
|
events. event() checks for Tab and Shift+Tab and tries to move the
|
|
|
|
focus appropriately. If there is no widget to move the focus to
|
|
|
|
(or the key press is not Tab or Shift+Tab), event() calls
|
|
|
|
keyPressEvent().
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Mouse and tablet event handling is also slightly special: only
|
|
|
|
when the widget is \l enabled, event() will call the specialized
|
|
|
|
handlers such as mousePressEvent(); otherwise it will discard the
|
|
|
|
event.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
This function returns true if the event was recognized, otherwise
|
|
|
|
it returns false. If the recognized event was accepted (see \l
|
|
|
|
QEvent::accepted), any further processing such as event
|
|
|
|
propagation to the parent widget stops.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
\sa closeEvent(), focusInEvent(), focusOutEvent(), enterEvent(),
|
|
|
|
keyPressEvent(), keyReleaseEvent(), leaveEvent(),
|
|
|
|
mouseDoubleClickEvent(), mouseMoveEvent(), mousePressEvent(),
|
|
|
|
mouseReleaseEvent(), moveEvent(), paintEvent(), resizeEvent(),
|
|
|
|
QObject::event(), QObject::timerEvent()
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
bool QWidget::event(QEvent *event)
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
Q_D(QWidget);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
// ignore mouse events when disabled
|
|
|
|
if (!isEnabled()) {
|
|
|
|
switch(event->type()) {
|
|
|
|
case QEvent::TabletPress:
|
|
|
|
case QEvent::TabletRelease:
|
|
|
|
case QEvent::TabletMove:
|
|
|
|
case QEvent::MouseButtonPress:
|
|
|
|
case QEvent::MouseButtonRelease:
|
|
|
|
case QEvent::MouseButtonDblClick:
|
|
|
|
case QEvent::MouseMove:
|
|
|
|
case QEvent::TouchBegin:
|
|
|
|
case QEvent::TouchUpdate:
|
|
|
|
case QEvent::TouchEnd:
|
|
|
|
case QEvent::ContextMenu:
|
|
|
|
#ifndef QT_NO_WHEELEVENT
|
|
|
|
case QEvent::Wheel:
|
|
|
|
#endif
|
|
|
|
return false;
|
|
|
|
default:
|
|
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
switch (event->type()) {
|
|
|
|
case QEvent::MouseMove:
|
|
|
|
mouseMoveEvent((QMouseEvent*)event);
|
|
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
case QEvent::MouseButtonPress:
|
|
|
|
// Don't reset input context here. Whether reset or not is
|
|
|
|
// a responsibility of input method. reset() will be
|
|
|
|
// called by mouseHandler() of input method if necessary
|
|
|
|
// via mousePressEvent() of text widgets.
|
|
|
|
#if 0
|
|
|
|
resetInputContext();
|
|
|
|
#endif
|
|
|
|
mousePressEvent((QMouseEvent*)event);
|
|
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
case QEvent::MouseButtonRelease:
|
|
|
|
mouseReleaseEvent((QMouseEvent*)event);
|
|
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
case QEvent::MouseButtonDblClick:
|
|
|
|
mouseDoubleClickEvent((QMouseEvent*)event);
|
|
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
case QEvent::NonClientAreaMouseButtonPress: {
|
|
|
|
QWidget* w;
|
|
|
|
while ((w = QApplication::activePopupWidget()) && w != this) {
|
|
|
|
w->close();
|
|
|
|
if (QApplication::activePopupWidget() == w) // widget does not want to disappear
|
|
|
|
w->hide(); // hide at least
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
#ifndef QT_NO_WHEELEVENT
|
|
|
|
case QEvent::Wheel:
|
|
|
|
wheelEvent((QWheelEvent*)event);
|
|
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
#endif
|
|
|
|
#ifndef QT_NO_TABLETEVENT
|
|
|
|
case QEvent::TabletMove:
|
|
|
|
case QEvent::TabletPress:
|
|
|
|
case QEvent::TabletRelease:
|
|
|
|
tabletEvent((QTabletEvent*)event);
|
|
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
#endif
|
|
|
|
case QEvent::KeyPress: {
|
|
|
|
QKeyEvent *k = (QKeyEvent *)event;
|
|
|
|
bool res = false;
|
|
|
|
if (!(k->modifiers() & (Qt::ControlModifier | Qt::AltModifier))) { //### Add MetaModifier?
|
|
|
|
if (k->key() == Qt::Key_Backtab
|
|
|
|
|| (k->key() == Qt::Key_Tab && (k->modifiers() & Qt::ShiftModifier)))
|
|
|
|
res = focusNextPrevChild(false);
|
|
|
|
else if (k->key() == Qt::Key_Tab)
|
|
|
|
res = focusNextPrevChild(true);
|
|
|
|
if (res)
|
|
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
keyPressEvent(k);
|
|
|
|
#ifdef QT_KEYPAD_NAVIGATION
|
|
|
|
if (!k->isAccepted() && QApplication::keypadNavigationEnabled()
|
|
|
|
&& !(k->modifiers() & (Qt::ControlModifier | Qt::AltModifier | Qt::ShiftModifier))) {
|
|
|
|
if (QApplication::navigationMode() == Qt::NavigationModeKeypadTabOrder) {
|
|
|
|
if (k->key() == Qt::Key_Up)
|
|
|
|
res = focusNextPrevChild(false);
|
|
|
|
else if (k->key() == Qt::Key_Down)
|
|
|
|
res = focusNextPrevChild(true);
|
|
|
|
} else if (QApplication::navigationMode() == Qt::NavigationModeKeypadDirectional) {
|
|
|
|
if (k->key() == Qt::Key_Up)
|
|
|
|
res = QWidgetPrivate::navigateToDirection(QWidgetPrivate::DirectionNorth);
|
|
|
|
else if (k->key() == Qt::Key_Right)
|
|
|
|
res = QWidgetPrivate::navigateToDirection(QWidgetPrivate::DirectionEast);
|
|
|
|
else if (k->key() == Qt::Key_Down)
|
|
|
|
res = QWidgetPrivate::navigateToDirection(QWidgetPrivate::DirectionSouth);
|
|
|
|
else if (k->key() == Qt::Key_Left)
|
|
|
|
res = QWidgetPrivate::navigateToDirection(QWidgetPrivate::DirectionWest);
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if (res) {
|
|
|
|
k->accept();
|
|
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
#endif
|
|
|
|
#ifndef QT_NO_WHATSTHIS
|
|
|
|
if (!k->isAccepted()
|
|
|
|
&& k->modifiers() & Qt::ShiftModifier && k->key() == Qt::Key_F1
|
|
|
|
&& d->whatsThis.size()) {
|
|
|
|
QWhatsThis::showText(mapToGlobal(inputMethodQuery(Qt::ImMicroFocus).toRect().center()), d->whatsThis, this);
|
|
|
|
k->accept();
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
#endif
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
case QEvent::KeyRelease:
|
|
|
|
keyReleaseEvent((QKeyEvent*)event);
|
|
|
|
// fall through
|
|
|
|
case QEvent::ShortcutOverride:
|
|
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
case QEvent::InputMethod:
|
|
|
|
inputMethodEvent((QInputMethodEvent *) event);
|
|
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
case QEvent::PolishRequest:
|
|
|
|
ensurePolished();
|
|
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
case QEvent::Polish: {
|
|
|
|
style()->polish(this);
|
|
|
|
setAttribute(Qt::WA_WState_Polished);
|
|
|
|
if (!QApplication::font(this).isCopyOf(QApplication::font()))
|
|
|
|
d->resolveFont();
|
|
|
|
if (!QApplication::palette(this).isCopyOf(QApplication::palette()))
|
|
|
|
d->resolvePalette();
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
case QEvent::ApplicationWindowIconChange:
|
|
|
|
if (isWindow() && !testAttribute(Qt::WA_SetWindowIcon)) {
|
|
|
|
d->setWindowIcon_sys();
|
|
|
|
d->setWindowIcon_helper();
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
case QEvent::FocusIn:
|
|
|
|
#ifdef QT_SOFTKEYS_ENABLED
|
|
|
|
QSoftKeyManager::updateSoftKeys();
|
|
|
|
#endif
|
|
|
|
focusInEvent((QFocusEvent*)event);
|
|
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
case QEvent::FocusOut:
|
|
|
|
focusOutEvent((QFocusEvent*)event);
|
|
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
case QEvent::Enter:
|
|
|
|
#ifndef QT_NO_STATUSTIP
|
|
|
|
if (d->statusTip.size()) {
|
|
|
|
QStatusTipEvent tip(d->statusTip);
|
|
|
|
QApplication::sendEvent(const_cast<QWidget *>(this), &tip);
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
#endif
|
|
|
|
enterEvent(event);
|
|
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
case QEvent::Leave:
|
|
|
|
#ifndef QT_NO_STATUSTIP
|
|
|
|
if (d->statusTip.size()) {
|
|
|
|
QString empty;
|
|
|
|
QStatusTipEvent tip(empty);
|
|
|
|
QApplication::sendEvent(const_cast<QWidget *>(this), &tip);
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
#endif
|
|
|
|
leaveEvent(event);
|
|
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
case QEvent::HoverEnter:
|
|
|
|
case QEvent::HoverLeave:
|
|
|
|
update();
|
|
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
case QEvent::Paint:
|
|
|
|
// At this point the event has to be delivered, regardless
|
|
|
|
// whether the widget isVisible() or not because it
|
|
|
|
// already went through the filters
|
|
|
|
paintEvent((QPaintEvent*)event);
|
|
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
case QEvent::Move:
|
|
|
|
moveEvent((QMoveEvent*)event);
|
|
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
case QEvent::Resize:
|
|
|
|
resizeEvent((QResizeEvent*)event);
|
|
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
case QEvent::Close:
|
|
|
|
closeEvent((QCloseEvent *)event);
|
|
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
#ifndef QT_NO_CONTEXTMENU
|
|
|
|
case QEvent::ContextMenu:
|
|
|
|
switch (data->context_menu_policy) {
|
|
|
|
case Qt::PreventContextMenu:
|
|
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
case Qt::DefaultContextMenu:
|
|
|
|
contextMenuEvent(static_cast<QContextMenuEvent *>(event));
|
|
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
case Qt::CustomContextMenu:
|
|
|
|
emit customContextMenuRequested(static_cast<QContextMenuEvent *>(event)->pos());
|
|
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
#ifndef QT_NO_MENU
|
|
|
|
case Qt::ActionsContextMenu:
|
|
|
|
if (d->actions.count()) {
|
|
|
|
QMenu::exec(d->actions, static_cast<QContextMenuEvent *>(event)->globalPos(),
|
|
|
|
0, this);
|
|
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// fall through
|
|
|
|
#endif
|
|
|
|
default:
|
|
|
|
event->ignore();
|
|
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
#endif // QT_NO_CONTEXTMENU
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
#ifndef QT_NO_DRAGANDDROP
|
|
|
|
case QEvent::Drop:
|
|
|
|
dropEvent((QDropEvent*) event);
|
|
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
case QEvent::DragEnter:
|
|
|
|
dragEnterEvent((QDragEnterEvent*) event);
|
|
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
case QEvent::DragMove:
|
|
|
|
dragMoveEvent((QDragMoveEvent*) event);
|
|
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
case QEvent::DragLeave:
|
|
|
|
dragLeaveEvent((QDragLeaveEvent*) event);
|
|
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
#endif
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
case QEvent::Show:
|
|
|
|
showEvent((QShowEvent*) event);
|
|
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
case QEvent::Hide:
|
|
|
|
hideEvent((QHideEvent*) event);
|
|
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
case QEvent::ShowWindowRequest:
|
|
|
|
if (!isHidden())
|
|
|
|
d->show_sys();
|
|
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
case QEvent::ApplicationFontChange:
|
|
|
|
d->resolveFont();
|
|
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
case QEvent::ApplicationPaletteChange:
|
|
|
|
if (!(windowType() == Qt::Desktop))
|
|
|
|
d->resolvePalette();
|
|
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
case QEvent::ToolBarChange:
|
|
|
|
case QEvent::ActivationChange:
|
|
|
|
case QEvent::EnabledChange:
|
|
|
|
case QEvent::FontChange:
|
|
|
|
case QEvent::StyleChange:
|
|
|
|
case QEvent::PaletteChange:
|
|
|
|
case QEvent::WindowTitleChange:
|
|
|
|
case QEvent::IconTextChange:
|
|
|
|
case QEvent::ModifiedChange:
|
|
|
|
case QEvent::MouseTrackingChange:
|
|
|
|
case QEvent::ParentChange:
|
|
|
|
case QEvent::WindowStateChange:
|
|
|
|
case QEvent::LocaleChange:
|
|
|
|
case QEvent::MacSizeChange:
|
|
|
|
case QEvent::ContentsRectChange:
|
|
|
|
changeEvent(event);
|
|
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
case QEvent::WindowActivate:
|
|
|
|
case QEvent::WindowDeactivate: {
|
|
|
|
if (isVisible() && !palette().isEqual(QPalette::Active, QPalette::Inactive))
|
|
|
|
update();
|
|
|
|
QList<QObject*> childList = d->children;
|
|
|
|
for (int i = 0; i < childList.size(); ++i) {
|
|
|
|
QWidget *w = qobject_cast<QWidget *>(childList.at(i));
|
|
|
|
if (w && w->isVisible() && !w->isWindow())
|
|
|
|
QApplication::sendEvent(w, event);
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
#ifdef QT_SOFTKEYS_ENABLED
|
|
|
|
if (isWindow())
|
|
|
|
QSoftKeyManager::updateSoftKeys();
|
|
|
|
#endif
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
break; }
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
case QEvent::LanguageChange:
|
|
|
|
changeEvent(event);
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
QList<QObject*> childList = d->children;
|
|
|
|
for (int i = 0; i < childList.size(); ++i) {
|
|
|
|
QObject *o = childList.at(i);
|
|
|
|
if (o)
|
|
|
|
QApplication::sendEvent(o, event);
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
update();
|
|
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
case QEvent::ApplicationLayoutDirectionChange:
|
|
|
|
d->resolveLayoutDirection();
|
|
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
case QEvent::LayoutDirectionChange:
|
|
|
|
if (d->layout)
|
|
|
|
d->layout->invalidate();
|
|
|
|
update();
|
|
|
|
changeEvent(event);
|
|
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
case QEvent::UpdateRequest:
|
|
|
|
d->syncBackingStore();
|
|
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
case QEvent::UpdateLater:
|
|
|
|
update(static_cast<QUpdateLaterEvent*>(event)->region());
|
|
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
case QEvent::WindowBlocked:
|
|
|
|
case QEvent::WindowUnblocked:
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
QList<QObject*> childList = d->children;
|
|
|
|
for (int i = 0; i < childList.size(); ++i) {
|
|
|
|
QObject *o = childList.at(i);
|
|
|
|
if (o && o != QApplication::activeModalWidget()) {
|
|
|
|
if (qobject_cast<QWidget *>(o) && static_cast<QWidget *>(o)->isWindow()) {
|
|
|
|
// do not forward the event to child windows,
|
|
|
|
// QApplication does this for us
|
|
|
|
continue;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
QApplication::sendEvent(o, event);
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
#if defined(Q_WS_WIN)
|
|
|
|
setDisabledStyle(this, (event->type() == QEvent::WindowBlocked));
|
|
|
|
#endif
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
#ifndef QT_NO_TOOLTIP
|
|
|
|
case QEvent::ToolTip:
|
|
|
|
if (!d->toolTip.isEmpty())
|
|
|
|
QToolTip::showText(static_cast<QHelpEvent*>(event)->globalPos(), d->toolTip, this);
|
|
|
|
else
|
|
|
|
event->ignore();
|
|
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
#endif
|
|
|
|
#ifndef QT_NO_WHATSTHIS
|
|
|
|
case QEvent::WhatsThis:
|
|
|
|
if (d->whatsThis.size())
|
|
|
|
QWhatsThis::showText(static_cast<QHelpEvent *>(event)->globalPos(), d->whatsThis, this);
|
|
|
|
else
|
|
|
|
event->ignore();
|
|
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
case QEvent::QueryWhatsThis:
|
|
|
|
if (d->whatsThis.isEmpty())
|
|
|
|
event->ignore();
|
|
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
#endif
|
|
|
|
#ifndef QT_NO_ACCESSIBILITY
|
|
|
|
case QEvent::AccessibilityDescription:
|
|
|
|
case QEvent::AccessibilityHelp: {
|
|
|
|
QAccessibleEvent *ev = static_cast<QAccessibleEvent *>(event);
|
|
|
|
if (ev->child())
|
|
|
|
return false;
|
|
|
|
switch (ev->type()) {
|
|
|
|
#ifndef QT_NO_TOOLTIP
|
|
|
|
case QEvent::AccessibilityDescription:
|
|
|
|
ev->setValue(d->toolTip);
|
|
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
#endif
|
|
|
|
#ifndef QT_NO_WHATSTHIS
|
|
|
|
case QEvent::AccessibilityHelp:
|
|
|
|
ev->setValue(d->whatsThis);
|
|
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
#endif
|
|
|
|
default:
|
|
|
|
return false;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
break; }
|
|
|
|
#endif
|
|
|
|
case QEvent::EmbeddingControl:
|
|
|
|
d->topData()->frameStrut.setCoords(0 ,0, 0, 0);
|
|
|
|
data->fstrut_dirty = false;
|
|
|
|
#if defined(Q_WS_WIN) || defined(Q_WS_X11)
|
|
|
|
d->topData()->embedded = 1;
|
|
|
|
#endif
|
|
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
#ifndef QT_NO_ACTION
|
|
|
|
case QEvent::ActionAdded:
|
|
|
|
case QEvent::ActionRemoved:
|
|
|
|
case QEvent::ActionChanged:
|
|
|
|
#ifdef QT_SOFTKEYS_ENABLED
|
|
|
|
QSoftKeyManager::updateSoftKeys();
|
|
|
|
#endif
|
|
|
|
actionEvent((QActionEvent*)event);
|
|
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
#endif
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
case QEvent::KeyboardLayoutChange:
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
changeEvent(event);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
// inform children of the change
|
|
|
|
QList<QObject*> childList = d->children;
|
|
|
|
for (int i = 0; i < childList.size(); ++i) {
|
|
|
|
QWidget *w = qobject_cast<QWidget *>(childList.at(i));
|
|
|
|
if (w && w->isVisible() && !w->isWindow())
|
|
|
|
QApplication::sendEvent(w, event);
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
#ifdef Q_WS_MAC
|
|
|
|
case QEvent::MacGLWindowChange:
|
|
|
|
d->needWindowChange = false;
|
|
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
#endif
|
|
|
|
case QEvent::TouchBegin:
|
|
|
|
case QEvent::TouchUpdate:
|
|
|
|
case QEvent::TouchEnd:
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
#ifndef Q_WS_MAC
|
|
|
|
QTouchEvent *touchEvent = static_cast<QTouchEvent *>(event);
|
|
|
|
const QTouchEvent::TouchPoint &touchPoint = touchEvent->touchPoints().first();
|
|
|
|
if (touchPoint.isPrimary() || touchEvent->deviceType() == QTouchEvent::TouchPad)
|
|
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
// fake a mouse event!
|
|
|
|
QEvent::Type eventType = QEvent::None;
|
|
|
|
switch (touchEvent->type()) {
|
|
|
|
case QEvent::TouchBegin:
|
|
|
|
eventType = QEvent::MouseButtonPress;
|
|
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
case QEvent::TouchUpdate:
|
|
|
|
eventType = QEvent::MouseMove;
|
|
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
case QEvent::TouchEnd:
|
|
|
|
eventType = QEvent::MouseButtonRelease;
|
|
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
default:
|
|
|
|
Q_ASSERT(!true);
|
|
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if (eventType == QEvent::None)
|
|
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
QMouseEvent mouseEvent(eventType,
|
|
|
|
touchPoint.pos().toPoint(),
|
|
|
|
touchPoint.screenPos().toPoint(),
|
|
|
|
Qt::LeftButton,
|
|
|
|
Qt::LeftButton,
|
|
|
|
touchEvent->modifiers());
|
|
|
|
(void) QApplication::sendEvent(this, &mouseEvent);
|
|
|
|
#endif // Q_WS_MAC
|
|
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
#ifndef QT_NO_GESTURES
|
|
|
|
case QEvent::Gesture:
|
|
|
|
event->ignore();
|
|
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
#endif
|
|
|
|
#ifndef QT_NO_PROPERTIES
|
|
|
|
case QEvent::DynamicPropertyChange: {
|
|
|
|
const QByteArray &propName = static_cast<QDynamicPropertyChangeEvent *>(event)->propertyName();
|
|
|
|
if (!qstrncmp(propName, "_q_customDpi", 12) && propName.length() == 13) {
|
|
|
|
uint value = property(propName.constData()).toUInt();
|
|
|
|
if (!d->extra)
|
|
|
|
d->createExtra();
|
|
|
|
const char axis = propName.at(12);
|
|
|
|
if (axis == 'X')
|
|
|
|
d->extra->customDpiX = value;
|
|
|
|
else if (axis == 'Y')
|
|
|
|
d->extra->customDpiY = value;
|
|
|
|
d->updateFont(d->data.fnt);
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// fall through
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
#endif
|
|
|
|
default:
|
|
|
|
return QObject::event(event);
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
return true;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/*!
|
|
|
|
This event handler can be reimplemented to handle state changes.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
The state being changed in this event can be retrieved through the \a event
|
|
|
|
supplied.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Change events include: QEvent::ToolBarChange,
|
|
|
|
QEvent::ActivationChange, QEvent::EnabledChange, QEvent::FontChange,
|
|
|
|
QEvent::StyleChange, QEvent::PaletteChange,
|
|
|
|
QEvent::WindowTitleChange, QEvent::IconTextChange,
|
|
|
|
QEvent::ModifiedChange, QEvent::MouseTrackingChange,
|
|
|
|
QEvent::ParentChange, QEvent::WindowStateChange,
|
|
|
|
QEvent::LanguageChange, QEvent::LocaleChange,
|
|
|
|
QEvent::LayoutDirectionChange.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
void QWidget::changeEvent(QEvent * event)
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
switch(event->type()) {
|
|
|
|
case QEvent::EnabledChange:
|
|
|
|
update();
|
|
|
|
#ifndef QT_NO_ACCESSIBILITY
|
|
|
|
QAccessible::updateAccessibility(this, 0, QAccessible::StateChanged);
|
|
|
|
#endif
|
|
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
case QEvent::FontChange:
|
|
|
|
case QEvent::StyleChange: {
|
|
|
|
Q_D(QWidget);
|
|
|
|
update();
|
|
|
|
updateGeometry();
|
|
|
|
if (d->layout)
|
|
|
|
d->layout->invalidate();
|
|
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
case QEvent::PaletteChange:
|
|
|
|
update();
|
|
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
#ifdef Q_WS_MAC
|
|
|
|
case QEvent::MacSizeChange:
|
|
|
|
updateGeometry();
|
|
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
case QEvent::ToolTipChange:
|
|
|
|
case QEvent::MouseTrackingChange:
|
|
|
|
qt_mac_update_mouseTracking(this);
|
|
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
#endif
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
default:
|
|
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/*!
|
|
|
|
This event handler, for event \a event, can be reimplemented in a
|
|
|
|
subclass to receive mouse move events for the widget.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
If mouse tracking is switched off, mouse move events only occur if
|
|
|
|
a mouse button is pressed while the mouse is being moved. If mouse
|
|
|
|
tracking is switched on, mouse move events occur even if no mouse
|
|
|
|
button is pressed.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
QMouseEvent::pos() reports the position of the mouse cursor,
|
|
|
|
relative to this widget. For press and release events, the
|
|
|
|
position is usually the same as the position of the last mouse
|
|
|
|
move event, but it might be different if the user's hand shakes.
|
|
|
|
This is a feature of the underlying window system, not Qt.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
If you want to show a tooltip immediately, while the mouse is
|
|
|
|
moving (e.g., to get the mouse coordinates with QMouseEvent::pos()
|
|
|
|
and show them as a tooltip), you must first enable mouse tracking
|
|
|
|
as described above. Then, to ensure that the tooltip is updated
|
|
|
|
immediately, you must call QToolTip::showText() instead of
|
|
|
|
setToolTip() in your implementation of mouseMoveEvent().
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
\sa setMouseTracking(), mousePressEvent(), mouseReleaseEvent(),
|
|
|
|
mouseDoubleClickEvent(), event(), QMouseEvent, {Scribble Example}
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
void QWidget::mouseMoveEvent(QMouseEvent *event)
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
event->ignore();
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/*!
|
|
|
|
This event handler, for event \a event, can be reimplemented in a
|
|
|
|
subclass to receive mouse press events for the widget.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
If you create new widgets in the mousePressEvent() the
|
|
|
|
mouseReleaseEvent() may not end up where you expect, depending on
|
|
|
|
the underlying window system (or X11 window manager), the widgets'
|
|
|
|
location and maybe more.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
The default implementation implements the closing of popup widgets
|
|
|
|
when you click outside the window. For other widget types it does
|
|
|
|
nothing.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
\sa mouseReleaseEvent(), mouseDoubleClickEvent(),
|
|
|
|
mouseMoveEvent(), event(), QMouseEvent, {Scribble Example}
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
void QWidget::mousePressEvent(QMouseEvent *event)
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
event->ignore();
|
|
|
|
if ((windowType() == Qt::Popup)) {
|
|
|
|
event->accept();
|
|
|
|
QWidget* w;
|
|
|
|
while ((w = QApplication::activePopupWidget()) && w != this){
|
|
|
|
w->close();
|
|
|
|
if (QApplication::activePopupWidget() == w) // widget does not want to disappear
|
|
|
|
w->hide(); // hide at least
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if (!rect().contains(event->pos())){
|
|
|
|
close();
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/*!
|
|
|
|
This event handler, for event \a event, can be reimplemented in a
|
|
|
|
subclass to receive mouse release events for the widget.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
\sa mousePressEvent(), mouseDoubleClickEvent(),
|
|
|
|
mouseMoveEvent(), event(), QMouseEvent, {Scribble Example}
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
void QWidget::mouseReleaseEvent(QMouseEvent *event)
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
event->ignore();
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/*!
|
|
|
|
This event handler, for event \a event, can be reimplemented in a
|
|
|
|
subclass to receive mouse double click events for the widget.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
The default implementation generates a normal mouse press event.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
\note The widget will also receive mouse press and mouse release
|
|
|
|
events in addition to the double click event. It is up to the
|
|
|
|
developer to ensure that the application interprets these events
|
|
|
|
correctly.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
\sa mousePressEvent(), mouseReleaseEvent() mouseMoveEvent(),
|
|
|
|
event(), QMouseEvent
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
void QWidget::mouseDoubleClickEvent(QMouseEvent *event)
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
mousePressEvent(event); // try mouse press event
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
#ifndef QT_NO_WHEELEVENT
|
|
|
|
/*!
|
|
|
|
This event handler, for event \a event, can be reimplemented in a
|
|
|
|
subclass to receive wheel events for the widget.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
If you reimplement this handler, it is very important that you
|
|
|
|
\link QWheelEvent ignore()\endlink the event if you do not handle
|
|
|
|
it, so that the widget's parent can interpret it.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
The default implementation ignores the event.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
\sa QWheelEvent::ignore(), QWheelEvent::accept(), event(),
|
|
|
|
QWheelEvent
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
void QWidget::wheelEvent(QWheelEvent *event)
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
event->ignore();
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
#endif // QT_NO_WHEELEVENT
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
#ifndef QT_NO_TABLETEVENT
|
|
|
|
/*!
|
|
|
|
This event handler, for event \a event, can be reimplemented in a
|
|
|
|
subclass to receive tablet events for the widget.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
If you reimplement this handler, it is very important that you
|
|
|
|
\link QTabletEvent ignore()\endlink the event if you do not handle
|
|
|
|
it, so that the widget's parent can interpret it.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
The default implementation ignores the event.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
\sa QTabletEvent::ignore(), QTabletEvent::accept(), event(),
|
|
|
|
QTabletEvent
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
void QWidget::tabletEvent(QTabletEvent *event)
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
event->ignore();
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
#endif // QT_NO_TABLETEVENT
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/*!
|
|
|
|
This event handler, for event \a event, can be reimplemented in a
|
|
|
|
subclass to receive key press events for the widget.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
A widget must call setFocusPolicy() to accept focus initially and
|
|
|
|
have focus in order to receive a key press event.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
If you reimplement this handler, it is very important that you
|
|
|
|
call the base class implementation if you do not act upon the key.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
The default implementation closes popup widgets if the user
|
|
|
|
presses Esc. Otherwise the event is ignored, so that the widget's
|
|
|
|
parent can interpret it.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Note that QKeyEvent starts with isAccepted() == true, so you do not
|
|
|
|
need to call QKeyEvent::accept() - just do not call the base class
|
|
|
|
implementation if you act upon the key.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
\sa keyReleaseEvent(), setFocusPolicy(),
|
|
|
|
focusInEvent(), focusOutEvent(), event(), QKeyEvent, {Tetrix Example}
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
void QWidget::keyPressEvent(QKeyEvent *event)
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
if ((windowType() == Qt::Popup) && event->key() == Qt::Key_Escape) {
|
|
|
|
event->accept();
|
|
|
|
close();
|
|
|
|
} else {
|
|
|
|
event->ignore();
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/*!
|
|
|
|
This event handler, for event \a event, can be reimplemented in a
|
|
|
|
subclass to receive key release events for the widget.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
A widget must \link setFocusPolicy() accept focus\endlink
|
|
|
|
initially and \link hasFocus() have focus\endlink in order to
|
|
|
|
receive a key release event.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
If you reimplement this handler, it is very important that you
|
|
|
|
call the base class implementation if you do not act upon the key.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
The default implementation ignores the event, so that the widget's
|
|
|
|
parent can interpret it.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Note that QKeyEvent starts with isAccepted() == true, so you do not
|
|
|
|
need to call QKeyEvent::accept() - just do not call the base class
|
|
|
|
implementation if you act upon the key.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
\sa keyPressEvent(), QKeyEvent::ignore(), setFocusPolicy(),
|
|
|
|
focusInEvent(), focusOutEvent(), event(), QKeyEvent
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
void QWidget::keyReleaseEvent(QKeyEvent *event)
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
event->ignore();
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/*!
|
|
|
|
\fn void QWidget::focusInEvent(QFocusEvent *event)
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
This event handler can be reimplemented in a subclass to receive
|
|
|
|
keyboard focus events (focus received) for the widget. The event
|
|
|
|
is passed in the \a event parameter
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
A widget normally must setFocusPolicy() to something other than
|
|
|
|
Qt::NoFocus in order to receive focus events. (Note that the
|
|
|
|
application programmer can call setFocus() on any widget, even
|
|
|
|
those that do not normally accept focus.)
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
The default implementation updates the widget (except for windows
|
|
|
|
that do not specify a focusPolicy()).
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
\sa focusOutEvent(), setFocusPolicy(), keyPressEvent(),
|
|
|
|
keyReleaseEvent(), event(), QFocusEvent
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
void QWidget::focusInEvent(QFocusEvent *)
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
if (focusPolicy() != Qt::NoFocus || !isWindow()) {
|
|
|
|
update();
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/*!
|
|
|
|
\fn void QWidget::focusOutEvent(QFocusEvent *event)
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
This event handler can be reimplemented in a subclass to receive
|
|
|
|
keyboard focus events (focus lost) for the widget. The events is
|
|
|
|
passed in the \a event parameter.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
A widget normally must setFocusPolicy() to something other than
|
|
|
|
Qt::NoFocus in order to receive focus events. (Note that the
|
|
|
|
application programmer can call setFocus() on any widget, even
|
|
|
|
those that do not normally accept focus.)
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
The default implementation updates the widget (except for windows
|
|
|
|
that do not specify a focusPolicy()).
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
\sa focusInEvent(), setFocusPolicy(), keyPressEvent(),
|
|
|
|
keyReleaseEvent(), event(), QFocusEvent
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
void QWidget::focusOutEvent(QFocusEvent *)
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
if (focusPolicy() != Qt::NoFocus || !isWindow())
|
|
|
|
update();
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/*!
|
|
|
|
\fn void QWidget::enterEvent(QEvent *event)
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
This event handler can be reimplemented in a subclass to receive
|
|
|
|
widget enter events which are passed in the \a event parameter.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
An event is sent to the widget when the mouse cursor enters the
|
|
|
|
widget.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
\sa leaveEvent(), mouseMoveEvent(), event()
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
void QWidget::enterEvent(QEvent *)
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/*!
|
|
|
|
\fn void QWidget::leaveEvent(QEvent *event)
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
This event handler can be reimplemented in a subclass to receive
|
|
|
|
widget leave events which are passed in the \a event parameter.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
A leave event is sent to the widget when the mouse cursor leaves
|
|
|
|
the widget.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
\sa enterEvent(), mouseMoveEvent(), event()
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
void QWidget::leaveEvent(QEvent *)
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/*!
|
|
|
|
\fn void QWidget::paintEvent(QPaintEvent *event)
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
This event handler can be reimplemented in a subclass to receive paint
|
|
|
|
events passed in \a event.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
A paint event is a request to repaint all or part of a widget. It can
|
|
|
|
happen for one of the following reasons:
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
\list
|
|
|
|
\o repaint() or update() was invoked,
|
|
|
|
\o the widget was obscured and has now been uncovered, or
|
|
|
|
\o many other reasons.
|
|
|
|
\endlist
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Many widgets can simply repaint their entire surface when asked to, but
|
|
|
|
some slow widgets need to optimize by painting only the requested region:
|
|
|
|
QPaintEvent::region(). This speed optimization does not change the result,
|
|
|
|
as painting is clipped to that region during event processing. QListView
|
|
|
|
and QTableView do this, for example.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Qt also tries to speed up painting by merging multiple paint events into
|
|
|
|
one. When update() is called several times or the window system sends
|
|
|
|
several paint events, Qt merges these events into one event with a larger
|
|
|
|
region (see QRegion::united()). The repaint() function does not permit this
|
|
|
|
optimization, so we suggest using update() whenever possible.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
When the paint event occurs, the update region has normally been erased, so
|
|
|
|
you are painting on the widget's background.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
The background can be set using setBackgroundRole() and setPalette().
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Since Qt 4.0, QWidget automatically double-buffers its painting, so there
|
|
|
|
is no need to write double-buffering code in paintEvent() to avoid flicker.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
\bold{Note for the X11 platform}: It is possible to toggle global double
|
|
|
|
buffering by calling \c qt_x11_set_global_double_buffer(). For example,
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
\snippet doc/src/snippets/code/src_gui_kernel_qwidget.cpp 14
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
\note Generally, you should refrain from calling update() or repaint()
|
|
|
|
\bold{inside} a paintEvent(). For example, calling update() or repaint() on
|
|
|
|
children inside a paintevent() results in undefined behavior; the child may
|
|
|
|
or may not get a paint event.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
\warning If you are using a custom paint engine without Qt's backingstore,
|
|
|
|
Qt::WA_PaintOnScreen must be set. Otherwise, QWidget::paintEngine() will
|
|
|
|
never be called; the backingstore will be used instead.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
\sa event(), repaint(), update(), QPainter, QPixmap, QPaintEvent,
|
|
|
|
{Analog Clock Example}
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
void QWidget::paintEvent(QPaintEvent *)
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/*!
|
|
|
|
\fn void QWidget::moveEvent(QMoveEvent *event)
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
This event handler can be reimplemented in a subclass to receive
|
|
|
|
widget move events which are passed in the \a event parameter.
|
|
|
|
When the widget receives this event, it is already at the new
|
|
|
|
position.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
The old position is accessible through QMoveEvent::oldPos().
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
\sa resizeEvent(), event(), move(), QMoveEvent
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
void QWidget::moveEvent(QMoveEvent *)
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/*!
|
|
|
|
This event handler can be reimplemented in a subclass to receive
|
|
|
|
widget resize events which are passed in the \a event parameter.
|
|
|
|
When resizeEvent() is called, the widget already has its new
|
|
|
|
geometry. The old size is accessible through
|
|
|
|
QResizeEvent::oldSize().
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
The widget will be erased and receive a paint event immediately
|
|
|
|
after processing the resize event. No drawing need be (or should
|
|
|
|
be) done inside this handler.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
\sa moveEvent(), event(), resize(), QResizeEvent, paintEvent(),
|
|
|
|
{Scribble Example}
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
void QWidget::resizeEvent(QResizeEvent * /* event */)
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
#ifndef QT_NO_ACTION
|
|
|
|
/*!
|
|
|
|
\fn void QWidget::actionEvent(QActionEvent *event)
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
This event handler is called with the given \a event whenever the
|
|
|
|
widget's actions are changed.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
\sa addAction(), insertAction(), removeAction(), actions(), QActionEvent
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
void QWidget::actionEvent(QActionEvent *)
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
#endif
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/*!
|
|
|
|
This event handler is called with the given \a event when Qt receives a window
|
|
|
|
close request for a top-level widget from the window system.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
By default, the event is accepted and the widget is closed. You can reimplement
|
|
|
|
this function to change the way the widget responds to window close requests.
|
|
|
|
For example, you can prevent the window from closing by calling \l{QEvent::}{ignore()}
|
|
|
|
on all events.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Main window applications typically use reimplementations of this function to check
|
|
|
|
whether the user's work has been saved and ask for permission before closing.
|
|
|
|
For example, the \l{Application Example} uses a helper function to determine whether
|
|
|
|
or not to close the window:
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
\snippet mainwindows/application/mainwindow.cpp 3
|
|
|
|
\snippet mainwindows/application/mainwindow.cpp 4
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
\sa event(), hide(), close(), QCloseEvent, {Application Example}
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
void QWidget::closeEvent(QCloseEvent *event)
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
event->accept();
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
#ifndef QT_NO_CONTEXTMENU
|
|
|
|
/*!
|
|
|
|
This event handler, for event \a event, can be reimplemented in a
|
|
|
|
subclass to receive widget context menu events.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
The handler is called when the widget's \l contextMenuPolicy is
|
|
|
|
Qt::DefaultContextMenu.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
The default implementation ignores the context event.
|
|
|
|
See the \l QContextMenuEvent documentation for more details.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
\sa event(), QContextMenuEvent customContextMenuRequested()
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
void QWidget::contextMenuEvent(QContextMenuEvent *event)
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
event->ignore();
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
#endif // QT_NO_CONTEXTMENU
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/*!
|
|
|
|
This event handler, for event \a event, can be reimplemented in a
|
|
|
|
subclass to receive Input Method composition events. This handler
|
|
|
|
is called when the state of the input method changes.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Note that when creating custom text editing widgets, the
|
|
|
|
Qt::WA_InputMethodEnabled window attribute must be set explicitly
|
|
|
|
(using the setAttribute() function) in order to receive input
|
|
|
|
method events.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
The default implementation calls event->ignore(), which rejects the
|
|
|
|
Input Method event. See the \l QInputMethodEvent documentation for more
|
|
|
|
details.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
\sa event(), QInputMethodEvent
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
void QWidget::inputMethodEvent(QInputMethodEvent *event)
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
event->ignore();
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/*!
|
|
|
|
This method is only relevant for input widgets. It is used by the
|
|
|
|
input method to query a set of properties of the widget to be
|
|
|
|
able to support complex input method operations as support for
|
|
|
|
surrounding text and reconversions.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
\a query specifies which property is queried.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
\sa inputMethodEvent(), QInputMethodEvent, QInputContext, inputMethodHints
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
QVariant QWidget::inputMethodQuery(Qt::InputMethodQuery query) const
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
switch(query) {
|
|
|
|
case Qt::ImMicroFocus:
|
|
|
|
return QRect(width()/2, 0, 1, height());
|
|
|
|
case Qt::ImFont:
|
|
|
|
return font();
|
|
|
|
case Qt::ImAnchorPosition:
|
|
|
|
// Fallback.
|
|
|
|
return inputMethodQuery(Qt::ImCursorPosition);
|
|
|
|
default:
|
|
|
|
return QVariant();
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/*!
|
|
|
|
\property QWidget::inputMethodHints
|
|
|
|
\brief What input method specific hints the widget has.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
This is only relevant for input widgets. It is used by
|
|
|
|
the input method to retrieve hints as to how the input method
|
|
|
|
should operate. For example, if the Qt::ImhFormattedNumbersOnly flag
|
|
|
|
is set, the input method may change its visual components to reflect
|
|
|
|
that only numbers can be entered.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
\note The flags are only hints, so the particular input method
|
|
|
|
implementation is free to ignore them. If you want to be
|
|
|
|
sure that a certain type of characters are entered,
|
|
|
|
you should also set a QValidator on the widget.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
The default value is Qt::ImhNone.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
\since 4.6
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
\sa inputMethodQuery(), QInputContext
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
Qt::InputMethodHints QWidget::inputMethodHints() const
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
#ifndef QT_NO_IM
|
|
|
|
const QWidgetPrivate *priv = d_func();
|
|
|
|
while (priv->inheritsInputMethodHints) {
|
|
|
|
priv = priv->q_func()->parentWidget()->d_func();
|
|
|
|
Q_ASSERT(priv);
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
return priv->imHints;
|
|
|
|
#else //QT_NO_IM
|
|
|
|
return 0;
|
|
|
|
#endif //QT_NO_IM
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
void QWidget::setInputMethodHints(Qt::InputMethodHints hints)
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
#ifndef QT_NO_IM
|
|
|
|
Q_D(QWidget);
|
|
|
|
if (d->imHints == hints)
|
|
|
|
return;
|
|
|
|
d->imHints = hints;
|
|
|
|
// Optimization to update input context only it has already been created.
|
|
|
|
if (d->ic || qApp->d_func()->inputContext) {
|
|
|
|
QInputContext *ic = inputContext();
|
|
|
|
if (ic)
|
|
|
|
ic->update();
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
#endif //QT_NO_IM
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
#ifndef QT_NO_DRAGANDDROP
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/*!
|
|
|
|
\fn void QWidget::dragEnterEvent(QDragEnterEvent *event)
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
This event handler is called when a drag is in progress and the
|
|
|
|
mouse enters this widget. The event is passed in the \a event parameter.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
If the event is ignored, the widget won't receive any \l{dragMoveEvent()}{drag
|
|
|
|
move events}.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
See the \link dnd.html Drag-and-drop documentation\endlink for an
|
|
|
|
overview of how to provide drag-and-drop in your application.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
\sa QDrag, QDragEnterEvent
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
void QWidget::dragEnterEvent(QDragEnterEvent *)
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/*!
|
|
|
|
\fn void QWidget::dragMoveEvent(QDragMoveEvent *event)
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
This event handler is called if a drag is in progress, and when
|
|
|
|
any of the following conditions occur: the cursor enters this widget,
|
|
|
|
the cursor moves within this widget, or a modifier key is pressed on
|
|
|
|
the keyboard while this widget has the focus. The event is passed
|
|
|
|
in the \a event parameter.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
See the \link dnd.html Drag-and-drop documentation\endlink for an
|
|
|
|
overview of how to provide drag-and-drop in your application.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
\sa QDrag, QDragMoveEvent
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
void QWidget::dragMoveEvent(QDragMoveEvent *)
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/*!
|
|
|
|
\fn void QWidget::dragLeaveEvent(QDragLeaveEvent *event)
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
This event handler is called when a drag is in progress and the
|
|
|
|
mouse leaves this widget. The event is passed in the \a event
|
|
|
|
parameter.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
See the \link dnd.html Drag-and-drop documentation\endlink for an
|
|
|
|
overview of how to provide drag-and-drop in your application.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
\sa QDrag, QDragLeaveEvent
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
void QWidget::dragLeaveEvent(QDragLeaveEvent *)
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/*!
|
|
|
|
\fn void QWidget::dropEvent(QDropEvent *event)
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
This event handler is called when the drag is dropped on this
|
|
|
|
widget. The event is passed in the \a event parameter.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
See the \link dnd.html Drag-and-drop documentation\endlink for an
|
|
|
|
overview of how to provide drag-and-drop in your application.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
\sa QDrag, QDropEvent
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
void QWidget::dropEvent(QDropEvent *)
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
#endif // QT_NO_DRAGANDDROP
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/*!
|
|
|
|
\fn void QWidget::showEvent(QShowEvent *event)
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
This event handler can be reimplemented in a subclass to receive
|
|
|
|
widget show events which are passed in the \a event parameter.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Non-spontaneous show events are sent to widgets immediately
|
|
|
|
before they are shown. The spontaneous show events of windows are
|
|
|
|
delivered afterwards.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Note: A widget receives spontaneous show and hide events when its
|
|
|
|
mapping status is changed by the window system, e.g. a spontaneous
|
|
|
|
hide event when the user minimizes the window, and a spontaneous
|
|
|
|
show event when the window is restored again. After receiving a
|
|
|
|
spontaneous hide event, a widget is still considered visible in
|
|
|
|
the sense of isVisible().
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
\sa visible, event(), QShowEvent
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
void QWidget::showEvent(QShowEvent *)
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/*!
|
|
|
|
\fn void QWidget::hideEvent(QHideEvent *event)
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
This event handler can be reimplemented in a subclass to receive
|
|
|
|
widget hide events. The event is passed in the \a event parameter.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Hide events are sent to widgets immediately after they have been
|
|
|
|
hidden.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Note: A widget receives spontaneous show and hide events when its
|
|
|
|
mapping status is changed by the window system, e.g. a spontaneous
|
|
|
|
hide event when the user minimizes the window, and a spontaneous
|
|
|
|
show event when the window is restored again. After receiving a
|
|
|
|
spontaneous hide event, a widget is still considered visible in
|
|
|
|
the sense of isVisible().
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
\sa visible, event(), QHideEvent
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
void QWidget::hideEvent(QHideEvent *)
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
|
|
\fn QWidget::x11Event(MSG *)
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
This special event handler can be reimplemented in a subclass to receive
|
|
|
|
native X11 events.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
In your reimplementation of this function, if you want to stop Qt from
|
|
|
|
handling the event, return true. If you return false, this native event
|
|
|
|
is passed back to Qt, which translates it into a Qt event and sends it to
|
|
|
|
the widget.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
\note Events are only delivered to this event handler if the widget is
|
|
|
|
native.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
\warning This function is not portable.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
\sa QApplication::x11EventFilter(), QWidget::winId()
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
#if defined(Q_WS_MAC)
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/*!
|
|
|
|
\fn bool QWidget::macEvent(EventHandlerCallRef caller, EventRef event)
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
This special event handler can be reimplemented in a subclass to
|
|
|
|
receive native Macintosh events.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
The parameters are a bit different depending if Qt is build against Carbon
|
|
|
|
or Cocoa. In Carbon, \a caller and \a event are the corresponding
|
|
|
|
EventHandlerCallRef and EventRef that correspond to the Carbon event
|
|
|
|
handlers that are installed. In Cocoa, \a caller is always 0 and the
|
|
|
|
EventRef is the EventRef generated from the NSEvent.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
In your reimplementation of this function, if you want to stop the
|
|
|
|
event being handled by Qt, return true. If you return false, this
|
|
|
|
native event is passed back to Qt, which translates the event into
|
|
|
|
a Qt event and sends it to the widget.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
\warning This function is not portable.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
\warning This function was not called inside of Qt until Qt 4.4.
|
|
|
|
If you need compatibility with earlier versions of Qt, consider QApplication::macEventFilter() instead.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
\sa QApplication::macEventFilter()
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
bool QWidget::macEvent(EventHandlerCallRef, EventRef)
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
return false;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
#endif
|
|
|
|
#if defined(Q_WS_WIN)
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/*!
|
|
|
|
This special event handler can be reimplemented in a subclass to
|
|
|
|
receive native Windows events which are passed in the \a message
|
|
|
|
parameter.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
In your reimplementation of this function, if you want to stop the
|
|
|
|
event being handled by Qt, return true and set \a result to the value
|
|
|
|
that the window procedure should return. If you return false, this
|
|
|
|
native event is passed back to Qt, which translates the event into
|
|
|
|
a Qt event and sends it to the widget.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
\warning This function is not portable.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
\sa QApplication::winEventFilter()
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
bool QWidget::winEvent(MSG *message, long *result)
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
Q_UNUSED(message);
|
|
|
|
Q_UNUSED(result);
|
|
|
|
return false;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
#endif
|
|
|
|
#if defined(Q_WS_X11)
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/*!
|
|
|
|
\fn bool QWidget::x11Event(XEvent *event)
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
This special event handler can be reimplemented in a subclass to receive
|
|
|
|
native X11 events passed in the \a event parameter.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
In your reimplementation of this function, if you want to stop Qt from
|
|
|
|
handling the event, return true. If you return false, this native event
|
|
|
|
is passed back to Qt, which translates it into a Qt event and sends it to
|
|
|
|
the widget.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
\note Events are only delivered to this event handler if the widget is
|
|
|
|
native.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
\warning This function is not portable.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
\sa QApplication::x11EventFilter(), QWidget::winId()
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
bool QWidget::x11Event(XEvent *)
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
return false;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
#endif
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/*!
|
|
|
|
Ensures that the widget has been polished by QStyle (i.e., has a
|
|
|
|
proper font and palette).
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
QWidget calls this function after it has been fully constructed
|
|
|
|
but before it is shown the very first time. You can call this
|
|
|
|
function if you want to ensure that the widget is polished before
|
|
|
|
doing an operation, e.g., the correct font size might be needed in
|
|
|
|
the widget's sizeHint() reimplementation. Note that this function
|
|
|
|
\e is called from the default implementation of sizeHint().
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Polishing is useful for final initialization that must happen after
|
|
|
|
all constructors (from base classes as well as from subclasses)
|
|
|
|
have been called.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
If you need to change some settings when a widget is polished,
|
|
|
|
reimplement event() and handle the QEvent::Polish event type.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
\bold{Note:} The function is declared const so that it can be called from
|
|
|
|
other const functions (e.g., sizeHint()).
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
\sa event()
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
void QWidget::ensurePolished() const
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
Q_D(const QWidget);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
const QMetaObject *m = metaObject();
|
|
|
|
if (m == d->polished)
|
|
|
|
return;
|
|
|
|
d->polished = m;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
QEvent e(QEvent::Polish);
|
|
|
|
QCoreApplication::sendEvent(const_cast<QWidget *>(this), &e);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
// polish children after 'this'
|
|
|
|
QList<QObject*> children = d->children;
|
|
|
|
for (int i = 0; i < children.size(); ++i) {
|
|
|
|
QObject *o = children.at(i);
|
|
|
|
if(!o->isWidgetType())
|
|
|
|
continue;
|
|
|
|
if (QWidget *w = qobject_cast<QWidget *>(o))
|
|
|
|
w->ensurePolished();
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
if (d->parent && d->sendChildEvents) {
|
|
|
|
QChildEvent e(QEvent::ChildPolished, const_cast<QWidget *>(this));
|
|
|
|
QCoreApplication::sendEvent(d->parent, &e);
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/*!
|
|
|
|
Returns the mask currently set on a widget. If no mask is set the
|
|
|
|
return value will be an empty region.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
\sa setMask(), clearMask(), QRegion::isEmpty(), {Shaped Clock Example}
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
QRegion QWidget::mask() const
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
Q_D(const QWidget);
|
|
|
|
return d->extra ? d->extra->mask : QRegion();
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/*!
|
|
|
|
Returns the layout manager that is installed on this widget, or 0
|
|
|
|
if no layout manager is installed.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
The layout manager sets the geometry of the widget's children
|
|
|
|
that have been added to the layout.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
\sa setLayout(), sizePolicy(), {Layout Management}
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
QLayout *QWidget::layout() const
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
return d_func()->layout;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/*!
|
|
|
|
\fn void QWidget::setLayout(QLayout *layout)
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Sets the layout manager for this widget to \a layout.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
If there already is a layout manager installed on this widget,
|
|
|
|
QWidget won't let you install another. You must first delete the
|
|
|
|
existing layout manager (returned by layout()) before you can
|
|
|
|
call setLayout() with the new layout.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
If \a layout is the layout manger on a different widget, setLayout()
|
|
|
|
will reparent the layout and make it the layout manager for this widget.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Example:
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
\snippet examples/uitools/textfinder/textfinder.cpp 3b
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
An alternative to calling this function is to pass this widget to
|
|
|
|
the layout's constructor.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
The QWidget will take ownership of \a layout.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
\sa layout(), {Layout Management}
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
void QWidget::setLayout(QLayout *l)
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
if (!l) {
|
|
|
|
qWarning("QWidget::setLayout: Cannot set layout to 0");
|
|
|
|
return;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if (layout()) {
|
|
|
|
if (layout() != l)
|
|
|
|
qWarning("QWidget::setLayout: Attempting to set QLayout \"%s\" on %s \"%s\", which already has a"
|
|
|
|
" layout", l->objectName().toLocal8Bit().data(), metaObject()->className(),
|
|
|
|
objectName().toLocal8Bit().data());
|
|
|
|
return;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
QObject *oldParent = l->parent();
|
|
|
|
if (oldParent && oldParent != this) {
|
|
|
|
if (oldParent->isWidgetType()) {
|
|
|
|
// Steal the layout off a widget parent. Takes effect when
|
|
|
|
// morphing laid-out container widgets in Designer.
|
|
|
|
QWidget *oldParentWidget = static_cast<QWidget *>(oldParent);
|
|
|
|
oldParentWidget->takeLayout();
|
|
|
|
} else {
|
|
|
|
qWarning("QWidget::setLayout: Attempting to set QLayout \"%s\" on %s \"%s\", when the QLayout already has a parent",
|
|
|
|
l->objectName().toLocal8Bit().data(), metaObject()->className(),
|
|
|
|
objectName().toLocal8Bit().data());
|
|
|
|
return;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Q_D(QWidget);
|
|
|
|
l->d_func()->topLevel = true;
|
|
|
|
d->layout = l;
|
|
|
|
if (oldParent != this) {
|
|
|
|
l->setParent(this);
|
|
|
|
l->d_func()->reparentChildWidgets(this);
|
|
|
|
l->invalidate();
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
if (isWindow() && d->maybeTopData())
|
|
|
|
d->topData()->sizeAdjusted = false;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/*!
|
|
|
|
\fn QLayout *QWidget::takeLayout()
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Remove the layout from the widget.
|
|
|
|
\since 4.5
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
QLayout *QWidget::takeLayout()
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
Q_D(QWidget);
|
|
|
|
QLayout *l = layout();
|
|
|
|
if (!l)
|
|
|
|
return 0;
|
|
|
|
d->layout = 0;
|
|
|
|
l->setParent(0);
|
|
|
|
return l;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/*!
|
|
|
|
\property QWidget::sizePolicy
|
|
|
|
\brief the default layout behavior of the widget
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
If there is a QLayout that manages this widget's children, the
|
|
|
|
size policy specified by that layout is used. If there is no such
|
|
|
|
QLayout, the result of this function is used.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
The default policy is Preferred/Preferred, which means that the
|
|
|
|
widget can be freely resized, but prefers to be the size
|
|
|
|
sizeHint() returns. Button-like widgets set the size policy to
|
|
|
|
specify that they may stretch horizontally, but are fixed
|
|
|
|
vertically. The same applies to lineedit controls (such as
|
|
|
|
QLineEdit, QSpinBox or an editable QComboBox) and other
|
|
|
|
horizontally orientated widgets (such as QProgressBar).
|
|
|
|
QToolButton's are normally square, so they allow growth in both
|
|
|
|
directions. Widgets that support different directions (such as
|
|
|
|
QSlider, QScrollBar or QHeader) specify stretching in the
|
|
|
|
respective direction only. Widgets that can provide scroll bars
|
|
|
|
(usually subclasses of QScrollArea) tend to specify that they can
|
|
|
|
use additional space, and that they can make do with less than
|
|
|
|
sizeHint().
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
\sa sizeHint() QLayout QSizePolicy updateGeometry()
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
QSizePolicy QWidget::sizePolicy() const
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
Q_D(const QWidget);
|
|
|
|
return d->size_policy;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
void QWidget::setSizePolicy(QSizePolicy policy)
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
Q_D(QWidget);
|
|
|
|
setAttribute(Qt::WA_WState_OwnSizePolicy);
|
|
|
|
if (policy == d->size_policy)
|
|
|
|
return;
|
|
|
|
d->size_policy = policy;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
#ifndef QT_NO_GRAPHICSVIEW
|
|
|
|
if (QWExtra *extra = d->extra) {
|
|
|
|
if (extra->proxyWidget)
|
|
|
|
extra->proxyWidget->setSizePolicy(policy);
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
#endif
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
updateGeometry();
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
if (isWindow() && d->maybeTopData())
|
|
|
|
d->topData()->sizeAdjusted = false;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/*!
|
|
|
|
\fn void QWidget::setSizePolicy(QSizePolicy::Policy horizontal, QSizePolicy::Policy vertical)
|
|
|
|
\overload
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Sets the size policy of the widget to \a horizontal and \a
|
|
|
|
vertical, with standard stretch and no height-for-width.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
\sa QSizePolicy::QSizePolicy()
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/*!
|
|
|
|
Returns the preferred height for this widget, given the width \a w.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
If this widget has a layout, the default implementation returns
|
|
|
|
the layout's preferred height. if there is no layout, the default
|
|
|
|
implementation returns -1 indicating that the preferred height
|
|
|
|
does not depend on the width.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
int QWidget::heightForWidth(int w) const
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
if (layout() && layout()->hasHeightForWidth())
|
|
|
|
return layout()->totalHeightForWidth(w);
|
|
|
|
return -1;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/*!
|
|
|
|
\internal
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
*virtual private*
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
This is a bit hackish, but ideally we would have created a virtual function
|
|
|
|
in the public API (however, too late...) so that subclasses could reimplement
|
|
|
|
their own function.
|
|
|
|
Instead we add a virtual function to QWidgetPrivate.
|
|
|
|
### Qt5: move to public class and make virtual
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
bool QWidgetPrivate::hasHeightForWidth() const
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
return layout ? layout->hasHeightForWidth() : size_policy.hasHeightForWidth();
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/*!
|
|
|
|
\fn QWidget *QWidget::childAt(int x, int y) const
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Returns the visible child widget at the position (\a{x}, \a{y})
|
|
|
|
in the widget's coordinate system. If there is no visible child
|
|
|
|
widget at the specified position, the function returns 0.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/*!
|
|
|
|
\overload
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Returns the visible child widget at point \a p in the widget's own
|
|
|
|
coordinate system.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
QWidget *QWidget::childAt(const QPoint &p) const
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
return d_func()->childAt_helper(p, false);
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
QWidget *QWidgetPrivate::childAt_helper(const QPoint &p, bool ignoreChildrenInDestructor) const
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
if (children.isEmpty())
|
|
|
|
return 0;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
#ifdef Q_WS_MAC
|
|
|
|
Q_Q(const QWidget);
|
|
|
|
// Unified tool bars on the Mac require special handling since they live outside
|
|
|
|
// QMainWindow's geometry(). See commit: 35667fd45ada49269a5987c235fdedfc43e92bb8
|
|
|
|
bool includeFrame = q->isWindow() && qobject_cast<const QMainWindow *>(q)
|
|
|
|
&& static_cast<const QMainWindow *>(q)->unifiedTitleAndToolBarOnMac();
|
|
|
|
if (includeFrame)
|
|
|
|
return childAtRecursiveHelper(p, ignoreChildrenInDestructor, includeFrame);
|
|
|
|
#endif
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
if (!pointInsideRectAndMask(p))
|
|
|
|
return 0;
|
|
|
|
return childAtRecursiveHelper(p, ignoreChildrenInDestructor);
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
QWidget *QWidgetPrivate::childAtRecursiveHelper(const QPoint &p, bool ignoreChildrenInDestructor, bool includeFrame) const
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
#ifndef Q_WS_MAC
|
|
|
|
Q_UNUSED(includeFrame);
|
|
|
|
#endif
|
|
|
|
for (int i = children.size() - 1; i >= 0; --i) {
|
|
|
|
QWidget *child = qobject_cast<QWidget *>(children.at(i));
|
|
|
|
if (!child || child->isWindow() || child->isHidden() || child->testAttribute(Qt::WA_TransparentForMouseEvents)
|
|
|
|
|| (ignoreChildrenInDestructor && child->data->in_destructor)) {
|
|
|
|
continue;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
// Map the point 'p' from parent coordinates to child coordinates.
|
|
|
|
QPoint childPoint = p;
|
|
|
|
#if defined(Q_WS_MAC) && defined(QT_MAC_USE_COCOA)
|
|
|
|
// 'includeFrame' is true if the child's parent is a top-level QMainWindow with an unified tool bar.
|
|
|
|
// An unified tool bar on the Mac lives outside QMainWindow's geometry(), so a normal
|
|
|
|
// QWidget::mapFromParent won't do the trick.
|
|
|
|
if (includeFrame && qobject_cast<QToolBar *>(child) && qt_widget_private(child)->isInUnifiedToolbar)
|
|
|
|
childPoint = qt_mac_nativeMapFromParent(child, p);
|
|
|
|
else
|
|
|
|
#endif
|
|
|
|
childPoint -= child->data->crect.topLeft();
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
// Check if the point hits the child.
|
|
|
|
if (!child->d_func()->pointInsideRectAndMask(childPoint))
|
|
|
|
continue;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
// Do the same for the child's descendants.
|
|
|
|
if (QWidget *w = child->d_func()->childAtRecursiveHelper(childPoint, ignoreChildrenInDestructor))
|
|
|
|
return w;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
// We have found our target; namely the child at position 'p'.
|
|
|
|
return child;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
return 0;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
void QWidgetPrivate::updateGeometry_helper(bool forceUpdate)
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
Q_Q(QWidget);
|
|
|
|
if (widgetItem)
|
|
|
|
widgetItem->invalidateSizeCache();
|
|
|
|
QWidget *parent;
|
|
|
|
if (forceUpdate || !extra || extra->minw != extra->maxw || extra->minh != extra->maxh) {
|
|
|
|
if (!q->isWindow() && !q->isHidden() && (parent = q->parentWidget())) {
|
|
|
|
if (parent->d_func()->layout)
|
|
|
|
parent->d_func()->layout->invalidate();
|
|
|
|
else if (parent->isVisible())
|
|
|
|
QApplication::postEvent(parent, new QEvent(QEvent::LayoutRequest));
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/*!
|
|
|
|
Notifies the layout system that this widget has changed and may
|
|
|
|
need to change geometry.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Call this function if the sizeHint() or sizePolicy() have changed.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
For explicitly hidden widgets, updateGeometry() is a no-op. The
|
|
|
|
layout system will be notified as soon as the widget is shown.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
void QWidget::updateGeometry()
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
Q_D(QWidget);
|
|
|
|
d->updateGeometry_helper(false);
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/*! \property QWidget::windowFlags
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Window flags are a combination of a type (e.g. Qt::Dialog) and
|
|
|
|
zero or more hints to the window system (e.g.
|
|
|
|
Qt::FramelessWindowHint).
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
If the widget had type Qt::Widget or Qt::SubWindow and becomes a
|
|
|
|
window (Qt::Window, Qt::Dialog, etc.), it is put at position (0,
|
|
|
|
0) on the desktop. If the widget is a window and becomes a
|
|
|
|
Qt::Widget or Qt::SubWindow, it is put at position (0, 0)
|
|
|
|
relative to its parent widget.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
\note This function calls setParent() when changing the flags for
|
|
|
|
a window, causing the widget to be hidden. You must call show() to make
|
|
|
|
the widget visible again..
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
\sa windowType(), {Window Flags Example}
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
void QWidget::setWindowFlags(Qt::WindowFlags flags)
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
if (data->window_flags == flags)
|
|
|
|
return;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Q_D(QWidget);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
if ((data->window_flags | flags) & Qt::Window) {
|
|
|
|
// the old type was a window and/or the new type is a window
|
|
|
|
QPoint oldPos = pos();
|
|
|
|
bool visible = isVisible();
|
|
|
|
setParent(parentWidget(), flags);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
// if both types are windows or neither of them are, we restore
|
|
|
|
// the old position
|
|
|
|
if (!((data->window_flags ^ flags) & Qt::Window)
|
|
|
|
&& (visible || testAttribute(Qt::WA_Moved))) {
|
|
|
|
move(oldPos);
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// for backward-compatibility we change Qt::WA_QuitOnClose attribute value only when the window was recreated.
|
|
|
|
d->adjustQuitOnCloseAttribute();
|
|
|
|
} else {
|
|
|
|
data->window_flags = flags;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/*!
|
|
|
|
Sets the window flags for the widget to \a flags,
|
|
|
|
\e without telling the window system.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
\warning Do not call this function unless you really know what
|
|
|
|
you're doing.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
\sa setWindowFlags()
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
void QWidget::overrideWindowFlags(Qt::WindowFlags flags)
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
data->window_flags = flags;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/*!
|
|
|
|
\fn Qt::WindowType QWidget::windowType() const
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Returns the window type of this widget. This is identical to
|
|
|
|
windowFlags() & Qt::WindowType_Mask.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
\sa windowFlags
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/*!
|
|
|
|
Sets the parent of the widget to \a parent, and resets the window
|
|
|
|
flags. The widget is moved to position (0, 0) in its new parent.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
If the new parent widget is in a different window, the
|
|
|
|
reparented widget and its children are appended to the end of the
|
|
|
|
\l{setFocusPolicy()}{tab chain} of the new parent
|
|
|
|
widget, in the same internal order as before. If one of the moved
|
|
|
|
widgets had keyboard focus, setParent() calls clearFocus() for that
|
|
|
|
widget.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
If the new parent widget is in the same window as the
|
|
|
|
old parent, setting the parent doesn't change the tab order or
|
|
|
|
keyboard focus.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
If the "new" parent widget is the old parent widget, this function
|
|
|
|
does nothing.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
\note The widget becomes invisible as part of changing its parent,
|
|
|
|
even if it was previously visible. You must call show() to make the
|
|
|
|
widget visible again.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
\warning It is very unlikely that you will ever need this
|
|
|
|
function. If you have a widget that changes its content
|
|
|
|
dynamically, it is far easier to use \l QStackedWidget.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
\sa setWindowFlags()
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
void QWidget::setParent(QWidget *parent)
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
if (parent == parentWidget())
|
|
|
|
return;
|
|
|
|
setParent((QWidget*)parent, windowFlags() & ~Qt::WindowType_Mask);
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/*!
|
|
|
|
\overload
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
This function also takes widget flags, \a f as an argument.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
void QWidget::setParent(QWidget *parent, Qt::WindowFlags f)
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
Q_D(QWidget);
|
|
|
|
d->inSetParent = true;
|
|
|
|
bool resized = testAttribute(Qt::WA_Resized);
|
|
|
|
bool wasCreated = testAttribute(Qt::WA_WState_Created);
|
|
|
|
QWidget *oldtlw = window();
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
QWidget *desktopWidget = 0;
|
|
|
|
if (parent && parent->windowType() == Qt::Desktop)
|
|
|
|
desktopWidget = parent;
|
|
|
|
bool newParent = (parent != parentWidget()) || !wasCreated || desktopWidget;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
#if defined(Q_WS_X11) || defined(Q_WS_WIN) || defined(Q_WS_MAC)
|
|
|
|
if (newParent && parent && !desktopWidget) {
|
|
|
|
if (testAttribute(Qt::WA_NativeWindow) && !qApp->testAttribute(Qt::AA_DontCreateNativeWidgetSiblings)
|
|
|
|
#if defined(Q_WS_MAC) && defined(QT_MAC_USE_COCOA)
|
|
|
|
// On Mac, toolbars inside the unified title bar will never overlap with
|
|
|
|
// siblings in the content view. So we skip enforce native siblings in that case
|
|
|
|
&& !d->isInUnifiedToolbar && parentWidget() && parentWidget()->isWindow()
|
|
|
|
#endif // Q_WS_MAC && QT_MAC_USE_COCOA
|
|
|
|
)
|
|
|
|
parent->d_func()->enforceNativeChildren();
|
|
|
|
else if (parent->d_func()->nativeChildrenForced() || parent->testAttribute(Qt::WA_PaintOnScreen))
|
|
|
|
setAttribute(Qt::WA_NativeWindow);
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
#endif
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
if (wasCreated) {
|
|
|
|
if (!testAttribute(Qt::WA_WState_Hidden)) {
|
|
|
|
hide();
|
|
|
|
setAttribute(Qt::WA_WState_ExplicitShowHide, false);
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if (newParent) {
|
|
|
|
QEvent e(QEvent::ParentAboutToChange);
|
|
|
|
QApplication::sendEvent(this, &e);
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if (newParent && isAncestorOf(focusWidget()))
|
|
|
|
focusWidget()->clearFocus();
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
QTLWExtra *oldTopExtra = window()->d_func()->maybeTopData();
|
|
|
|
QWidgetBackingStoreTracker *oldBsTracker = oldTopExtra ? &oldTopExtra->backingStore : 0;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
d->setParent_sys(parent, f);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
QTLWExtra *topExtra = window()->d_func()->maybeTopData();
|
|
|
|
QWidgetBackingStoreTracker *bsTracker = topExtra ? &topExtra->backingStore : 0;
|
|
|
|
if (oldBsTracker && oldBsTracker != bsTracker)
|
|
|
|
oldBsTracker->unregisterWidgetSubtree(this);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
if (desktopWidget)
|
|
|
|
parent = 0;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
#ifdef Q_BACKINGSTORE_SUBSURFACES
|
|
|
|
QTLWExtra *extra = d->maybeTopData();
|
|
|
|
QWindowSurface *windowSurface = (extra ? extra->windowSurface : 0);
|
|
|
|
if (newParent && windowSurface) {
|
|
|
|
QWidgetBackingStore *oldBs = oldtlw->d_func()->maybeBackingStore();
|
|
|
|
if (oldBs)
|
|
|
|
oldBs->subSurfaces.removeAll(windowSurface);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
if (parent) {
|
|
|
|
QWidgetBackingStore *newBs = parent->d_func()->maybeBackingStore();
|
|
|
|
if (newBs)
|
|
|
|
newBs->subSurfaces.append(windowSurface);
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
#endif
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
if (QWidgetBackingStore *oldBs = oldtlw->d_func()->maybeBackingStore()) {
|
|
|
|
if (newParent)
|
|
|
|
oldBs->removeDirtyWidget(this);
|
|
|
|
// Move the widget and all its static children from
|
|
|
|
// the old backing store to the new one.
|
|
|
|
oldBs->moveStaticWidgets(this);
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
if ((QApplicationPrivate::app_compile_version < 0x040200
|
|
|
|
|| QApplicationPrivate::testAttribute(Qt::AA_ImmediateWidgetCreation))
|
|
|
|
&& !testAttribute(Qt::WA_WState_Created))
|
|
|
|
create();
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
d->reparentFocusWidgets(oldtlw);
|
|
|
|
setAttribute(Qt::WA_Resized, resized);
|
|
|
|
if (!testAttribute(Qt::WA_StyleSheet)
|
|
|
|
&& (!parent || !parent->testAttribute(Qt::WA_StyleSheet))) {
|
|
|
|
d->resolveFont();
|
|
|
|
d->resolvePalette();
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
d->resolveLayoutDirection();
|
|
|
|
d->resolveLocale();
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
// Note: GL widgets under WGL or EGL will always need a ParentChange
|
|
|
|
// event to handle recreation/rebinding of the GL context, hence the
|
|
|
|
// (f & Qt::MSWindowsOwnDC) clause (which is set on QGLWidgets on all
|
|
|
|
// platforms).
|
|
|
|
if (newParent
|
|
|
|
#if defined(Q_WS_WIN) || defined(QT_OPENGL_ES)
|
|
|
|
|| (f & Qt::MSWindowsOwnDC)
|
|
|
|
#endif
|
|
|
|
) {
|
|
|
|
// propagate enabled updates enabled state to non-windows
|
|
|
|
if (!isWindow()) {
|
|
|
|
if (!testAttribute(Qt::WA_ForceDisabled))
|
|
|
|
d->setEnabled_helper(parent ? parent->isEnabled() : true);
|
|
|
|
if (!testAttribute(Qt::WA_ForceUpdatesDisabled))
|
|
|
|
d->setUpdatesEnabled_helper(parent ? parent->updatesEnabled() : true);
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
d->inheritStyle();
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
// send and post remaining QObject events
|
|
|
|
if (parent && d->sendChildEvents) {
|
|
|
|
QChildEvent e(QEvent::ChildAdded, this);
|
|
|
|
QApplication::sendEvent(parent, &e);
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
//### already hidden above ---> must probably do something smart on the mac
|
|
|
|
// #ifdef Q_WS_MAC
|
|
|
|
// extern bool qt_mac_is_macdrawer(const QWidget *); //qwidget_mac.cpp
|
|
|
|
// if(!qt_mac_is_macdrawer(q)) //special case
|
|
|
|
// q->setAttribute(Qt::WA_WState_Hidden);
|
|
|
|
// #else
|
|
|
|
// q->setAttribute(Qt::WA_WState_Hidden);
|
|
|
|
//#endif
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
if (parent && d->sendChildEvents && d->polished) {
|
|
|
|
QChildEvent e(QEvent::ChildPolished, this);
|
|
|
|
QCoreApplication::sendEvent(parent, &e);
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
QEvent e(QEvent::ParentChange);
|
|
|
|
QApplication::sendEvent(this, &e);
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
if (!wasCreated) {
|
|
|
|
if (isWindow() || parentWidget()->isVisible())
|
|
|
|
setAttribute(Qt::WA_WState_Hidden, true);
|
|
|
|
else if (!testAttribute(Qt::WA_WState_ExplicitShowHide))
|
|
|
|
setAttribute(Qt::WA_WState_Hidden, false);
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
d->updateIsOpaque();
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
#ifndef QT_NO_GRAPHICSVIEW
|
|
|
|
// Embed the widget into a proxy if the parent is embedded.
|
|
|
|
// ### Doesn't handle reparenting out of an embedded widget.
|
|
|
|
if (oldtlw->graphicsProxyWidget()) {
|
|
|
|
if (QGraphicsProxyWidget *ancestorProxy = d->nearestGraphicsProxyWidget(oldtlw))
|
|
|
|
ancestorProxy->d_func()->unembedSubWindow(this);
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if (isWindow() && parent && !graphicsProxyWidget() && !bypassGraphicsProxyWidget(this)) {
|
|
|
|
if (QGraphicsProxyWidget *ancestorProxy = d->nearestGraphicsProxyWidget(parent))
|
|
|
|
ancestorProxy->d_func()->embedSubWindow(this);
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
#endif
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
d->inSetParent = false;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/*!
|
|
|
|
Scrolls the widget including its children \a dx pixels to the
|
|
|
|
right and \a dy downward. Both \a dx and \a dy may be negative.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
After scrolling, the widgets will receive paint events for
|
|
|
|
the areas that need to be repainted. For widgets that Qt knows to
|
|
|
|
be opaque, this is only the newly exposed parts.
|
|
|
|
For example, if an opaque widget is scrolled 8 pixels to the left,
|
|
|
|
only an 8-pixel wide stripe at the right edge needs updating.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Since widgets propagate the contents of their parents by default,
|
|
|
|
you need to set the \l autoFillBackground property, or use
|
|
|
|
setAttribute() to set the Qt::WA_OpaquePaintEvent attribute, to make
|
|
|
|
a widget opaque.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
For widgets that use contents propagation, a scroll will cause an
|
|
|
|
update of the entire scroll area.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
\sa {Transparency and Double Buffering}
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
void QWidget::scroll(int dx, int dy)
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
if ((!updatesEnabled() && children().size() == 0) || !isVisible())
|
|
|
|
return;
|
|
|
|
if (dx == 0 && dy == 0)
|
|
|
|
return;
|
|
|
|
Q_D(QWidget);
|
|
|
|
#ifndef QT_NO_GRAPHICSVIEW
|
|
|
|
if (QGraphicsProxyWidget *proxy = QWidgetPrivate::nearestGraphicsProxyWidget(this)) {
|
|
|
|
// Graphics View maintains its own dirty region as a list of rects;
|
|
|
|
// until we can connect item updates directly to the view, we must
|
|
|
|
// separately add a translated dirty region.
|
|
|
|
if (!d->dirty.isEmpty()) {
|
|
|
|
foreach (const QRect &rect, (d->dirty.translated(dx, dy)).rects())
|
|
|
|
proxy->update(rect);
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
proxy->scroll(dx, dy, proxy->subWidgetRect(this));
|
|
|
|
return;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
#endif
|
|
|
|
d->setDirtyOpaqueRegion();
|
|
|
|
d->scroll_sys(dx, dy);
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/*!
|
|
|
|
\overload
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
This version only scrolls \a r and does not move the children of
|
|
|
|
the widget.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
If \a r is empty or invalid, the result is undefined.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
\sa QScrollArea
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
void QWidget::scroll(int dx, int dy, const QRect &r)
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
if ((!updatesEnabled() && children().size() == 0) || !isVisible())
|
|
|
|
return;
|
|
|
|
if (dx == 0 && dy == 0)
|
|
|
|
return;
|
|
|
|
Q_D(QWidget);
|
|
|
|
#ifndef QT_NO_GRAPHICSVIEW
|
|
|
|
if (QGraphicsProxyWidget *proxy = QWidgetPrivate::nearestGraphicsProxyWidget(this)) {
|
|
|
|
// Graphics View maintains its own dirty region as a list of rects;
|
|
|
|
// until we can connect item updates directly to the view, we must
|
|
|
|
// separately add a translated dirty region.
|
|
|
|
if (!d->dirty.isEmpty()) {
|
|
|
|
foreach (const QRect &rect, (d->dirty.translated(dx, dy) & r).rects())
|
|
|
|
proxy->update(rect);
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
proxy->scroll(dx, dy, r.translated(proxy->subWidgetRect(this).topLeft().toPoint()));
|
|
|
|
return;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
#endif
|
|
|
|
d->scroll_sys(dx, dy, r);
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/*!
|
|
|
|
Repaints the widget directly by calling paintEvent() immediately,
|
|
|
|
unless updates are disabled or the widget is hidden.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
We suggest only using repaint() if you need an immediate repaint,
|
|
|
|
for example during animation. In almost all circumstances update()
|
|
|
|
is better, as it permits Qt to optimize for speed and minimize
|
|
|
|
flicker.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
\warning If you call repaint() in a function which may itself be
|
|
|
|
called from paintEvent(), you may get infinite recursion. The
|
|
|
|
update() function never causes recursion.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
\sa update(), paintEvent(), setUpdatesEnabled()
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
void QWidget::repaint()
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
repaint(rect());
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/*! \overload
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
This version repaints a rectangle (\a x, \a y, \a w, \a h) inside
|
|
|
|
the widget.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
If \a w is negative, it is replaced with \c{width() - x}, and if
|
|
|
|
\a h is negative, it is replaced width \c{height() - y}.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
void QWidget::repaint(int x, int y, int w, int h)
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
if (x > data->crect.width() || y > data->crect.height())
|
|
|
|
return;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
if (w < 0)
|
|
|
|
w = data->crect.width() - x;
|
|
|
|
if (h < 0)
|
|
|
|
h = data->crect.height() - y;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
repaint(QRect(x, y, w, h));
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/*! \overload
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
This version repaints a rectangle \a rect inside the widget.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
void QWidget::repaint(const QRect &rect)
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
Q_D(QWidget);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
if (testAttribute(Qt::WA_WState_ConfigPending)) {
|
|
|
|
update(rect);
|
|
|
|
return;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
if (!isVisible() || !updatesEnabled() || rect.isEmpty())
|
|
|
|
return;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
if (hasBackingStoreSupport()) {
|
|
|
|
#ifdef QT_MAC_USE_COCOA
|
|
|
|
if (qt_widget_private(this)->isInUnifiedToolbar) {
|
|
|
|
qt_widget_private(this)->unifiedSurface->renderToolbar(this, true);
|
|
|
|
return;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
#endif // QT_MAC_USE_COCOA
|
|
|
|
QTLWExtra *tlwExtra = window()->d_func()->maybeTopData();
|
|
|
|
if (tlwExtra && !tlwExtra->inTopLevelResize && tlwExtra->backingStore) {
|
|
|
|
tlwExtra->inRepaint = true;
|
|
|
|
tlwExtra->backingStore->markDirty(rect, this, true);
|
|
|
|
tlwExtra->inRepaint = false;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
} else {
|
|
|
|
d->repaint_sys(rect);
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/*!
|
|
|
|
\overload
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
This version repaints a region \a rgn inside the widget.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
void QWidget::repaint(const QRegion &rgn)
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
Q_D(QWidget);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
if (testAttribute(Qt::WA_WState_ConfigPending)) {
|
|
|
|
update(rgn);
|
|
|
|
return;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
if (!isVisible() || !updatesEnabled() || rgn.isEmpty())
|
|
|
|
return;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
if (hasBackingStoreSupport()) {
|
|
|
|
#ifdef QT_MAC_USE_COCOA
|
|
|
|
if (qt_widget_private(this)->isInUnifiedToolbar) {
|
|
|
|
qt_widget_private(this)->unifiedSurface->renderToolbar(this, true);
|
|
|
|
return;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
#endif // QT_MAC_USE_COCOA
|
|
|
|
QTLWExtra *tlwExtra = window()->d_func()->maybeTopData();
|
|
|
|
if (tlwExtra && !tlwExtra->inTopLevelResize && tlwExtra->backingStore) {
|
|
|
|
tlwExtra->inRepaint = true;
|
|
|
|
tlwExtra->backingStore->markDirty(rgn, this, true);
|
|
|
|
tlwExtra->inRepaint = false;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
} else {
|
|
|
|
d->repaint_sys(rgn);
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/*!
|
|
|
|
Updates the widget unless updates are disabled or the widget is
|
|
|
|
hidden.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
This function does not cause an immediate repaint; instead it
|
|
|
|
schedules a paint event for processing when Qt returns to the main
|
|
|
|
event loop. This permits Qt to optimize for more speed and less
|
|
|
|
flicker than a call to repaint() does.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Calling update() several times normally results in just one
|
|
|
|
paintEvent() call.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Qt normally erases the widget's area before the paintEvent() call.
|
|
|
|
If the Qt::WA_OpaquePaintEvent widget attribute is set, the widget is
|
|
|
|
responsible for painting all its pixels with an opaque color.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
\sa repaint() paintEvent(), setUpdatesEnabled(), {Analog Clock Example}
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
void QWidget::update()
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
update(rect());
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/*! \fn void QWidget::update(int x, int y, int w, int h)
|
|
|
|
\overload
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
This version updates a rectangle (\a x, \a y, \a w, \a h) inside
|
|
|
|
the widget.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/*!
|
|
|
|
\overload
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
This version updates a rectangle \a rect inside the widget.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
void QWidget::update(const QRect &rect)
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
if (!isVisible() || !updatesEnabled())
|
|
|
|
return;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
QRect r = rect & QWidget::rect();
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
if (r.isEmpty())
|
|
|
|
return;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
if (testAttribute(Qt::WA_WState_InPaintEvent)) {
|
|
|
|
QApplication::postEvent(this, new QUpdateLaterEvent(r));
|
|
|
|
return;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
if (hasBackingStoreSupport()) {
|
|
|
|
#ifdef QT_MAC_USE_COCOA
|
|
|
|
if (qt_widget_private(this)->isInUnifiedToolbar) {
|
|
|
|
qt_widget_private(this)->unifiedSurface->renderToolbar(this, true);
|
|
|
|
return;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
#endif // QT_MAC_USE_COCOA
|
|
|
|
QTLWExtra *tlwExtra = window()->d_func()->maybeTopData();
|
|
|
|
if (tlwExtra && !tlwExtra->inTopLevelResize && tlwExtra->backingStore)
|
|
|
|
tlwExtra->backingStore->markDirty(r, this);
|
|
|
|
} else {
|
|
|
|
d_func()->repaint_sys(r);
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/*!
|
|
|
|
\overload
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
This version repaints a region \a rgn inside the widget.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
void QWidget::update(const QRegion &rgn)
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
if (!isVisible() || !updatesEnabled() || rgn.isEmpty())
|
|
|
|
return;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
QRegion r = rgn & QWidget::rect();
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
if (r.isEmpty())
|
|
|
|
return;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
if (testAttribute(Qt::WA_WState_InPaintEvent)) {
|
|
|
|
QApplication::postEvent(this, new QUpdateLaterEvent(r));
|
|
|
|
return;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
if (hasBackingStoreSupport()) {
|
|
|
|
#ifdef QT_MAC_USE_COCOA
|
|
|
|
if (qt_widget_private(this)->isInUnifiedToolbar) {
|
|
|
|
qt_widget_private(this)->unifiedSurface->renderToolbar(this, true);
|
|
|
|
return;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
#endif // QT_MAC_USE_COCOA
|
|
|
|
QTLWExtra *tlwExtra = window()->d_func()->maybeTopData();
|
|
|
|
if (tlwExtra && !tlwExtra->inTopLevelResize && tlwExtra->backingStore)
|
|
|
|
tlwExtra->backingStore->markDirty(r, this);
|
|
|
|
} else {
|
|
|
|
d_func()->repaint_sys(r);
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/*!
|
|
|
|
\internal
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
This just sets the corresponding attribute bit to 1 or 0
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
static void setAttribute_internal(Qt::WidgetAttribute attribute, bool on, QWidgetData *data,
|
|
|
|
QWidgetPrivate *d)
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
if (attribute < int(8*sizeof(uint))) {
|
|
|
|
if (on)
|
|
|
|
data->widget_attributes |= (1<<attribute);
|
|
|
|
else
|
|
|
|
data->widget_attributes &= ~(1<<attribute);
|
|
|
|
} else {
|
|
|
|
const int x = attribute - 8*sizeof(uint);
|
|
|
|
const int int_off = x / (8*sizeof(uint));
|
|
|
|
if (on)
|
|
|
|
d->high_attributes[int_off] |= (1<<(x-(int_off*8*sizeof(uint))));
|
|
|
|
else
|
|
|
|
d->high_attributes[int_off] &= ~(1<<(x-(int_off*8*sizeof(uint))));
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/*!
|
|
|
|
Sets the attribute \a attribute on this widget if \a on is true;
|
|
|
|
otherwise clears the attribute.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
\sa testAttribute()
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
void QWidget::setAttribute(Qt::WidgetAttribute attribute, bool on)
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
if (testAttribute(attribute) == on)
|
|
|
|
return;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Q_D(QWidget);
|
|
|
|
Q_ASSERT_X(sizeof(d->high_attributes)*8 >= (Qt::WA_AttributeCount - sizeof(uint)*8),
|
|
|
|
"QWidget::setAttribute(WidgetAttribute, bool)",
|
|
|
|
"QWidgetPrivate::high_attributes[] too small to contain all attributes in WidgetAttribute");
|
|
|
|
#ifdef Q_WS_WIN
|
|
|
|
// ### Don't use PaintOnScreen+paintEngine() to do native painting in 5.0
|
|
|
|
if (attribute == Qt::WA_PaintOnScreen && on && !inherits("QGLWidget")) {
|
|
|
|
// see qwidget_win.cpp, ::paintEngine for details
|
|
|
|
paintEngine();
|
|
|
|
if (d->noPaintOnScreen)
|
|
|
|
return;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
#endif
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
setAttribute_internal(attribute, on, data, d);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
switch (attribute) {
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
#ifndef QT_NO_DRAGANDDROP
|
|
|
|
case Qt::WA_AcceptDrops: {
|
|
|
|
if (on && !testAttribute(Qt::WA_DropSiteRegistered))
|
|
|
|
setAttribute(Qt::WA_DropSiteRegistered, true);
|
|
|
|
else if (!on && (isWindow() || !parentWidget() || !parentWidget()->testAttribute(Qt::WA_DropSiteRegistered)))
|
|
|
|
setAttribute(Qt::WA_DropSiteRegistered, false);
|
|
|
|
QEvent e(QEvent::AcceptDropsChange);
|
|
|
|
QApplication::sendEvent(this, &e);
|
|
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
case Qt::WA_DropSiteRegistered: {
|
|
|
|
d->registerDropSite(on);
|
|
|
|
for (int i = 0; i < d->children.size(); ++i) {
|
|
|
|
QWidget *w = qobject_cast<QWidget *>(d->children.at(i));
|
|
|
|
if (w && !w->isWindow() && !w->testAttribute(Qt::WA_AcceptDrops) && w->testAttribute(Qt::WA_DropSiteRegistered) != on)
|
|
|
|
w->setAttribute(Qt::WA_DropSiteRegistered, on);
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
#endif
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
case Qt::WA_NoChildEventsForParent:
|
|
|
|
d->sendChildEvents = !on;
|
|
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
case Qt::WA_NoChildEventsFromChildren:
|
|
|
|
d->receiveChildEvents = !on;
|
|
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
case Qt::WA_MacBrushedMetal:
|
|
|
|
#ifdef Q_WS_MAC
|
|
|
|
d->setStyle_helper(style(), false, true); // Make sure things get unpolished/polished correctly.
|
|
|
|
// fall through since changing the metal attribute affects the opaque size grip.
|
|
|
|
case Qt::WA_MacOpaqueSizeGrip:
|
|
|
|
d->macUpdateOpaqueSizeGrip();
|
|
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
case Qt::WA_MacShowFocusRect:
|
|
|
|
if (hasFocus()) {
|
|
|
|
clearFocus();
|
|
|
|
setFocus();
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
case Qt::WA_Hover:
|
|
|
|
qt_mac_update_mouseTracking(this);
|
|
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
#endif
|
|
|
|
case Qt::WA_MacAlwaysShowToolWindow:
|
|
|
|
#ifdef Q_WS_MAC
|
|
|
|
d->macUpdateHideOnSuspend();
|
|
|
|
#endif
|
|
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
case Qt::WA_MacNormalSize:
|
|
|
|
case Qt::WA_MacSmallSize:
|
|
|
|
case Qt::WA_MacMiniSize:
|
|
|
|
#ifdef Q_WS_MAC
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
// We can only have one of these set at a time
|
|
|
|
const Qt::WidgetAttribute MacSizes[] = { Qt::WA_MacNormalSize, Qt::WA_MacSmallSize,
|
|
|
|
Qt::WA_MacMiniSize };
|
|
|
|
for (int i = 0; i < 3; ++i) {
|
|
|
|
if (MacSizes[i] != attribute)
|
|
|
|
setAttribute_internal(MacSizes[i], false, data, d);
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
d->macUpdateSizeAttribute();
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
#endif
|
|
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
case Qt::WA_ShowModal:
|
|
|
|
if (!on) {
|
|
|
|
if (isVisible())
|
|
|
|
QApplicationPrivate::leaveModal(this);
|
|
|
|
// reset modality type to Modeless when clearing WA_ShowModal
|
|
|
|
data->window_modality = Qt::NonModal;
|
|
|
|
} else if (data->window_modality == Qt::NonModal) {
|
|
|
|
// determine the modality type if it hasn't been set prior
|
|
|
|
// to setting WA_ShowModal. set the default to WindowModal
|
|
|
|
// if we are the child of a group leader; otherwise use
|
|
|
|
// ApplicationModal.
|
|
|
|
QWidget *w = parentWidget();
|
|
|
|
if (w)
|
|
|
|
w = w->window();
|
|
|
|
while (w && !w->testAttribute(Qt::WA_GroupLeader)) {
|
|
|
|
w = w->parentWidget();
|
|
|
|
if (w)
|
|
|
|
w = w->window();
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
data->window_modality = (w && w->testAttribute(Qt::WA_GroupLeader))
|
|
|
|
? Qt::WindowModal
|
|
|
|
: Qt::ApplicationModal;
|
|
|
|
// Some window managers does not allow us to enter modal after the
|
|
|
|
// window is showing. Therefore, to be consistent, we cannot call
|
|
|
|
// QApplicationPrivate::enterModal(this) here. The window must be
|
|
|
|
// hidden before changing modality.
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if (testAttribute(Qt::WA_WState_Created)) {
|
|
|
|
// don't call setModal_sys() before create_sys()
|
|
|
|
d->setModal_sys();
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
case Qt::WA_MouseTracking: {
|
|
|
|
QEvent e(QEvent::MouseTrackingChange);
|
|
|
|
QApplication::sendEvent(this, &e);
|
|
|
|
break; }
|
|
|
|
case Qt::WA_NativeWindow: {
|
|
|
|
#ifndef QT_NO_IM
|
|
|
|
QWidget *focusWidget = d->effectiveFocusWidget();
|
|
|
|
QInputContext *ic = 0;
|
|
|
|
if (on && !internalWinId() && hasFocus()
|
|
|
|
&& focusWidget->testAttribute(Qt::WA_InputMethodEnabled)) {
|
|
|
|
ic = focusWidget->d_func()->inputContext();
|
|
|
|
if (ic) {
|
|
|
|
ic->reset();
|
|
|
|
ic->setFocusWidget(0);
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if (!qApp->testAttribute(Qt::AA_DontCreateNativeWidgetSiblings) && parentWidget()
|
|
|
|
#if defined(Q_WS_MAC) && defined(QT_MAC_USE_COCOA)
|
|
|
|
// On Mac, toolbars inside the unified title bar will never overlap with
|
|
|
|
// siblings in the content view. So we skip enforce native siblings in that case
|
|
|
|
&& !d->isInUnifiedToolbar && parentWidget()->isWindow()
|
|
|
|
#endif // Q_WS_MAC && QT_MAC_USE_COCOA
|
|
|
|
)
|
|
|
|
parentWidget()->d_func()->enforceNativeChildren();
|
|
|
|
if (on && !internalWinId() && testAttribute(Qt::WA_WState_Created))
|
|
|
|
d->createWinId();
|
|
|
|
if (ic && isEnabled() && focusWidget->isEnabled()
|
|
|
|
&& focusWidget->testAttribute(Qt::WA_InputMethodEnabled)) {
|
|
|
|
ic->setFocusWidget(focusWidget);
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
#endif //QT_NO_IM
|
|
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
case Qt::WA_PaintOnScreen:
|
|
|
|
d->updateIsOpaque();
|
|
|
|
#if defined(Q_WS_WIN) || defined(Q_WS_X11) || defined(Q_WS_MAC)
|
|
|
|
// Recreate the widget if it's already created as an alien widget and
|
|
|
|
// WA_PaintOnScreen is enabled. Paint on screen widgets must have win id.
|
|
|
|
// So must their children.
|
|
|
|
if (on) {
|
|
|
|
setAttribute(Qt::WA_NativeWindow);
|
|
|
|
d->enforceNativeChildren();
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
#endif
|
|
|
|
// fall through
|
|
|
|
case Qt::WA_OpaquePaintEvent:
|
|
|
|
d->updateIsOpaque();
|
|
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
case Qt::WA_NoSystemBackground:
|
|
|
|
d->updateIsOpaque();
|
|
|
|
// fall through...
|
|
|
|
case Qt::WA_UpdatesDisabled:
|
|
|
|
d->updateSystemBackground();
|
|
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
case Qt::WA_TransparentForMouseEvents:
|
|
|
|
#ifdef Q_WS_MAC
|
|
|
|
d->macUpdateIgnoreMouseEvents();
|
|
|
|
#endif
|
|
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
case Qt::WA_InputMethodEnabled: {
|
|
|
|
#ifndef QT_NO_IM
|
|
|
|
QWidget *focusWidget = d->effectiveFocusWidget();
|
|
|
|
QInputContext *ic = focusWidget->d_func()->assignedInputContext();
|
|
|
|
if (!ic && (!on || hasFocus()))
|
|
|
|
ic = focusWidget->d_func()->inputContext();
|
|
|
|
if (ic) {
|
|
|
|
if (on && hasFocus() && ic->focusWidget() != focusWidget && isEnabled()
|
|
|
|
&& focusWidget->testAttribute(Qt::WA_InputMethodEnabled)) {
|
|
|
|
ic->setFocusWidget(focusWidget);
|
|
|
|
} else if (!on && ic->focusWidget() == focusWidget) {
|
|
|
|
ic->reset();
|
|
|
|
ic->setFocusWidget(0);
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
#endif //QT_NO_IM
|
|
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
case Qt::WA_WindowPropagation:
|
|
|
|
d->resolvePalette();
|
|
|
|
d->resolveFont();
|
|
|
|
d->resolveLocale();
|
|
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
#ifdef Q_WS_X11
|
|
|
|
case Qt::WA_NoX11EventCompression:
|
|
|
|
if (!d->extra)
|
|
|
|
d->createExtra();
|
|
|
|
d->extra->compress_events = on;
|
|
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
case Qt::WA_X11OpenGLOverlay:
|
|
|
|
d->updateIsOpaque();
|
|
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
case Qt::WA_X11DoNotAcceptFocus:
|
|
|
|
if (testAttribute(Qt::WA_WState_Created))
|
|
|
|
d->updateX11AcceptFocus();
|
|
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
#endif
|
|
|
|
case Qt::WA_DontShowOnScreen: {
|
|
|
|
if (on && isVisible()) {
|
|
|
|
// Make sure we keep the current state and only hide the widget
|
|
|
|
// from the desktop. show_sys will only update platform specific
|
|
|
|
// attributes at this point.
|
|
|
|
d->hide_sys();
|
|
|
|
d->show_sys();
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
#ifdef Q_WS_X11
|
|
|
|
case Qt::WA_X11NetWmWindowTypeDesktop:
|
|
|
|
case Qt::WA_X11NetWmWindowTypeDock:
|
|
|
|
case Qt::WA_X11NetWmWindowTypeToolBar:
|
|
|
|
case Qt::WA_X11NetWmWindowTypeMenu:
|
|
|
|
case Qt::WA_X11NetWmWindowTypeUtility:
|
|
|
|
case Qt::WA_X11NetWmWindowTypeSplash:
|
|
|
|
case Qt::WA_X11NetWmWindowTypeDialog:
|
|
|
|
case Qt::WA_X11NetWmWindowTypeDropDownMenu:
|
|
|
|
case Qt::WA_X11NetWmWindowTypePopupMenu:
|
|
|
|
case Qt::WA_X11NetWmWindowTypeToolTip:
|
|
|
|
case Qt::WA_X11NetWmWindowTypeNotification:
|
|
|
|
case Qt::WA_X11NetWmWindowTypeCombo:
|
|
|
|
case Qt::WA_X11NetWmWindowTypeDND:
|
|
|
|
if (testAttribute(Qt::WA_WState_Created))
|
|
|
|
d->setNetWmWindowTypes();
|
|
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
#endif
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
case Qt::WA_StaticContents:
|
|
|
|
if (QWidgetBackingStore *bs = d->maybeBackingStore()) {
|
|
|
|
if (on)
|
|
|
|
bs->addStaticWidget(this);
|
|
|
|
else
|
|
|
|
bs->removeStaticWidget(this);
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
case Qt::WA_TranslucentBackground:
|
|
|
|
if (on) {
|
|
|
|
setAttribute(Qt::WA_NoSystemBackground);
|
|
|
|
d->updateIsTranslucent();
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
case Qt::WA_AcceptTouchEvents:
|
|
|
|
#if defined(Q_WS_WIN) || defined(Q_WS_MAC)
|
|
|
|
if (on)
|
|
|
|
d->registerTouchWindow();
|
|
|
|
#endif
|
|
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
case Qt::WA_LockPortraitOrientation:
|
|
|
|
case Qt::WA_LockLandscapeOrientation:
|
|
|
|
case Qt::WA_AutoOrientation: {
|
|
|
|
const Qt::WidgetAttribute orientations[3] = {
|
|
|
|
Qt::WA_LockPortraitOrientation,
|
|
|
|
Qt::WA_LockLandscapeOrientation,
|
|
|
|
Qt::WA_AutoOrientation
|
|
|
|
};
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
if (on) {
|
|
|
|
// We can only have one of these set at a time
|
|
|
|
for (int i = 0; i < 3; ++i) {
|
|
|
|
if (orientations[i] != attribute)
|
|
|
|
setAttribute_internal(orientations[i], false, data, d);
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
#ifdef Q_OS_BLACKBERRY
|
|
|
|
if (testAttribute(Qt::WA_AutoOrientation)) {
|
|
|
|
navigator_rotation_lock(false);
|
|
|
|
} else {
|
|
|
|
#ifdef Q_OS_BLACKBERRY_TABLET
|
|
|
|
const bool portraitLocked = testAttribute(Qt::WA_LockPortraitOrientation);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
orientation_direction_t direction;
|
|
|
|
orientation_get(&direction, 0);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
int rotation = 0;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
switch (direction) {
|
|
|
|
case ORIENTATION_TOP_UP:
|
|
|
|
case ORIENTATION_RIGHT_UP:
|
|
|
|
rotation = portraitLocked ? 90 : 0;
|
|
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
case ORIENTATION_BOTTOM_UP:
|
|
|
|
case ORIENTATION_LEFT_UP:
|
|
|
|
rotation = portraitLocked ? 270 : 180;
|
|
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
default:
|
|
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
navigator_set_orientation(rotation, 0);
|
|
|
|
#else
|
|
|
|
navigator_set_orientation_mode((testAttribute(Qt::WA_LockPortraitOrientation) ?
|
|
|
|
NAVIGATOR_PORTRAIT : NAVIGATOR_LANDSCAPE), 0);
|
|
|
|
#endif // Q_OS_BLACKBERRY_TABLET
|
|
|
|
navigator_rotation_lock(true);
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
#endif // Q_OS_BLACKBERRY
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
default:
|
|
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/*! \fn bool QWidget::testAttribute(Qt::WidgetAttribute attribute) const
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Returns true if attribute \a attribute is set on this widget;
|
|
|
|
otherwise returns false.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
\sa setAttribute()
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
bool QWidget::testAttribute_helper(Qt::WidgetAttribute attribute) const
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
Q_D(const QWidget);
|
|
|
|
const int x = attribute - 8*sizeof(uint);
|
|
|
|
const int int_off = x / (8*sizeof(uint));
|
|
|
|
return (d->high_attributes[int_off] & (1<<(x-(int_off*8*sizeof(uint)))));
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/*!
|
|
|
|
\property QWidget::windowOpacity
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
\brief The level of opacity for the window.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
The valid range of opacity is from 1.0 (completely opaque) to
|
|
|
|
0.0 (completely transparent).
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
By default the value of this property is 1.0.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
This feature is available on Embedded Linux, Mac OS X, Windows,
|
|
|
|
and X11 platforms that support the Composite extension.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
This feature is not available on Windows CE.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Note that under X11 you need to have a composite manager running,
|
|
|
|
and the X11 specific _NET_WM_WINDOW_OPACITY atom needs to be
|
|
|
|
supported by the window manager you are using.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
\warning Changing this property from opaque to transparent might issue a
|
|
|
|
paint event that needs to be processed before the window is displayed
|
|
|
|
correctly. This affects mainly the use of QPixmap::grabWindow(). Also note
|
|
|
|
that semi-transparent windows update and resize significantly slower than
|
|
|
|
opaque windows.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
\sa setMask()
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
qreal QWidget::windowOpacity() const
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
Q_D(const QWidget);
|
|
|
|
return (isWindow() && d->maybeTopData()) ? d->maybeTopData()->opacity / qreal(255.) : qreal(1.0);
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
void QWidget::setWindowOpacity(qreal opacity)
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
Q_D(QWidget);
|
|
|
|
if (!isWindow())
|
|
|
|
return;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
opacity = qBound(qreal(0.0), opacity, qreal(1.0));
|
|
|
|
QTLWExtra *extra = d->topData();
|
|
|
|
extra->opacity = uint(opacity * 255);
|
|
|
|
setAttribute(Qt::WA_WState_WindowOpacitySet);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
if (!testAttribute(Qt::WA_WState_Created))
|
|
|
|
return;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
#ifndef QT_NO_GRAPHICSVIEW
|
|
|
|
if (QGraphicsProxyWidget *proxy = graphicsProxyWidget()) {
|
|
|
|
// Avoid invalidating the cache if set.
|
|
|
|
if (proxy->cacheMode() == QGraphicsItem::NoCache)
|
|
|
|
proxy->update();
|
|
|
|
else if (QGraphicsScene *scene = proxy->scene())
|
|
|
|
scene->update(proxy->sceneBoundingRect());
|
|
|
|
return;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
#endif
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
d->setWindowOpacity_sys(opacity);
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/*!
|
|
|
|
\property QWidget::windowModified
|
|
|
|
\brief whether the document shown in the window has unsaved changes
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
A modified window is a window whose content has changed but has
|
|
|
|
not been saved to disk. This flag will have different effects
|
|
|
|
varied by the platform. On Mac OS X the close button will have a
|
|
|
|
modified look; on other platforms, the window title will have an
|
|
|
|
'*' (asterisk).
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
The window title must contain a "[*]" placeholder, which
|
|
|
|
indicates where the '*' should appear. Normally, it should appear
|
|
|
|
right after the file name (e.g., "document1.txt[*] - Text
|
|
|
|
Editor"). If the window isn't modified, the placeholder is simply
|
|
|
|
removed.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Note that if a widget is set as modified, all its ancestors will
|
|
|
|
also be set as modified. However, if you call \c
|
|
|
|
{setWindowModified(false)} on a widget, this will not propagate to
|
|
|
|
its parent because other children of the parent might have been
|
|
|
|
modified.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
\sa windowTitle, {Application Example}, {SDI Example}, {MDI Example}
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
bool QWidget::isWindowModified() const
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
return testAttribute(Qt::WA_WindowModified);
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
void QWidget::setWindowModified(bool mod)
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
Q_D(QWidget);
|
|
|
|
setAttribute(Qt::WA_WindowModified, mod);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
#ifndef Q_WS_MAC
|
|
|
|
if (!windowTitle().contains(QLatin1String("[*]")) && mod)
|
|
|
|
qWarning("QWidget::setWindowModified: The window title does not contain a '[*]' placeholder");
|
|
|
|
#endif
|
|
|
|
d->setWindowTitle_helper(windowTitle());
|
|
|
|
d->setWindowIconText_helper(windowIconText());
|
|
|
|
#ifdef Q_WS_MAC
|
|
|
|
d->setWindowModified_sys(mod);
|
|
|
|
#endif
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
QEvent e(QEvent::ModifiedChange);
|
|
|
|
QApplication::sendEvent(this, &e);
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
#ifndef QT_NO_TOOLTIP
|
|
|
|
/*!
|
|
|
|
\property QWidget::toolTip
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
\brief the widget's tooltip
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Note that by default tooltips are only shown for widgets that are
|
|
|
|
children of the active window. You can change this behavior by
|
|
|
|
setting the attribute Qt::WA_AlwaysShowToolTips on the \e window,
|
|
|
|
not on the widget with the tooltip.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
If you want to control a tooltip's behavior, you can intercept the
|
|
|
|
event() function and catch the QEvent::ToolTip event (e.g., if you
|
|
|
|
want to customize the area for which the tooltip should be shown).
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
By default, this property contains an empty string.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
\sa QToolTip statusTip whatsThis
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
void QWidget::setToolTip(const QString &s)
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
Q_D(QWidget);
|
|
|
|
d->toolTip = s;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
QEvent event(QEvent::ToolTipChange);
|
|
|
|
QApplication::sendEvent(this, &event);
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
QString QWidget::toolTip() const
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
Q_D(const QWidget);
|
|
|
|
return d->toolTip;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
#endif // QT_NO_TOOLTIP
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
#ifndef QT_NO_STATUSTIP
|
|
|
|
/*!
|
|
|
|
\property QWidget::statusTip
|
|
|
|
\brief the widget's status tip
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
By default, this property contains an empty string.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
\sa toolTip whatsThis
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
void QWidget::setStatusTip(const QString &s)
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
Q_D(QWidget);
|
|
|
|
d->statusTip = s;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
QString QWidget::statusTip() const
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
Q_D(const QWidget);
|
|
|
|
return d->statusTip;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
#endif // QT_NO_STATUSTIP
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
#ifndef QT_NO_WHATSTHIS
|
|
|
|
/*!
|
|
|
|
\property QWidget::whatsThis
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
\brief the widget's What's This help text.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
By default, this property contains an empty string.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
\sa QWhatsThis QWidget::toolTip QWidget::statusTip
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
void QWidget::setWhatsThis(const QString &s)
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
Q_D(QWidget);
|
|
|
|
d->whatsThis = s;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
QString QWidget::whatsThis() const
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
Q_D(const QWidget);
|
|
|
|
return d->whatsThis;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
#endif // QT_NO_WHATSTHIS
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
#ifndef QT_NO_ACCESSIBILITY
|
|
|
|
/*!
|
|
|
|
\property QWidget::accessibleName
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
\brief the widget's name as seen by assistive technologies
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
This property is used by accessible clients to identify, find, or announce
|
|
|
|
the widget for accessible clients.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
By default, this property contains an empty string.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
\sa QAccessibleInterface::text()
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
void QWidget::setAccessibleName(const QString &name)
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
Q_D(QWidget);
|
|
|
|
d->accessibleName = name;
|
|
|
|
QAccessible::updateAccessibility(this, 0, QAccessible::NameChanged);
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
QString QWidget::accessibleName() const
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
Q_D(const QWidget);
|
|
|
|
return d->accessibleName;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/*!
|
|
|
|
\property QWidget::accessibleDescription
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
\brief the widget's description as seen by assistive technologies
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
By default, this property contains an empty string.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
\sa QAccessibleInterface::text()
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
void QWidget::setAccessibleDescription(const QString &description)
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
Q_D(QWidget);
|
|
|
|
d->accessibleDescription = description;
|
|
|
|
QAccessible::updateAccessibility(this, 0, QAccessible::DescriptionChanged);
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
QString QWidget::accessibleDescription() const
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
Q_D(const QWidget);
|
|
|
|
return d->accessibleDescription;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
#endif // QT_NO_ACCESSIBILITY
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
#ifndef QT_NO_SHORTCUT
|
|
|
|
/*!
|
|
|
|
Adds a shortcut to Qt's shortcut system that watches for the given
|
|
|
|
\a key sequence in the given \a context. If the \a context is
|
|
|
|
Qt::ApplicationShortcut, the shortcut applies to the application as a
|
|
|
|
whole. Otherwise, it is either local to this widget, Qt::WidgetShortcut,
|
|
|
|
or to the window itself, Qt::WindowShortcut.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
If the same \a key sequence has been grabbed by several widgets,
|
|
|
|
when the \a key sequence occurs a QEvent::Shortcut event is sent
|
|
|
|
to all the widgets to which it applies in a non-deterministic
|
|
|
|
order, but with the ``ambiguous'' flag set to true.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
\warning You should not normally need to use this function;
|
|
|
|
instead create \l{QAction}s with the shortcut key sequences you
|
|
|
|
require (if you also want equivalent menu options and toolbar
|
|
|
|
buttons), or create \l{QShortcut}s if you just need key sequences.
|
|
|
|
Both QAction and QShortcut handle all the event filtering for you,
|
|
|
|
and provide signals which are triggered when the user triggers the
|
|
|
|
key sequence, so are much easier to use than this low-level
|
|
|
|
function.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
\sa releaseShortcut() setShortcutEnabled()
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
int QWidget::grabShortcut(const QKeySequence &key, Qt::ShortcutContext context)
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
Q_ASSERT(qApp);
|
|
|
|
if (key.isEmpty())
|
|
|
|
return 0;
|
|
|
|
setAttribute(Qt::WA_GrabbedShortcut);
|
|
|
|
return qApp->d_func()->shortcutMap.addShortcut(this, key, context);
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/*!
|
|
|
|
Removes the shortcut with the given \a id from Qt's shortcut
|
|
|
|
system. The widget will no longer receive QEvent::Shortcut events
|
|
|
|
for the shortcut's key sequence (unless it has other shortcuts
|
|
|
|
with the same key sequence).
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
\warning You should not normally need to use this function since
|
|
|
|
Qt's shortcut system removes shortcuts automatically when their
|
|
|
|
parent widget is destroyed. It is best to use QAction or
|
|
|
|
QShortcut to handle shortcuts, since they are easier to use than
|
|
|
|
this low-level function. Note also that this is an expensive
|
|
|
|
operation.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
\sa grabShortcut() setShortcutEnabled()
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
void QWidget::releaseShortcut(int id)
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
Q_ASSERT(qApp);
|
|
|
|
if (id)
|
|
|
|
qApp->d_func()->shortcutMap.removeShortcut(id, this, 0);
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/*!
|
|
|
|
If \a enable is true, the shortcut with the given \a id is
|
|
|
|
enabled; otherwise the shortcut is disabled.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
\warning You should not normally need to use this function since
|
|
|
|
Qt's shortcut system enables/disables shortcuts automatically as
|
|
|
|
widgets become hidden/visible and gain or lose focus. It is best
|
|
|
|
to use QAction or QShortcut to handle shortcuts, since they are
|
|
|
|
easier to use than this low-level function.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
\sa grabShortcut() releaseShortcut()
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
void QWidget::setShortcutEnabled(int id, bool enable)
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
Q_ASSERT(qApp);
|
|
|
|
if (id)
|
|
|
|
qApp->d_func()->shortcutMap.setShortcutEnabled(enable, id, this, 0);
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/*!
|
|
|
|
\since 4.2
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
If \a enable is true, auto repeat of the shortcut with the
|
|
|
|
given \a id is enabled; otherwise it is disabled.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
\sa grabShortcut() releaseShortcut()
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
void QWidget::setShortcutAutoRepeat(int id, bool enable)
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
Q_ASSERT(qApp);
|
|
|
|
if (id)
|
|
|
|
qApp->d_func()->shortcutMap.setShortcutAutoRepeat(enable, id, this, 0);
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
#endif // QT_NO_SHORTCUT
|
|
|
|
/*!
|
|
|
|
Updates the widget's micro focus.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
\sa QInputContext
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
void QWidget::updateMicroFocus()
|
|
|
|
{
|
2016-06-21 16:52:02 +00:00
|
|
|
#if !defined(QT_NO_IM) && defined(Q_WS_X11)
|
2015-12-10 05:06:13 +02:00
|
|
|
Q_D(QWidget);
|
|
|
|
// and optimization to update input context only it has already been created.
|
|
|
|
if (d->assignedInputContext() || qApp->d_func()->inputContext) {
|
|
|
|
QInputContext *ic = inputContext();
|
|
|
|
if (ic)
|
|
|
|
ic->update();
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
#endif
|
|
|
|
#ifndef QT_NO_ACCESSIBILITY
|
|
|
|
if (isVisible()) {
|
|
|
|
// ##### is this correct
|
|
|
|
QAccessible::updateAccessibility(this, 0, QAccessible::StateChanged);
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
#endif
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
#if defined (Q_WS_WIN)
|
|
|
|
/*!
|
|
|
|
Returns the window system handle of the widget, for low-level
|
|
|
|
access. Using this function is not portable.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
An HDC acquired with getDC() has to be released with releaseDC().
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
\warning Using this function is not portable.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
HDC QWidget::getDC() const
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
Q_D(const QWidget);
|
|
|
|
if (d->hd)
|
|
|
|
return (HDC) d->hd;
|
|
|
|
return GetDC(winId());
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/*!
|
|
|
|
Releases the HDC \a hdc acquired by a previous call to getDC().
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
\warning Using this function is not portable.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
void QWidget::releaseDC(HDC hdc) const
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
Q_D(const QWidget);
|
|
|
|
// If its the widgets own dc, it will be released elsewhere. If
|
|
|
|
// its a different HDC we release it and issue a warning if it
|
|
|
|
// fails.
|
|
|
|
if (hdc != d->hd && !ReleaseDC(winId(), hdc))
|
|
|
|
qErrnoWarning("QWidget::releaseDC(): failed to release HDC");
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
#else
|
|
|
|
/*!
|
|
|
|
Returns the window system handle of the widget, for low-level
|
|
|
|
access. Using this function is not portable.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
The HANDLE type varies with platform; see \c qwindowdefs.h for
|
|
|
|
details.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
Qt::HANDLE QWidget::handle() const
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
Q_D(const QWidget);
|
|
|
|
if (!internalWinId() && testAttribute(Qt::WA_WState_Created))
|
|
|
|
(void)winId(); // enforce native window
|
|
|
|
return d->hd;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
#endif
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/*!
|
|
|
|
Raises this widget to the top of the parent widget's stack.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
After this call the widget will be visually in front of any
|
|
|
|
overlapping sibling widgets.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
\note When using activateWindow(), you can call this function to
|
|
|
|
ensure that the window is stacked on top.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
\sa lower(), stackUnder()
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
void QWidget::raise()
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
Q_D(QWidget);
|
|
|
|
if (!isWindow()) {
|
|
|
|
QWidget *p = parentWidget();
|
|
|
|
const int parentChildCount = p->d_func()->children.size();
|
|
|
|
if (parentChildCount < 2)
|
|
|
|
return;
|
|
|
|
const int from = p->d_func()->children.indexOf(this);
|
|
|
|
Q_ASSERT(from >= 0);
|
|
|
|
// Do nothing if the widget is already in correct stacking order _and_ created.
|
|
|
|
if (from != parentChildCount -1)
|
|
|
|
p->d_func()->children.move(from, parentChildCount - 1);
|
|
|
|
if (!testAttribute(Qt::WA_WState_Created) && p->testAttribute(Qt::WA_WState_Created))
|
|
|
|
create();
|
|
|
|
else if (from == parentChildCount - 1)
|
|
|
|
return;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
QRegion region(rect());
|
|
|
|
d->subtractOpaqueSiblings(region);
|
|
|
|
d->invalidateBuffer(region);
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if (testAttribute(Qt::WA_WState_Created))
|
|
|
|
d->raise_sys();
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
QEvent e(QEvent::ZOrderChange);
|
|
|
|
QApplication::sendEvent(this, &e);
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/*!
|
|
|
|
Lowers the widget to the bottom of the parent widget's stack.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
After this call the widget will be visually behind (and therefore
|
|
|
|
obscured by) any overlapping sibling widgets.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
\sa raise(), stackUnder()
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
void QWidget::lower()
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
Q_D(QWidget);
|
|
|
|
if (!isWindow()) {
|
|
|
|
QWidget *p = parentWidget();
|
|
|
|
const int parentChildCount = p->d_func()->children.size();
|
|
|
|
if (parentChildCount < 2)
|
|
|
|
return;
|
|
|
|
const int from = p->d_func()->children.indexOf(this);
|
|
|
|
Q_ASSERT(from >= 0);
|
|
|
|
// Do nothing if the widget is already in correct stacking order _and_ created.
|
|
|
|
if (from != 0)
|
|
|
|
p->d_func()->children.move(from, 0);
|
|
|
|
if (!testAttribute(Qt::WA_WState_Created) && p->testAttribute(Qt::WA_WState_Created))
|
|
|
|
create();
|
|
|
|
else if (from == 0)
|
|
|
|
return;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if (testAttribute(Qt::WA_WState_Created))
|
|
|
|
d->lower_sys();
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
QEvent e(QEvent::ZOrderChange);
|
|
|
|
QApplication::sendEvent(this, &e);
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/*!
|
|
|
|
Places the widget under \a w in the parent widget's stack.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
To make this work, the widget itself and \a w must be siblings.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
\sa raise(), lower()
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
void QWidget::stackUnder(QWidget* w)
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
Q_D(QWidget);
|
|
|
|
QWidget *p = parentWidget();
|
|
|
|
if (!w || isWindow() || p != w->parentWidget() || this == w)
|
|
|
|
return;
|
|
|
|
if (p) {
|
|
|
|
int from = p->d_func()->children.indexOf(this);
|
|
|
|
int to = p->d_func()->children.indexOf(w);
|
|
|
|
Q_ASSERT(from >= 0);
|
|
|
|
Q_ASSERT(to >= 0);
|
|
|
|
if (from < to)
|
|
|
|
--to;
|
|
|
|
// Do nothing if the widget is already in correct stacking order _and_ created.
|
|
|
|
if (from != to)
|
|
|
|
p->d_func()->children.move(from, to);
|
|
|
|
if (!testAttribute(Qt::WA_WState_Created) && p->testAttribute(Qt::WA_WState_Created))
|
|
|
|
create();
|
|
|
|
else if (from == to)
|
|
|
|
return;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if (testAttribute(Qt::WA_WState_Created))
|
|
|
|
d->stackUnder_sys(w);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
QEvent e(QEvent::ZOrderChange);
|
|
|
|
QApplication::sendEvent(this, &e);
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
void QWidget::styleChange(QStyle&) { }
|
|
|
|
void QWidget::enabledChange(bool) { } // compat
|
|
|
|
void QWidget::paletteChange(const QPalette &) { } // compat
|
|
|
|
void QWidget::fontChange(const QFont &) { } // compat
|
|
|
|
void QWidget::windowActivationChange(bool) { } // compat
|
|
|
|
void QWidget::languageChange() { } // compat
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/*!
|
|
|
|
\enum QWidget::BackgroundOrigin
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
\compat
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
\value WidgetOrigin
|
|
|
|
\value ParentOrigin
|
|
|
|
\value WindowOrigin
|
|
|
|
\value AncestorOrigin
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/*!
|
|
|
|
\fn bool QWidget::isVisibleToTLW() const
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Use isVisible() instead.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/*!
|
|
|
|
\fn void QWidget::iconify()
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Use showMinimized() instead.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/*!
|
|
|
|
\fn void QWidget::constPolish() const
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Use ensurePolished() instead.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/*!
|
|
|
|
\fn void QWidget::reparent(QWidget *parent, Qt::WindowFlags f, const QPoint &p, bool showIt)
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Use setParent() to change the parent or the widget's widget flags;
|
|
|
|
use move() to move the widget, and use show() to show the widget.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/*!
|
|
|
|
\fn void QWidget::reparent(QWidget *parent, const QPoint &p, bool showIt)
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Use setParent() to change the parent; use move() to move the
|
|
|
|
widget, and use show() to show the widget.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/*!
|
|
|
|
\fn void QWidget::recreate(QWidget *parent, Qt::WindowFlags f, const QPoint & p, bool showIt)
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Use setParent() to change the parent or the widget's widget flags;
|
|
|
|
use move() to move the widget, and use show() to show the widget.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/*!
|
|
|
|
\fn bool QWidget::hasMouse() const
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Use testAttribute(Qt::WA_UnderMouse) instead.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/*!
|
|
|
|
\fn bool QWidget::ownCursor() const
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Use testAttribute(Qt::WA_SetCursor) instead.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/*!
|
|
|
|
\fn bool QWidget::ownFont() const
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Use testAttribute(Qt::WA_SetFont) instead.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/*!
|
|
|
|
\fn void QWidget::unsetFont()
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Use setFont(QFont()) instead.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/*!
|
|
|
|
\fn bool QWidget::ownPalette() const
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Use testAttribute(Qt::WA_SetPalette) instead.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/*!
|
|
|
|
\fn void QWidget::unsetPalette()
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Use setPalette(QPalette()) instead.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/*!
|
|
|
|
\fn void QWidget::setEraseColor(const QColor &color)
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Use the palette instead.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
\oldcode
|
|
|
|
widget->setEraseColor(color);
|
|
|
|
\newcode
|
|
|
|
QPalette palette;
|
|
|
|
palette.setColor(widget->backgroundRole(), color);
|
|
|
|
widget->setPalette(palette);
|
|
|
|
\endcode
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/*!
|
|
|
|
\fn void QWidget::setErasePixmap(const QPixmap &pixmap)
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Use the palette instead.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
\oldcode
|
|
|
|
widget->setErasePixmap(pixmap);
|
|
|
|
\newcode
|
|
|
|
QPalette palette;
|
|
|
|
palette.setBrush(widget->backgroundRole(), QBrush(pixmap));
|
|
|
|
widget->setPalette(palette);
|
|
|
|
\endcode
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/*!
|
|
|
|
\fn void QWidget::setPaletteForegroundColor(const QColor &color)
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Use the palette directly.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
\oldcode
|
|
|
|
widget->setPaletteForegroundColor(color);
|
|
|
|
\newcode
|
|
|
|
QPalette palette;
|
|
|
|
palette.setColor(widget->foregroundRole(), color);
|
|
|
|
widget->setPalette(palette);
|
|
|
|
\endcode
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/*!
|
|
|
|
\fn void QWidget::setPaletteBackgroundColor(const QColor &color)
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Use the palette directly.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
\oldcode
|
|
|
|
widget->setPaletteBackgroundColor(color);
|
|
|
|
\newcode
|
|
|
|
QPalette palette;
|
|
|
|
palette.setColor(widget->backgroundRole(), color);
|
|
|
|
widget->setPalette(palette);
|
|
|
|
\endcode
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/*!
|
|
|
|
\fn void QWidget::setPaletteBackgroundPixmap(const QPixmap &pixmap)
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Use the palette directly.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
\oldcode
|
|
|
|
widget->setPaletteBackgroundPixmap(pixmap);
|
|
|
|
\newcode
|
|
|
|
QPalette palette;
|
|
|
|
palette.setBrush(widget->backgroundRole(), QBrush(pixmap));
|
|
|
|
widget->setPalette(palette);
|
|
|
|
\endcode
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/*!
|
|
|
|
\fn void QWidget::setBackgroundPixmap(const QPixmap &pixmap)
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Use the palette instead.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
\oldcode
|
|
|
|
widget->setBackgroundPixmap(pixmap);
|
|
|
|
\newcode
|
|
|
|
QPalette palette;
|
|
|
|
palette.setBrush(widget->backgroundRole(), QBrush(pixmap));
|
|
|
|
widget->setPalette(palette);
|
|
|
|
\endcode
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/*!
|
|
|
|
\fn void QWidget::setBackgroundColor(const QColor &color)
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Use the palette instead.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
\oldcode
|
|
|
|
widget->setBackgroundColor(color);
|
|
|
|
\newcode
|
|
|
|
QPalette palette;
|
|
|
|
palette.setColor(widget->backgroundRole(), color);
|
|
|
|
widget->setPalette(palette);
|
|
|
|
\endcode
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/*!
|
|
|
|
\fn QWidget *QWidget::parentWidget(bool sameWindow) const
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Use the no-argument overload instead.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/*!
|
|
|
|
\fn void QWidget::setKeyCompression(bool b)
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Use setAttribute(Qt::WA_KeyCompression, b) instead.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/*!
|
|
|
|
\fn void QWidget::setFont(const QFont &f, bool b)
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Use the single-argument overload instead.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/*!
|
|
|
|
\fn void QWidget::setPalette(const QPalette &p, bool b)
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Use the single-argument overload instead.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/*!
|
|
|
|
\fn void QWidget::setBackgroundOrigin(BackgroundOrigin background)
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
\obsolete
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/*!
|
|
|
|
\fn BackgroundOrigin QWidget::backgroundOrigin() const
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
\obsolete
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Always returns \c WindowOrigin.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/*!
|
|
|
|
\fn QPoint QWidget::backgroundOffset() const
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
\obsolete
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Always returns QPoint().
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/*!
|
|
|
|
\fn void QWidget::repaint(bool b)
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
The boolean parameter \a b is ignored. Use the no-argument overload instead.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/*!
|
|
|
|
\fn void QWidget::repaint(int x, int y, int w, int h, bool b)
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
The boolean parameter \a b is ignored. Use the four-argument overload instead.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/*!
|
|
|
|
\fn void QWidget::repaint(const QRect &r, bool b)
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
The boolean parameter \a b is ignored. Use the single rect-argument overload instead.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/*!
|
|
|
|
\fn void QWidget::repaint(const QRegion &rgn, bool b)
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
The boolean parameter \a b is ignored. Use the single region-argument overload instead.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/*!
|
|
|
|
\fn void QWidget::erase()
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Drawing may only take place in a QPaintEvent. Overload
|
|
|
|
paintEvent() to do your erasing and call update() to schedule a
|
|
|
|
replaint whenever necessary. See also QPainter.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/*!
|
|
|
|
\fn void QWidget::erase(int x, int y, int w, int h)
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Drawing may only take place in a QPaintEvent. Overload
|
|
|
|
paintEvent() to do your erasing and call update() to schedule a
|
|
|
|
replaint whenever necessary. See also QPainter.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/*!
|
|
|
|
\fn void QWidget::erase(const QRect &rect)
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Drawing may only take place in a QPaintEvent. Overload
|
|
|
|
paintEvent() to do your erasing and call update() to schedule a
|
|
|
|
replaint whenever necessary. See also QPainter.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/*!
|
|
|
|
\fn void QWidget::drawText(const QPoint &p, const QString &s)
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Drawing may only take place in a QPaintEvent. Overload
|
|
|
|
paintEvent() to do your drawing and call update() to schedule a
|
|
|
|
replaint whenever necessary. See also QPainter.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/*!
|
|
|
|
\fn void QWidget::drawText(int x, int y, const QString &s)
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Drawing may only take place in a QPaintEvent. Overload
|
|
|
|
paintEvent() to do your drawing and call update() to schedule a
|
|
|
|
replaint whenever necessary. See also QPainter.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/*!
|
|
|
|
\fn QWidget *QWidget::childAt(const QPoint &p, bool includeThis) const
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Use the single point argument overload instead.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/*!
|
|
|
|
\fn void QWidget::setCaption(const QString &c)
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Use setWindowTitle() instead.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/*!
|
|
|
|
\fn void QWidget::setIcon(const QPixmap &i)
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Use setWindowIcon() instead.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/*!
|
|
|
|
\fn void QWidget::setIconText(const QString &it)
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Use setWindowIconText() instead.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/*!
|
|
|
|
\fn QString QWidget::caption() const
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Use windowTitle() instead.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/*!
|
|
|
|
\fn QString QWidget::iconText() const
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Use windowIconText() instead.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/*!
|
|
|
|
\fn bool QWidget::isTopLevel() const
|
|
|
|
\obsolete
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Use isWindow() instead.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/*!
|
|
|
|
\fn bool QWidget::isRightToLeft() const
|
|
|
|
\internal
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/*!
|
|
|
|
\fn bool QWidget::isLeftToRight() const
|
|
|
|
\internal
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/*!
|
|
|
|
\fn void QWidget::setInputMethodEnabled(bool enabled)
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Use setAttribute(Qt::WA_InputMethodEnabled, \a enabled) instead.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/*!
|
|
|
|
\fn bool QWidget::isInputMethodEnabled() const
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Use testAttribute(Qt::WA_InputMethodEnabled) instead.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/*!
|
|
|
|
\fn void QWidget::setActiveWindow()
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Use activateWindow() instead.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/*!
|
|
|
|
\fn bool QWidget::isShown() const
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Use !isHidden() instead (notice the exclamation mark), or use isVisible() to check whether the widget is visible.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/*!
|
|
|
|
\fn bool QWidget::isDialog() const
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Use windowType() == Qt::Dialog instead.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/*!
|
|
|
|
\fn bool QWidget::isPopup() const
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Use windowType() == Qt::Popup instead.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/*!
|
|
|
|
\fn bool QWidget::isDesktop() const
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Use windowType() == Qt::Desktop instead.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/*!
|
|
|
|
\fn void QWidget::polish()
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Use ensurePolished() instead.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/*!
|
|
|
|
\fn QWidget *QWidget::childAt(int x, int y, bool includeThis) const
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Use the childAt() overload that doesn't have an \a includeThis parameter.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
\oldcode
|
|
|
|
return widget->childAt(x, y, true);
|
|
|
|
\newcode
|
|
|
|
QWidget *child = widget->childAt(x, y, true);
|
|
|
|
if (child)
|
|
|
|
return child;
|
|
|
|
if (widget->rect().contains(x, y))
|
|
|
|
return widget;
|
|
|
|
\endcode
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/*!
|
|
|
|
\fn void QWidget::setSizePolicy(QSizePolicy::Policy hor, QSizePolicy::Policy ver, bool hfw)
|
|
|
|
\compat
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Use the \l sizePolicy property and heightForWidth() function instead.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/*!
|
|
|
|
\fn bool QWidget::isUpdatesEnabled() const
|
|
|
|
\compat
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Use the \l updatesEnabled property instead.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/*!
|
|
|
|
\macro QWIDGETSIZE_MAX
|
|
|
|
\relates QWidget
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Defines the maximum size for a QWidget object.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
The largest allowed size for a widget is QSize(QWIDGETSIZE_MAX,
|
|
|
|
QWIDGETSIZE_MAX), i.e. QSize (16777215,16777215).
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
\sa QWidget::setMaximumSize()
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/*!
|
|
|
|
\fn QWidget::setupUi(QWidget *widget)
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Sets up the user interface for the specified \a widget.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
\note This function is available with widgets that derive from user
|
|
|
|
interface descriptions created using \l{uic}.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
\sa {Using a Designer UI File in Your Application}
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
QRect QWidgetPrivate::frameStrut() const
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
Q_Q(const QWidget);
|
|
|
|
if (!q->isWindow() || (q->windowType() == Qt::Desktop) || q->testAttribute(Qt::WA_DontShowOnScreen)) {
|
|
|
|
// x2 = x1 + w - 1, so w/h = 1
|
|
|
|
return QRect(0, 0, 1, 1);
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
if (data.fstrut_dirty
|
|
|
|
#ifndef Q_WS_WIN
|
|
|
|
// ### Fix properly for 4.3
|
|
|
|
&& q->isVisible()
|
|
|
|
#endif
|
|
|
|
&& q->testAttribute(Qt::WA_WState_Created))
|
|
|
|
const_cast<QWidgetPrivate *>(this)->updateFrameStrut();
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
return maybeTopData() ? maybeTopData()->frameStrut : QRect();
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
#ifdef QT_KEYPAD_NAVIGATION
|
|
|
|
/*!
|
|
|
|
\internal
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Changes the focus from the current focusWidget to a widget in
|
|
|
|
the \a direction.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Returns true, if there was a widget in that direction
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
bool QWidgetPrivate::navigateToDirection(Direction direction)
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
QWidget *targetWidget = widgetInNavigationDirection(direction);
|
|
|
|
if (targetWidget)
|
|
|
|
targetWidget->setFocus();
|
|
|
|
return (targetWidget != 0);
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/*!
|
|
|
|
\internal
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Searches for a widget that is positioned in the \a direction, starting
|
|
|
|
from the current focusWidget.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Returns the pointer to a found widget or 0, if there was no widget in
|
|
|
|
that direction.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
QWidget *QWidgetPrivate::widgetInNavigationDirection(Direction direction)
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
const QWidget *sourceWidget = QApplication::focusWidget();
|
|
|
|
if (!sourceWidget)
|
|
|
|
return 0;
|
|
|
|
const QRect sourceRect = sourceWidget->rect().translated(sourceWidget->mapToGlobal(QPoint()));
|
|
|
|
const int sourceX =
|
|
|
|
(direction == DirectionNorth || direction == DirectionSouth) ?
|
|
|
|
(sourceRect.left() + (sourceRect.right() - sourceRect.left()) / 2)
|
|
|
|
:(direction == DirectionEast ? sourceRect.right() : sourceRect.left());
|
|
|
|
const int sourceY =
|
|
|
|
(direction == DirectionEast || direction == DirectionWest) ?
|
|
|
|
(sourceRect.top() + (sourceRect.bottom() - sourceRect.top()) / 2)
|
|
|
|
:(direction == DirectionSouth ? sourceRect.bottom() : sourceRect.top());
|
|
|
|
const QPoint sourcePoint(sourceX, sourceY);
|
|
|
|
const QPoint sourceCenter = sourceRect.center();
|
|
|
|
const QWidget *sourceWindow = sourceWidget->window();
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
QWidget *targetWidget = 0;
|
|
|
|
int shortestDistance = INT_MAX;
|
|
|
|
foreach(QWidget *targetCandidate, QApplication::allWidgets()) {
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
const QRect targetCandidateRect = targetCandidate->rect().translated(targetCandidate->mapToGlobal(QPoint()));
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
// For focus proxies, the child widget handling the focus can have keypad navigation focus,
|
|
|
|
// but the owner of the proxy cannot.
|
|
|
|
// Additionally, empty widgets should be ignored.
|
|
|
|
if (targetCandidate->focusProxy() || targetCandidateRect.isEmpty())
|
|
|
|
continue;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
// Only navigate to a target widget that...
|
|
|
|
if ( targetCandidate != sourceWidget
|
|
|
|
// ...takes the focus,
|
|
|
|
&& targetCandidate->focusPolicy() & Qt::TabFocus
|
|
|
|
// ...is above if DirectionNorth,
|
|
|
|
&& !(direction == DirectionNorth && targetCandidateRect.bottom() > sourceRect.top())
|
|
|
|
// ...is on the right if DirectionEast,
|
|
|
|
&& !(direction == DirectionEast && targetCandidateRect.left() < sourceRect.right())
|
|
|
|
// ...is below if DirectionSouth,
|
|
|
|
&& !(direction == DirectionSouth && targetCandidateRect.top() < sourceRect.bottom())
|
|
|
|
// ...is on the left if DirectionWest,
|
|
|
|
&& !(direction == DirectionWest && targetCandidateRect.right() > sourceRect.left())
|
|
|
|
// ...is enabled,
|
|
|
|
&& targetCandidate->isEnabled()
|
|
|
|
// ...is visible,
|
|
|
|
&& targetCandidate->isVisible()
|
|
|
|
// ...is in the same window,
|
|
|
|
&& targetCandidate->window() == sourceWindow) {
|
|
|
|
const int targetCandidateDistance = pointToRect(sourcePoint, targetCandidateRect);
|
|
|
|
if (targetCandidateDistance < shortestDistance) {
|
|
|
|
shortestDistance = targetCandidateDistance;
|
|
|
|
targetWidget = targetCandidate;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
return targetWidget;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/*!
|
|
|
|
\internal
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Tells us if it there is currently a reachable widget by keypad navigation in
|
|
|
|
a certain \a orientation.
|
|
|
|
If no navigation is possible, occurring key events in that \a orientation may
|
|
|
|
be used to interact with the value in the focused widget, even though it
|
|
|
|
currently has not the editFocus.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
\sa QWidgetPrivate::widgetInNavigationDirection(), QWidget::hasEditFocus()
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
bool QWidgetPrivate::canKeypadNavigate(Qt::Orientation orientation)
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
return orientation == Qt::Horizontal?
|
|
|
|
(QWidgetPrivate::widgetInNavigationDirection(QWidgetPrivate::DirectionEast)
|
|
|
|
|| QWidgetPrivate::widgetInNavigationDirection(QWidgetPrivate::DirectionWest))
|
|
|
|
:(QWidgetPrivate::widgetInNavigationDirection(QWidgetPrivate::DirectionNorth)
|
|
|
|
|| QWidgetPrivate::widgetInNavigationDirection(QWidgetPrivate::DirectionSouth));
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/*!
|
|
|
|
\internal
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Checks, if the \a widget is inside a QTabWidget. If is is inside
|
|
|
|
one, left/right key events will be used to switch between tabs in keypad
|
|
|
|
navigation. If there is no QTabWidget, the horizontal key events can be used
|
|
|
|
to
|
|
|
|
interact with the value in the focused widget, even though it currently has
|
|
|
|
not the editFocus.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
\sa QWidget::hasEditFocus()
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
bool QWidgetPrivate::inTabWidget(QWidget *widget)
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
for (QWidget *tabWidget = widget; tabWidget; tabWidget = tabWidget->parentWidget())
|
|
|
|
if (qobject_cast<const QTabWidget*>(tabWidget))
|
|
|
|
return true;
|
|
|
|
return false;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
#endif
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/*!
|
|
|
|
\preliminary
|
|
|
|
\since 4.2
|
|
|
|
\obsolete
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Sets the window surface to be the \a surface specified.
|
|
|
|
The QWidget takes will ownership of the \a surface.
|
|
|
|
widget itself is deleted.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
void QWidget::setWindowSurface(QWindowSurface *surface)
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
// ### createWinId() ??
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
#ifndef Q_BACKINGSTORE_SUBSURFACES
|
|
|
|
if (!isTopLevel())
|
|
|
|
return;
|
|
|
|
#endif
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Q_D(QWidget);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
QTLWExtra *topData = d->topData();
|
|
|
|
if (topData->windowSurface == surface)
|
|
|
|
return;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
QWindowSurface *oldSurface = topData->windowSurface;
|
|
|
|
delete topData->windowSurface;
|
|
|
|
topData->windowSurface = surface;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
QWidgetBackingStore *bs = d->maybeBackingStore();
|
|
|
|
if (!bs)
|
|
|
|
return;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
if (isTopLevel()) {
|
|
|
|
if (bs->windowSurface != oldSurface && bs->windowSurface != surface)
|
|
|
|
delete bs->windowSurface;
|
|
|
|
bs->windowSurface = surface;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
#ifdef Q_BACKINGSTORE_SUBSURFACES
|
|
|
|
else {
|
|
|
|
bs->subSurfaces.append(surface);
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
bs->subSurfaces.removeOne(oldSurface);
|
|
|
|
#endif
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/*!
|
|
|
|
\preliminary
|
|
|
|
\since 4.2
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Returns the QWindowSurface this widget will be drawn into.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
QWindowSurface *QWidget::windowSurface() const
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
Q_D(const QWidget);
|
|
|
|
QTLWExtra *extra = d->maybeTopData();
|
|
|
|
if (extra && extra->windowSurface)
|
|
|
|
return extra->windowSurface;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
QWidgetBackingStore *bs = d->maybeBackingStore();
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
#ifdef Q_BACKINGSTORE_SUBSURFACES
|
|
|
|
if (bs && bs->subSurfaces.isEmpty())
|
|
|
|
return bs->windowSurface;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
if (!isTopLevel()) {
|
|
|
|
const QWidget *w = parentWidget();
|
|
|
|
while (w) {
|
|
|
|
QTLWExtra *extra = w->d_func()->maybeTopData();
|
|
|
|
if (extra && extra->windowSurface)
|
|
|
|
return extra->windowSurface;
|
|
|
|
if (w->isTopLevel())
|
|
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
w = w->parentWidget();
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
#endif // Q_BACKINGSTORE_SUBSURFACES
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
return bs ? bs->windowSurface : 0;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
void QWidgetPrivate::getLayoutItemMargins(int *left, int *top, int *right, int *bottom) const
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
if (left)
|
|
|
|
*left = (int)leftLayoutItemMargin;
|
|
|
|
if (top)
|
|
|
|
*top = (int)topLayoutItemMargin;
|
|
|
|
if (right)
|
|
|
|
*right = (int)rightLayoutItemMargin;
|
|
|
|
if (bottom)
|
|
|
|
*bottom = (int)bottomLayoutItemMargin;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
void QWidgetPrivate::setLayoutItemMargins(int left, int top, int right, int bottom)
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
if (leftLayoutItemMargin == left
|
|
|
|
&& topLayoutItemMargin == top
|
|
|
|
&& rightLayoutItemMargin == right
|
|
|
|
&& bottomLayoutItemMargin == bottom)
|
|
|
|
return;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Q_Q(QWidget);
|
|
|
|
leftLayoutItemMargin = (signed char)left;
|
|
|
|
topLayoutItemMargin = (signed char)top;
|
|
|
|
rightLayoutItemMargin = (signed char)right;
|
|
|
|
bottomLayoutItemMargin = (signed char)bottom;
|
|
|
|
q->updateGeometry();
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
void QWidgetPrivate::setLayoutItemMargins(QStyle::SubElement element, const QStyleOption *opt)
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
Q_Q(QWidget);
|
|
|
|
QStyleOption myOpt;
|
|
|
|
if (!opt) {
|
|
|
|
myOpt.initFrom(q);
|
|
|
|
myOpt.rect.setRect(0, 0, 32768, 32768); // arbitrary
|
|
|
|
opt = &myOpt;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
QRect liRect = q->style()->subElementRect(element, opt, q);
|
|
|
|
if (liRect.isValid()) {
|
|
|
|
leftLayoutItemMargin = (signed char)(opt->rect.left() - liRect.left());
|
|
|
|
topLayoutItemMargin = (signed char)(opt->rect.top() - liRect.top());
|
|
|
|
rightLayoutItemMargin = (signed char)(liRect.right() - opt->rect.right());
|
|
|
|
bottomLayoutItemMargin = (signed char)(liRect.bottom() - opt->rect.bottom());
|
|
|
|
} else {
|
|
|
|
leftLayoutItemMargin = 0;
|
|
|
|
topLayoutItemMargin = 0;
|
|
|
|
rightLayoutItemMargin = 0;
|
|
|
|
bottomLayoutItemMargin = 0;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// resets the Qt::WA_QuitOnClose attribute to the default value for transient widgets.
|
|
|
|
void QWidgetPrivate::adjustQuitOnCloseAttribute()
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
Q_Q(QWidget);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
if (!q->parentWidget()) {
|
|
|
|
Qt::WindowType type = q->windowType();
|
|
|
|
if (type == Qt::Widget || type == Qt::SubWindow)
|
|
|
|
type = Qt::Window;
|
|
|
|
if (type != Qt::Widget && type != Qt::Window && type != Qt::Dialog)
|
|
|
|
q->setAttribute(Qt::WA_QuitOnClose, false);
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Q_GUI_EXPORT QWidgetData *qt_qwidget_data(QWidget *widget)
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
return widget->data;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Q_GUI_EXPORT QWidgetPrivate *qt_widget_private(QWidget *widget)
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
return widget->d_func();
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
#ifndef QT_NO_GRAPHICSVIEW
|
|
|
|
/*!
|
|
|
|
\since 4.5
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Returns the proxy widget for the corresponding embedded widget in a graphics
|
|
|
|
view; otherwise returns 0.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
\sa QGraphicsProxyWidget::createProxyForChildWidget(),
|
|
|
|
QGraphicsScene::addWidget()
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
QGraphicsProxyWidget *QWidget::graphicsProxyWidget() const
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
Q_D(const QWidget);
|
|
|
|
if (d->extra) {
|
|
|
|
return d->extra->proxyWidget;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
return 0;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
#endif
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/*!
|
|
|
|
\typedef QWidgetList
|
|
|
|
\relates QWidget
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Synonym for QList<QWidget *>.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
#ifndef QT_NO_GESTURES
|
|
|
|
/*!
|
|
|
|
Subscribes the widget to a given \a gesture with specific \a flags.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
\sa ungrabGesture(), QGestureEvent
|
|
|
|
\since 4.6
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
void QWidget::grabGesture(Qt::GestureType gesture, Qt::GestureFlags flags)
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
Q_D(QWidget);
|
|
|
|
d->gestureContext.insert(gesture, flags);
|
|
|
|
(void)QGestureManager::instance(); // create a gesture manager
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/*!
|
|
|
|
Unsubscribes the widget from a given \a gesture type
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
\sa grabGesture(), QGestureEvent
|
|
|
|
\since 4.6
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
void QWidget::ungrabGesture(Qt::GestureType gesture)
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
Q_D(QWidget);
|
|
|
|
if (d->gestureContext.remove(gesture)) {
|
|
|
|
if (QGestureManager *manager = QGestureManager::instance())
|
|
|
|
manager->cleanupCachedGestures(this, gesture);
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
#endif // QT_NO_GESTURES
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/*!
|
|
|
|
\typedef WId
|
|
|
|
\relates QWidget
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Platform dependent window identifier.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/*!
|
|
|
|
\fn void QWidget::destroy(bool destroyWindow, bool destroySubWindows)
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Frees up window system resources. Destroys the widget window if \a
|
|
|
|
destroyWindow is true.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
destroy() calls itself recursively for all the child widgets,
|
|
|
|
passing \a destroySubWindows for the \a destroyWindow parameter.
|
|
|
|
To have more control over destruction of subwidgets, destroy
|
|
|
|
subwidgets selectively first.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
This function is usually called from the QWidget destructor.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/*!
|
|
|
|
\fn QPaintEngine *QWidget::paintEngine() const
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Returns the widget's paint engine.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Note that this function should not be called explicitly by the
|
|
|
|
user, since it's meant for reimplementation purposes only. The
|
|
|
|
function is called by Qt internally, and the default
|
|
|
|
implementation may not always return a valid pointer.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/*!
|
|
|
|
\fn QPoint QWidget::mapToGlobal(const QPoint &pos) const
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Translates the widget coordinate \a pos to global screen
|
|
|
|
coordinates. For example, \c{mapToGlobal(QPoint(0,0))} would give
|
|
|
|
the global coordinates of the top-left pixel of the widget.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
\sa mapFromGlobal() mapTo() mapToParent()
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/*!
|
|
|
|
\fn QPoint QWidget::mapFromGlobal(const QPoint &pos) const
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Translates the global screen coordinate \a pos to widget
|
|
|
|
coordinates.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
\sa mapToGlobal() mapFrom() mapFromParent()
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/*!
|
|
|
|
\fn void QWidget::grabMouse()
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Grabs the mouse input.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
This widget receives all mouse events until releaseMouse() is
|
|
|
|
called; other widgets get no mouse events at all. Keyboard
|
|
|
|
events are not affected. Use grabKeyboard() if you want to grab
|
|
|
|
that.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
\warning Bugs in mouse-grabbing applications very often lock the
|
|
|
|
terminal. Use this function with extreme caution, and consider
|
|
|
|
using the \c -nograb command line option while debugging.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
It is almost never necessary to grab the mouse when using Qt, as
|
|
|
|
Qt grabs and releases it sensibly. In particular, Qt grabs the
|
|
|
|
mouse when a mouse button is pressed and keeps it until the last
|
|
|
|
button is released.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
\note Only visible widgets can grab mouse input. If isVisible()
|
|
|
|
returns false for a widget, that widget cannot call grabMouse().
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
\note \bold{(Mac OS X developers)} For \e Cocoa, calling
|
|
|
|
grabMouse() on a widget only works when the mouse is inside the
|
|
|
|
frame of that widget. For \e Carbon, it works outside the widget's
|
|
|
|
frame as well, like for Windows and X11.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
\sa releaseMouse() grabKeyboard() releaseKeyboard()
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/*!
|
|
|
|
\fn void QWidget::grabMouse(const QCursor &cursor)
|
|
|
|
\overload grabMouse()
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Grabs the mouse input and changes the cursor shape.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
The cursor will assume shape \a cursor (for as long as the mouse
|
|
|
|
focus is grabbed) and this widget will be the only one to receive
|
|
|
|
mouse events until releaseMouse() is called().
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
\warning Grabbing the mouse might lock the terminal.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
\note \bold{(Mac OS X developers)} See the note in QWidget::grabMouse().
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
\sa releaseMouse(), grabKeyboard(), releaseKeyboard(), setCursor()
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/*!
|
|
|
|
\fn void QWidget::releaseMouse()
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Releases the mouse grab.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
\sa grabMouse(), grabKeyboard(), releaseKeyboard()
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/*!
|
|
|
|
\fn void QWidget::grabKeyboard()
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Grabs the keyboard input.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
This widget receives all keyboard events until releaseKeyboard()
|
|
|
|
is called; other widgets get no keyboard events at all. Mouse
|
|
|
|
events are not affected. Use grabMouse() if you want to grab that.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
The focus widget is not affected, except that it doesn't receive
|
|
|
|
any keyboard events. setFocus() moves the focus as usual, but the
|
|
|
|
new focus widget receives keyboard events only after
|
|
|
|
releaseKeyboard() is called.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
If a different widget is currently grabbing keyboard input, that
|
|
|
|
widget's grab is released first.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
\sa releaseKeyboard() grabMouse() releaseMouse() focusWidget()
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/*!
|
|
|
|
\fn void QWidget::releaseKeyboard()
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Releases the keyboard grab.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
\sa grabKeyboard(), grabMouse(), releaseMouse()
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/*!
|
|
|
|
\fn QWidget *QWidget::mouseGrabber()
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Returns the widget that is currently grabbing the mouse input.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
If no widget in this application is currently grabbing the mouse,
|
|
|
|
0 is returned.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
\sa grabMouse(), keyboardGrabber()
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/*!
|
|
|
|
\fn QWidget *QWidget::keyboardGrabber()
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Returns the widget that is currently grabbing the keyboard input.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
If no widget in this application is currently grabbing the
|
|
|
|
keyboard, 0 is returned.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
\sa grabMouse(), mouseGrabber()
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/*!
|
|
|
|
\fn void QWidget::activateWindow()
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Sets the top-level widget containing this widget to be the active
|
|
|
|
window.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
An active window is a visible top-level window that has the
|
|
|
|
keyboard input focus.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
This function performs the same operation as clicking the mouse on
|
|
|
|
the title bar of a top-level window. On X11, the result depends on
|
|
|
|
the Window Manager. If you want to ensure that the window is
|
|
|
|
stacked on top as well you should also call raise(). Note that the
|
|
|
|
window must be visible, otherwise activateWindow() has no effect.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
On Windows, if you are calling this when the application is not
|
|
|
|
currently the active one then it will not make it the active
|
|
|
|
window. It will change the color of the taskbar entry to indicate
|
|
|
|
that the window has changed in some way. This is because Microsoft
|
|
|
|
does not allow an application to interrupt what the user is currently
|
|
|
|
doing in another application.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
\sa isActiveWindow(), window(), show()
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/*!
|
|
|
|
\fn int QWidget::metric(PaintDeviceMetric m) const
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Internal implementation of the virtual QPaintDevice::metric()
|
|
|
|
function.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
\a m is the metric to get.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/*!
|
|
|
|
\fn void QWidget::setMask(const QRegion ®ion)
|
|
|
|
\overload
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Causes only the parts of the widget which overlap \a region to be
|
|
|
|
visible. If the region includes pixels outside the rect() of the
|
|
|
|
widget, window system controls in that area may or may not be
|
|
|
|
visible, depending on the platform.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Note that this effect can be slow if the region is particularly
|
|
|
|
complex.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
\sa windowOpacity
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
void QWidget::setMask(const QRegion &newMask)
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
Q_D(QWidget);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
d->createExtra();
|
|
|
|
if (newMask == d->extra->mask)
|
|
|
|
return;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
#ifndef QT_NO_BACKINGSTORE
|
|
|
|
const QRegion oldMask(d->extra->mask);
|
|
|
|
#endif
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
d->extra->mask = newMask;
|
|
|
|
d->extra->hasMask = !newMask.isEmpty();
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
#ifndef QT_MAC_USE_COCOA
|
|
|
|
if (!testAttribute(Qt::WA_WState_Created))
|
|
|
|
return;
|
|
|
|
#endif
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
d->setMask_sys(newMask);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
#ifndef QT_NO_BACKINGSTORE
|
|
|
|
if (!isVisible())
|
|
|
|
return;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
if (!d->extra->hasMask) {
|
|
|
|
// Mask was cleared; update newly exposed area.
|
|
|
|
QRegion expose(rect());
|
|
|
|
expose -= oldMask;
|
|
|
|
if (!expose.isEmpty()) {
|
|
|
|
d->setDirtyOpaqueRegion();
|
|
|
|
update(expose);
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
return;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
if (!isWindow()) {
|
|
|
|
// Update newly exposed area on the parent widget.
|
|
|
|
QRegion parentExpose(rect());
|
|
|
|
parentExpose -= newMask;
|
|
|
|
if (!parentExpose.isEmpty()) {
|
|
|
|
d->setDirtyOpaqueRegion();
|
|
|
|
parentExpose.translate(data->crect.topLeft());
|
|
|
|
parentWidget()->update(parentExpose);
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
// Update newly exposed area on this widget
|
|
|
|
if (!oldMask.isEmpty())
|
|
|
|
update(newMask - oldMask);
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
#endif
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/*!
|
|
|
|
\fn void QWidget::setMask(const QBitmap &bitmap)
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Causes only the pixels of the widget for which \a bitmap has a
|
|
|
|
corresponding 1 bit to be visible. If the region includes pixels
|
|
|
|
outside the rect() of the widget, window system controls in that
|
|
|
|
area may or may not be visible, depending on the platform.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Note that this effect can be slow if the region is particularly
|
|
|
|
complex.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
The following code shows how an image with an alpha channel can be
|
|
|
|
used to generate a mask for a widget:
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
\snippet doc/src/snippets/widget-mask/main.cpp 0
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
The label shown by this code is masked using the image it contains,
|
|
|
|
giving the appearance that an irregularly-shaped image is being drawn
|
|
|
|
directly onto the screen.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Masked widgets receive mouse events only on their visible
|
|
|
|
portions.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
\sa clearMask(), windowOpacity(), {Shaped Clock Example}
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
void QWidget::setMask(const QBitmap &bitmap)
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
setMask(QRegion(bitmap));
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/*!
|
|
|
|
\fn void QWidget::clearMask()
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Removes any mask set by setMask().
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
\sa setMask()
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
void QWidget::clearMask()
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
setMask(QRegion());
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/*! \fn const QX11Info &QWidget::x11Info() const
|
|
|
|
Returns information about the configuration of the X display used to display
|
|
|
|
the widget.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
\warning This function is only available on X11.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/*! \fn Qt::HANDLE QWidget::x11PictureHandle() const
|
|
|
|
Returns the X11 Picture handle of the widget for XRender
|
|
|
|
support. Use of this function is not portable. This function will
|
|
|
|
return 0 if XRender support is not compiled into Qt, if the
|
|
|
|
XRender extension is not supported on the X11 display, or if the
|
|
|
|
handle could not be created.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
2016-01-30 16:02:10 +02:00
|
|
|
#ifdef QT_MAC_USE_COCOA
|
2015-12-10 05:06:13 +02:00
|
|
|
void QWidgetPrivate::syncUnifiedMode() {
|
|
|
|
// The whole purpose of this method is to keep the unifiedToolbar in sync.
|
|
|
|
// That means making sure we either exchange the drawing methods or we let
|
|
|
|
// the toolbar know that it does not require to draw the baseline.
|
|
|
|
Q_Q(QWidget);
|
|
|
|
// This function makes sense only if this is a top level
|
|
|
|
if(!q->isWindow())
|
|
|
|
return;
|
|
|
|
OSWindowRef window = qt_mac_window_for(q);
|
|
|
|
if(changeMethods) {
|
|
|
|
// Ok, we are in documentMode.
|
|
|
|
if(originalDrawMethod)
|
|
|
|
qt_mac_replaceDrawRect(window, this);
|
|
|
|
} else {
|
|
|
|
if(!originalDrawMethod)
|
|
|
|
qt_mac_replaceDrawRectOriginal(window, this);
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
#endif // QT_MAC_USE_COCOA
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
QT_END_NAMESPACE
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
#include "moc_qwidget.h"
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|